BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
C-Class
Operator's Manual
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 1
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Symbols
Registered trademarks:
RBabySmart™
is a registered trademark of
the Siemens Automotive Corp.
RBluetooth® is a registered trademark of the
Bluetooth SIG Inc.
RESP® is a registered trademark of Daimler
AG.
RHomeLink® is a registered trademark of
Prince, a Johnson Controls Company.
RLogic 7® is a registered trademark of
Harman International Industries,
Incorporated.
RMicrosoft® a registered trademark of the
Microsoft Corporation in the USA and in
other countries.
RSIRIUS and related brands are registered
trademarks of SIRIUS XM Radio Inc.
RWindows Media® is a registered trademark
of the Microsoft Corporation in the USA and
in other countries.
In this Operator's Manual you will find the
following symbols:
G Warning
Warning notices draw your attention to
hazards that endanger your health or life, or
the health or life of others.
! Warning notices draw your attention to
hazards that could cause damage to your
vehicle.
i Practical tips or other information that
could be helpful to you.
X
X
Y page
This symbol indicates instructions
that you must follow.
A number of these symbols
appearing in succession indicates
instructions with several steps.
This symbol tells you where to look
for further information on a topic.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 2
Version: 3.0.3.6
YY
This symbol marks a warning or
procedure which is continued on
the next page.
Display Text in the multifunction display/
COMAND display.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 1
Version: 3.0.3.6
Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz
Before you drive off, please familiarize
yourself with your vehicle and read this
manual, especially the safety and warning
notices. This will help you to obtain the
maximum pleasure from your vehicle and to
avoid endangering yourself and others.
The equipment or product designation of your
vehicle may vary depending on:
Rmodel
Rorder
Rcountry
specification
Ravailability
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its
vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right
to introduce changes in the following areas:
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical
features
You cannot therefore base any claims on the
data, illustrations or descriptions contained
in this manual.
The following are integral parts of the vehicle:
ROperator's
Manual
Instructions1
RService Booklet
RSupplements relating to vehicle equipment
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. When you sell the vehicle, always pass
the documents on to the new owner.
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
A Daimler Company
RBrief
1
Canada only.
2045848981 É2045848981XËÍ
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 2
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 3
Version: 3.0.3.6
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
At a glance ........................................... 23
Introduction ......................................... 18
Safety ................................................... 33
Opening and closing ........................... 69
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .... 91
Lights and windshield wipers .......... 105
Climate control ................................. 119
Driving and parking .......................... 129
On-board computer and displays .... 165
Loading, stowing and features ........ 215
Maintenance and care ...................... 237
Breakdown assistance ..................... 251
Tires and wheels ............................... 269
Technical data ................................... 301
3
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 4
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
115 V socket ...................................... 225
12 V socket ........................................ 224
4ETS
see ETS/4ETS
4MATIC (permanent four-wheel
drive) .................................................. 159
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 189
Function/notes ................................ 62
Warning lamp ................................. 206
Accident (notes) ................................ 253
Active light function (display
message) ............................................ 194
Active service system
see Service interval display
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 66
Additional speedometer ................... 179
Air bags
Display message ............................ 187
Front air bag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 37
Important safety notes .................... 36
Knee bag .......................................... 38
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
indicator lamp (only Canada) ........... 46
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
indicator lamp (only USA) ................ 41
Pelvis air bag ................................... 40
Safety guidelines ............................. 35
Side impact air bag .......................... 39
Window curtain air bag .................... 40
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Air dehumidification
Activating/deactivating with
cooling ........................................... 122
Air distribution
Setting ........................................... 123
Airflow
Setting ........................................... 124
Air nozzles
see Air vents .................................. 126
Air pressure
see Tire pressure
Air-recirculation mode
Activating/deactivating ................. 125
Air vents ............................................. 126
Glove box ....................................... 127
Important safety information ......... 126
Rear ............................................... 127
Setting the center air vents ........... 126
Setting the side air vents ............... 126
Alarm system
see ATA
AMG menu (on-board computer) ..... 171
Anti-lock Braking System
see ABS
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA
Anti-theft system
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 67
Ashtray ............................................... 223
Assistance menu (on-board
computer) .......................................... 178
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 67
Function ........................................... 67
Switching off the alarm .................... 67
Audio menu (on-board computer) .... 175
AUTO lights
see Light sensor
Automatic car wash .......................... 244
Automatic transmission
Display message ............................ 200
Driving tips .................................... 139
Emergency running mode .............. 144
Kickdown ....................................... 140
Malfunction .................................... 144
Program selector button ................ 140
Pulling away ................................... 134
Releasing the parking lock
manually ........................................ 144
Selector lever ................................ 138
Starting .......................................... 133
B
Backrest (display message) ............. 201
Bag hook ............................................ 219
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 62
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 5
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Index
Battery
Charging ........................................ 261
Checking (SmartKey) ....................... 74
Display message ............................ 196
Important safety guidelines
(SmartKey) ....................................... 74
Jump-starting ................................. 262
Replacing (SmartKey) ...................... 74
Safety notes .................................. 259
Belt
see Seat belts
Brake fluid
Notes ............................................. 309
Brake fluid level ................................ 242
Brake lamp (display message) ......... 192
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 62
BAS .................................................. 62
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 309
Display message ............................ 190
High-performance brake system .... 153
Important safety notes .................. 151
Maintenance .................................. 152
Parking brake ................................ 149
Warning lamp ................................. 203
Breakdown
see Accident (notes)
see Flat tire
Bulbs
Backup lamp .................................. 115
Brake lamp .................................... 115
High-beam headlamps ................... 113
Low-beam headlamps .................... 113
Overview ........................................ 112
Parking lamps ................................ 114
Rear fog lamp ................................ 115
Replacing ....................................... 114
Side marker lamp .......................... 115
Standing lamps (front) ................... 114
Tail lamp ........................................ 115
Turn signal lamp ............................ 115
Turn signals (front) ......................... 114
C
CAC
(Customer Assistance Center) ......... 21
California
Important notice for retail
customers and lessees .................... 19
Calling up a malfunction
see Display messages
Capacities
see Technical data
Care
Carpets .......................................... 249
Car wash ........................................ 244
Display ........................................... 247
Gear or selector lever .................... 248
Headlamps ..................................... 246
Matte finish ................................... 245
Notes ............................................. 243
Paint .............................................. 245
Plastic trim .................................... 247
Power washer ................................ 244
Rear view camera .......................... 247
Roof lining ...................................... 249
Seat belt ........................................ 249
Seat covers .................................... 248
Sensors ......................................... 247
Steering wheel ............................... 248
Tail pipes ....................................... 247
Trim strips ..................................... 248
Washing by hand ........................... 244
Wheels ........................................... 245
Windows ........................................ 246
Wiper blades .................................. 246
Wooden trim .................................. 248
Cargo tie down rings ......................... 219
CD player/CD changer (on-board
computer) .......................................... 175
Center console ..................................... 29
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board
computer) ...................................... 181
SmartKey ......................................... 70
Changing bulbs
Headlamps ..................................... 111
Changing gears .................................. 139
Changing the programming
SmartKey ......................................... 73
5
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 6
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
6
Index
Child-proof locks
Rear doors ....................................... 60
Children
In the vehicle ................................... 55
Restraint systems ............................ 56
Child seat
Automatic recognition ..................... 46
Automatic recognition/air bag
deactivation, self-test ...................... 48
Display message ............................ 185
LATCH-type (ISOFIX ) child seat
anchors ............................................ 58
Special seat belt retractor ............... 58
Top Tether ....................................... 59
Troubleshooting ............................... 49
Cigarette lighter ................................ 224
Classification system for
occupants (OCS)
Faults ............................................... 45
Operation ......................................... 41
System self-test ............................... 44
Climate control
Activating/deactivating ................. 122
Activating/deactivating airrecirculation mode ......................... 125
Controlling automatically ............... 123
Cooling with air dehumidification . . 122
Defrosting the windshield .............. 124
Demisting the windows .................. 125
Dual-zone automatic climate
control ........................................... 121
Important safety information ......... 120
Indicator lamp ................................ 123
Maximum cooling .......................... 124
Problems with "cooling with air
dehumidification" ........................... 123
Problems with the rear window
heating .......................................... 125
Refrigerant ..................................... 309
Setting the air distribution ............. 123
Setting the airflow ......................... 124
Setting the air vents ...................... 126
Setting the temperature ................ 123
Switching the MONO function on/
off .................................................. 124
Switching the rear window
heating on/off ............................... 125
Clock (on-board computer) ............... 179
Cockpit ................................................. 25
Combination switch .......................... 108
Compass ............................................ 235
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) .......................................... 170
Convenience closing feature .............. 84
Convenience opening feature ............ 84
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level ......................... 240
Display message ............................ 194
Notes ............................................. 310
Temperature (on-board computer) . 171
Temperature gauge ........................ 166
Warning lamp ................................. 210
Cooling
see Climate control
Cornering light (display message) ... 191
Crash-responsive emergency
lighting ............................................... 111
Cruise control
Cruise control lever ....................... 156
Display message ............................ 197
Function/notes ............................. 156
Cup holder ......................................... 220
Center console .............................. 221
Rear compartment ......................... 221
Current fuel consumption (onboard computer) ............................... 170
Customer Assistance Center
(CAC) ............................................... 21
Customer Relations Department ....... 21
D
Dashboard
see Cockpit
Date (on-board computer) ................
Daytime running lamps
Display message ............................
Switching on/off (on-board
computer) ......................................
Delayed switch-off
Exterior lighting (on-board
computer) ......................................
Interior lighting (on-board
computer) ......................................
Digital speedometer .........................
Display (cleaning instructions) ........
179
194
180
180
180
171
247
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 7
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Index
Display messages
Brakes ........................................... 189
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 183
Clearing (on-board computer) ........ 183
Driving systems ............................. 197
Engine ............................................ 194
KEYLESS-GO .................................. 202
Lamps ............................................ 191
Safety systems .............................. 184
Service interval display .................. 242
SmartKey ....................................... 201
Tires ............................................... 197
Vehicle ........................................... 200
Distance recorder ............................. 170
Door
Automatic locking ............................ 78
Automatic locking (on-board
computer) ...................................... 181
Display message ............................ 201
Emergency locking ........................... 79
Emergency unlocking ....................... 79
Opening (from inside) ...................... 78
Door control panel
Overview .......................................... 31
Doors
Important safety notes .................... 77
Drinking and driving ......................... 151
Drinks holder
see Cup holder
Drive program
Automatic ...................................... 141
Manual ........................................... 142
SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 171
Drive program display ...................... 139
Driving abroad ................................... 155
Driving on flooded roads .................. 154
Driving safety system
EBD (Electronic Brake force
Distribution) ..................................... 66
ESP® (Electronic Stability
Program) .......................................... 63
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction
System) ........................................... 63
Important safety information ........... 61
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 62
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 66
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 62
Overview .......................................... 61
Driving systems
Cruise control ................................ 156
Dynamic handling package with
sports mode .................................. 158
PARKTRONIC ................................. 159
Rear view camera .......................... 162
Driving tips ........................................ 139
Braking .......................................... 153
Downhill gradients ......................... 152
Driving on flooded roads ................ 154
Wet road surface ........................... 152
Winter ............................................ 155
DVD audio (on-board computer) ...... 175
Dynamic handling package with
sports mode ....................................... 158
E
EASY-ENTRY feature ............................ 99
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 181
EASY-EXIT feature ............................... 99
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 181
Crash-responsive ............................. 99
EBD (Electronic Brake force
Distribution)
Display message ............................ 190
Function/notes ................................ 66
Electrical fuses
see Fuses
Electronic Brake force
see EBD
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP®
Electronic Traction System
see ETS/4ETS
Emergency call
see mbrace
Emergency release
Fuel filler flap ................................. 146
Trunk ............................................... 82
Vehicle ............................................. 79
Emergency running mode
Automatic transmission ................. 144
7
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 8
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
8
Index
Emergency spare wheel
Storage location ............................ 254
Emergency starting ........................... 266
Emergency tensioning device
Function ........................................... 54
Safety guidelines ............................. 35
Emissions purification
Service and warranty information .... 18
Engine
Irregular running ............................ 136
Starting problems .......................... 136
Starting the engine with the key .... 133
Starting with KEYLESS-GO ............. 133
Switching off .................................. 149
Warning lamp Check Engine .......... 210
Engine electronics
Malfunction .................................... 136
Engine number .................................. 304
Engine oil
Adding ........................................... 240
Checking the oil level ..................... 239
Display message ............................ 196
Lubricant additives ........................ 309
Notes about oil grades ................... 308
Temperature (on-board computer) . 171
Viscosity ........................................ 309
ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
see ESP®
ESP® (Electronic Stability
Program)
Activating/deactivating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 65
Activating/deactivating (except
AMG vehicles) .................................. 64
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 178
AMG menu (on-board computer) . . . 171
Display message ............................ 184
ETS/4ETS ........................................ 63
Important safety information ........... 63
Warning lamp ................................. 207
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction
System) ................................................ 63
Exhaust check ................................... 151
Exhaust tail pipe (cleaning
instructions) ...................................... 247
Exterior lighting
see Lights
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ....................................... 100
Dipping (automatic) ....................... 101
Folding in/out (automatically) ....... 101
Folding in/out (electrically) ........... 100
Folding in when locking (on-board
computer) ...................................... 182
Out of position ............................... 101
Setting ........................................... 100
Storing settings (memory
function) ........................................ 102
Storing the parking position .......... 101
Exterior view ........................................ 24
F
First-aid kit .........................................
Flat tire
Changing a wheel/mounting the
spare wheel ...................................
MOExtended run-flat system .........
Preparing the vehicle .....................
Raising the vehicle .........................
Floormat .............................................
Front fog lamp (display message) . . .
Fuel
Additives ........................................
Notes .............................................
Premium-grade unleaded gasoline .
Refueling ........................................
Specifications ................................
Troubleshooting .............................
Fuel consumption
Current (on-board computer) .........
Notes .............................................
Fuel filler cap (display message) .....
Fuel filler flap
Emergency release ........................
Opening/closing ............................
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer) ......................................
Fuses
Dashboard fuse box .......................
Fuse allocation chart .....................
253
255
259
254
256
236
193
308
306
306
145
307
148
170
150
197
146
146
170
267
267
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 9
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Index
Fuse box in the engine
compartment ................................. 267
Fuse box in the trunk ..................... 268
Notes ............................................. 266
G
Garage door opener
Clearing the memory .....................
Notes .............................................
Opening/closing the garage door ..
Programming the remote control ...
Gear indicator (on-board
computer) ..........................................
Gear lever ...........................................
Gear or selector lever (cleaning
guidelines) .........................................
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts .........
Genuine wood trim and trim strips
(cleaning instructions) ......................
Glove box ...........................................
235
232
234
232
171
137
248
302
248
216
H
Headlamp cleaning system .............. 109
Adding washer fluid ....................... 241
Notes ............................................. 310
Headlamp mode (daytime driving)
see Daytime running lamps
Headlamps
Cleaning ......................................... 246
Misting up ...................................... 110
Head restraints
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 96
Adjusting (manually) ........................ 95
Adjusting (rear) ................................ 96
Installing/removing (rear) ................ 96
see NECK-PRO head restraints
(except AMG vehicles)
Heating
see Climate control
High beam flasher ............................. 109
Hill start assist .................................. 135
Hood
Closing ........................................... 239
Display message ............................ 200
Opening ......................................... 238
Hydroplaning ..................................... 154
I
Immobilizer .......................................... 66
Instrument cluster
Overview .......................................... 26
Submenu (on-board computer) ...... 178
Warning and indicator lamps ........... 27
Instrument cluster lighting ................ 26
Instrument lighting
see Instrument cluster lighting
Interior lighting
Automatic control .......................... 111
Delayed switch-off (on-board
computer) ...................................... 180
Emergency lighting ........................ 111
Manual control ............................... 111
Reading lamp ................................. 110
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 253
Using ............................................. 256
Jump-starting ..................................... 262
K
KEYLESS-GO
Button ............................................ 132
Convenience closing feature ............ 85
Display message ............................ 202
Locking ............................................ 71
Starting the engine ........................ 133
Unlocking ......................................... 71
Key positions
KEYLESS-GO .................................. 132
SmartKey ....................................... 131
Kickdown ................................... 140, 143
Knee bag .............................................. 38
L
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat
anchors ................................................ 58
License plate lamp (display
message) ............................................ 193
9
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
10
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 10
Version: 3.0.3.6
Index
Lights
Activating/deactivating the
interior lighting delayed switch-off
(on-board computer) ...................... 180
Active light function ....................... 109
Automatic headlamp mode ............ 107
Cornering light function ................. 110
Daytime running lamps .................. 107
Driving abroad ............................... 106
Fog lamps ...................................... 108
Hazard warning lamps ................... 109
High-beam headlamps ................... 108
Light switch ................................... 106
Low-beam headlamps .................... 107
Rear fog lamp ................................ 108
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (on-board computer) . 180
Switching the exterior lighting
delayed switch-off on/off (onboard computer) ............................ 180
Switching the surround lighting
on/off (on-board computer) .......... 180
Light sensor (display message) ....... 194
Loading guidelines ............................ 216
Locking
Automatic ........................................ 78
Emergency locking ........................... 79
From inside the vehicle (central
locking button) ................................. 78
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 181
Low-beam headlamp (display
message) ............................................ 191
Luggage net ....................................... 217
Lumbar support ................................... 97
M
M+S tires ............................................ 154
Main-beam headlamps (display
message) ............................................ 192
Malfunction message
see Display messages
Malfunctions relevant to safety
Reporting ......................................... 21
Manual drive program ...................... 142
Manual transmission
Gear lever ...................................... 137
Pulling away ................................... 134
Shift recommendation ................... 138
Starting .......................................... 133
Matte finish (cleaning
instructions) ...................................... 245
mbrace
Call priority .................................... 230
Display message ............................ 185
Downloading destinations
(COMAND) ..................................... 230
Emergency call .............................. 227
Important safety notes .................. 226
Locating a stolen vehicle ............... 231
MB info call button ........................ 229
Remote vehicle locking .................. 231
Roadside Assistance button .......... 229
Self-test ......................................... 227
System .......................................... 227
Vehicle remote unlocking .............. 231
Mechanical key
Function/notes ................................ 73
Memory card (on-board computer) . 175
Memory function ............................... 102
Menu (on-board computer)
AMG ............................................... 171
Assistance ..................................... 178
Audio ............................................. 175
DVD ............................................... 176
Navigation ..................................... 174
Overview of menus ........................ 169
Service ........................................... 178
Settings ......................................... 178
Telephone ...................................... 176
Trip ................................................ 170
Message memory .............................. 183
Messages
see Display messages
Mirrors
Sun visor ........................................ 222
see Exterior mirrors or Rear-view mirror
MOExtended run-flat system ........... 259
MP3
Operating (on-board computer) ..... 175
see separate operating instructions
Multifunction display ........................ 168
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 11
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Index
Multifunction steering wheel
Operating the on-board computer . 167
Overview .......................................... 28
N
Navigation
On-board computer ....................... 174
see separate operating instructions
NECK-PRO head restraints (except
AMG vehicles)
Operation ......................................... 49
Resetting triggered .......................... 50
Notes on breaking-in a new
vehicle ................................................ 130
O
Occupant Classification System
(OCS)
Faults ............................................... 45
Operation ......................................... 41
System self-test ............................... 44
Occupant safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 55
System overview .............................. 34
Octane number (fuel) ........................ 307
Odometer ........................................... 170
Off-road
4MATIC .......................................... 159
Oil
see Engine oil
On-board computer
AMG menu ..................................... 171
Assistance menu ........................... 178
Audio menu ................................... 175
Convenience submenu .................. 181
Display messages .......................... 183
Factory settings ............................. 182
Important safety notes .................. 166
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 178
Lighting submenu .......................... 180
Message memory .......................... 183
Navigation menu ............................ 174
Operating video DVD ..................... 176
Operation ....................................... 167
Overview of menus ........................ 169
Service menu ................................. 178
Settings menu ............................... 178
Standard display submenu ............ 170
Telephone menu ............................ 176
Time/Date submenu ..................... 179
Trip menu ...................................... 170
Vehicle submenu ........................... 181
Opening and closing the side trim
panels ................................................. 114
Operating system
see On-board computer
Outside temperature
Display ........................................... 167
Overhead control panel
Overview .......................................... 30
Override feature
Rear side windows ........................... 60
P
Paint code number ............................ 303
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) . . . 245
Panic alarm .......................................... 61
Panorama roof with power tilt/
sliding panel
Opening/closing .............................. 89
Resetting ......................................... 90
Parking ............................................... 148
Parking aid
PARKTRONIC ................................. 159
Rear view camera .......................... 162
Parking brake .................................... 149
Parking lamp (display message) ...... 193
Parking lock
Releasing manually (automatic
transmission) ................................. 144
Parking position
Exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side ............................... 101
PARKTRONIC
Activating/deactivating ................. 161
Function/notes ............................. 159
Malfunction .................................... 162
Problem ......................................... 162
Range of the sensors ..................... 159
Warning display ............................. 160
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp (only Canada) ............................. 46
11
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 12
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
12
Index
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp (only USA) ................................... 41
Pedals ................................................. 151
Permanent display (on-board
computer) .......................................... 179
Permanent four-wheel drive
see 4MATIC
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) . 247
Power washers .................................. 244
Power windows
see Side windows
Product information ............................ 18
Program selector button .................. 140
Pulling away
Automatic transmission ................. 134
Manual transmission ...................... 134
R
RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 172
Radio
Changing stations (on-board
computer) ...................................... 175
see separate operating instructions
Range (on-board computer) ............. 170
Rear compartment
Setting the airflow ......................... 124
Setting the air vents ...................... 127
Rear fog lamp (display message) ..... 193
Rear seat backrest
Display message ............................ 201
Folding forwards/back .................. 218
Rear seat backrest (display
message) ............................................ 201
Rear view camera
Function/notes ............................. 162
Rear view camera (cleaning
instructions) ...................................... 247
Rear-view mirror
Anti-glare (manual) .......................... 99
Dipping (automatic) ....................... 101
Rear window blind ............................ 222
Rear window heating
Malfunction .................................... 125
Switching on/off ........................... 125
Refueling ............................................ 145
Remote control
Programming (garage door
opener) .......................................... 232
Reporting
Malfunctions relevant to safety ........ 21
Reserve fuel
Display message ............................ 197
Warning lamp ................................. 210
Restraint systems
see SRS
Reverse gear
Engaging (manual transmission) .... 137
Reversing lamp (display message) . . 193
Roadside Assistance (breakdown) .... 19
Roller blind
see Roller sunblind
Roller sunblind
Opening/closing .............................. 89
Panorama roof with power tilt/
sliding panel ..................................... 89
Rear side windows ......................... 222
Rear window .................................. 222
Roof carrier ........................................ 220
Roof lining and carpets (cleaning
guidelines) ......................................... 249
Route
see Route guidance (on-board
computer)
Route guidance (on-board
computer) .......................................... 174
S
Safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 55
Child restraint systems .................... 56
Occupant Classification System
(OCS) ............................................... 41
Overview of occupant safety
systems ........................................... 34
Safety systems
see Driving safety systems
Seat backrest
Adaptive ........................................... 97
Seat belts
Adjusting the height ......................... 53
Belt force limiters ............................ 54
Cleaning ......................................... 249
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 13
Version: 3.0.3.6
Index
Correct usage .................................. 51
Emergency Tensioning Devices ........ 54
Fastening ......................................... 52
Important safety guidelines ............. 50
Releasing ......................................... 53
Safety guidelines ............................. 35
Special seat belt retractor ............... 58
Warning lamp ................................. 204
Warning lamp (function) ................... 54
Seat heating
Indicator lamp (Malfunction) ............ 98
Seats
Adaptive seat backrests (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 97
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 94
Adjusting (manually and
electrically) ...................................... 94
Adjusting the head restraint ............ 95
Adjusting the lumbar support .......... 97
Cleaning the cover ......................... 248
Correct driver's seat position ........... 92
Important safety notes .................... 93
Storing settings (memory
function) ........................................ 102
Switching seat heating on/off ......... 97
Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 247
Service indicator
see Service interval display
Service interval display .................... 242
Displaying a service message (onboard computer) ............................ 243
Service menu (on-board computer) . 178
Service products
Brake fluid ..................................... 309
Capacities ...................................... 305
Coolant (engine) ............................ 310
Engine oil ....................................... 308
Fuel ................................................ 306
Important safety notes .................. 304
Notes ............................................. 304
Refrigerant (air-conditioning
system) .......................................... 309
Washer fluid ................................... 310
Settings
Factory (on-board computer) ......... 182
On-board computer ....................... 178
SETUP (on-board computer) ............. 171
Shift ranges ....................................... 141
Shift recommendation ...................... 138
Side impact air bag ............................. 39
Side marker lamp (display
message) ............................................ 193
Side windows
Convenience closing feature ............ 84
Convenience opening feature .......... 84
Important safety information ........... 83
Opening/closing .............................. 84
Resetting ......................................... 85
Troubleshooting ............................... 86
Sliding sunroof
Important safety information ........... 86
Troubleshooting ............................... 90
see Panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel
see Tilt/sliding sunroof
SmartKey
Changing the battery ....................... 74
Changing the programming ............. 73
Checking the battery ................. 70, 74
Convenience closing feature ............ 84
Convenience opening feature .......... 84
Display message ............................ 201
Important safety notes .................... 70
Malfunction ...................................... 76
Starting the engine ........................ 133
Snow chains ...................................... 154
Socket ................................................ 224
Dashboard ..................................... 224
Rear compartment ......................... 225
SOS
see mbrace
Spare wheel
Notes/data .................................... 298
Storage location ............................ 254
see Emergency spare wheel
Speedometer
Activating/deactivating
additional speedometer (onboard computer) ............................ 179
Additional speedometer (onboard computer) ............................ 171
Segments ...................................... 167
Setting the unit (on-board
computer) ...................................... 178
13
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 14
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
14
Index
SPORT handling mode
Activating/deactivating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 64
Warning lamp ................................. 208
SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System)
Display message ............................ 185
Introduction ..................................... 34
Warning lamp ................................. 209
Warning lamp (function) ................... 34
Standard display (on-board
computer) .......................................... 170
Starting the engine
Important safety notes .................. 133
Station
see Radio
Steering (display message) .............. 201
Steering wheel
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 98
Adjusting (manually) ........................ 98
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 167
Cleaning ......................................... 248
Important safety notes .................... 98
Memory function (storing
settings) ........................................... 98
Storing settings (memory
function) ........................................ 102
Steering wheel paddle shifters ........ 141
Stowage compartments
Armrest (under) ............................. 217
Glove box ....................................... 216
Stowage space
Cup holders ................................... 220
Important safety information ......... 216
Stowage well
Trunk floor (under) ......................... 219
Submenu (on-board computer)
Convenience .................................. 181
Factory setting ............................... 182
Instrument cluster ......................... 178
Lights ............................................. 180
Standard display ............................ 170
Time/Date ..................................... 179
Vehicle ........................................... 181
Summer opening
see Convenience opening feature
Sun visor ............................................ 221
Supplemental Restraint System
see SRS
Surround lighting (on-board
computer) .......................................... 180
Switching off the alarm (ATA) ............ 67
T
Tachometer ........................................ 167
Tailgate
Display message (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 200
Tail lamps (Display message) ........... 192
Tank content
Fuel gauge ....................................... 26
Technical data ................................... 302
C 250 ............................................. 311
C 250 4MATIC ............................... 311
C 300 ............................................. 311
C 300 4MATIC ............................... 312
C 350 .................................... 312, 313
C 350 4MATIC ............................... 312
Tires/wheels ................................. 293
TELEAID
Call priority .................................... 230
Display message ............................ 185
Downloading destinations
(COMAND) ..................................... 230
Emergency call .............................. 227
Important safety notes .................. 226
Locating a stolen vehicle ............... 231
MB info call button ........................ 229
Remote vehicle locking .................. 231
Roadside Assistance button .......... 229
Self-test ......................................... 227
System .......................................... 227
Vehicle remote unlocking .............. 231
Telephone
Accepting a call ............................. 176
Display message ............................ 201
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 176
Number from the phone book ........ 177
Redialing ........................................ 177
Rejecting/ending a call ................. 177
Telephone compartment .................. 217
Temperature
Coolant .......................................... 166
Coolant (on-board computer) ......... 171
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 15
Version: 3.0.3.6
Index
Engine oil (on-board computer) ...... 171
Outside temperature ...................... 167
Setting ........................................... 123
Theft deterrent locking system
Immobilizer ...................................... 66
Through-loading feature ................... 218
Tilt/sliding sunroof
Opening/closing .............................. 88
Resetting ......................................... 88
Time (on-board computer) ................ 179
Timer (on-board computer) .............. 172
Tire pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 277
Checking manually ........................ 275
Display message ............................ 197
Maximum ....................................... 280
Notes ............................................. 273
Pressure loss warning .................... 275
Recommended ............................... 272
Tire pressure monitoring system
Function/notes ............................. 277
Restarting ...................................... 279
Warning lamp ................................. 212
Tires
Aspect ratio (definition) ................. 292
Average weight of the vehicle
occupants (definition) .................... 290
Bar (definition) ............................... 290
Characteristics .............................. 290
Checking ........................................ 271
Cleaning ......................................... 272
Definition of terms ......................... 290
Direction of rotation ...................... 284
Distribution of the vehicle
occupants (definition) .................... 293
DOT, Tire Identification Number
(TIN) ............................................... 289
DOT (Department of
Transportation) (definition) ............ 290
Flat tire .......................................... 254
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
(definition) ..................................... 291
Guidelines to be observed ............. 271
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
(definition) ..................................... 291
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight
Rating) (definition) ......................... 291
Increased vehicle weight due to
optional equipment (definition) ......
Kilopascal (kPa) (definition) ...........
Labeling (overview) ........................
Load bearing index (definition) ......
Load index .....................................
Load index (definition) ...................
Maximum loaded vehicle weight
(definition) .....................................
Maximum load on a tire
(definition) .....................................
Maximum permissible tire
pressure (definition) .......................
Maximum tire load .........................
Maximum tire load (definition) .......
Optional equipment weight
(definition) .....................................
PSI (pounds per square inch)
(definition) .....................................
Replacing .......................................
Service life .....................................
Sidewall (definition) .......................
Speed index (definition) .................
Storing ...........................................
Structure and characteristics
(definition) .....................................
Temperature ..................................
TIN (Tire Identification Number)
(definition) .....................................
Tire bead (definition) ......................
Tire pressure (definition) ................
Tire pressures (recommended) ......
Tire size (data) ...............................
Tire size designation, load-bearing
capacity, speed index ....................
Tire tread .......................................
Tire tread (definition) .....................
Total load limit (definition) .............
Traction .........................................
Traction (definition) .......................
Tread wear .....................................
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards ......................................
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards (definition) ....................
Unladen weight (definition) ............
Wear indicator (definition) .............
Wheel rim (definition) ....................
291
291
286
292
289
291
291
292
292
284
291
292
292
286
271
292
291
272
290
285
292
292
292
290
293
287
271
292
293
285
292
285
284
290
291
292
291
15
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 16
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
16
Index
Tires and wheels (important safety
information) ....................................... 270
Top Tether ............................................ 59
Towing
Important safety guidelines ........... 264
Installing the towing eye ................ 264
Removing the towing eye ............... 265
Tow-starting
Emergency engine starting ............ 266
Installing the towing eye ................ 266
Removing the towing eye ............... 266
Transfer case ..................................... 144
Transmission position display ......... 138
Transmission positions .................... 139
Trip computer (on-board
computer) .......................................... 170
Trip odometer
Calling up ....................................... 170
Resetting (on-board computer) ...... 171
Trunk
Automatic opening ........................... 81
Emergency release .......................... 82
Important safety guidelines ............. 80
Locking separately ........................... 82
Trunk lid
Display message ............................ 200
Turn signal (display message) ......... 191
Turn signals ....................................... 108
Type plate
see Vehicle identification plate
U
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 79
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 78
V
Vanity mirror
Sun visor ........................................ 222
Vehicle
Data acquisition ............................... 22
Emergency unlocking ....................... 79
Equipment ....................................... 18
Exterior view .................................... 24
Individual settings (on-board
computer) ...................................... 178
Loading .......................................... 280
Lowering ........................................ 258
Maintenance .................................... 19
Parking up ..................................... 150
Raising ........................................... 256
Reporting problems ......................... 21
Towing away .................................. 264
Tow-starting ................................... 264
Transporting .................................. 266
Vehicle data
see Technical data
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 303
Vehicle tool kit .................................. 253
Video (DVD) ........................................ 176
Video DVD (on-board computer) ...... 176
VIN ...................................................... 303
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................ 206
Brakes ........................................... 203
Check Engine ................................. 210
Coolant .......................................... 210
ESP® .............................................. 207
ESP® OFF ....................................... 208
Fuel tank ........................................ 210
Overview .......................................... 27
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
indicator lamp (only Canada) ........... 46
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
indicator lamp (only USA) ................ 41
Reserve fuel ................................... 210
Seat belt ........................................ 204
SPORT handling mode ................... 208
SRS ................................................ 209
Tire pressure monitor .................... 212
Warranty ............................................ 302
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 258
Wheel chock ...................................... 255
Wheels
Changing/replacing ....................... 286
Changing a wheel .......................... 255
Checking ........................................ 271
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 17
Version: 3.0.3.6
Index
Cleaning ......................................... 245
Guidelines to be observed ............. 271
Mounting a wheel .......................... 258
Removing a wheel .......................... 257
Tightening torque ........................... 258
Wheel size/tire size ....................... 293
Window curtain air bag
Display message ............................ 186
Operation ......................................... 40
Windows
see Side windows
Windows (cleaning instructions) ..... 246
Windshield
Defrosting ...................................... 124
Windshield washer fluid (display
message) ............................................ 201
Windshield washer system
Adding washer fluid ....................... 241
Notes ............................................. 310
Windshield wipers
Important safety notes .................. 115
Replacing the wiper blades .... 116, 117
Switching on/off ........................... 116
Troubleshooting ............................. 117
Winter operation ............................... 155
Winter tires
M+S tires ....................................... 154
Wiper blades
Cleaning ......................................... 246
17
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
18
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 18
Version: 3.0.3.6
Introduction
Product information
We recommend using genuine MercedesBenz parts as well as conversion parts and
accessories explicitly approved by us for your
vehicle model.
We have tested these parts to determine their
reliability, safety and special suitability for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles. Despite ongoing
market research, Mercedes-Benz is unable to
assess other parts. We cannot therefore be
held responsible for them, even if in individual
cases an official approval or authorization by
governmental or other agencies should exist.
The use of non-approved parts could affect
your vehicle's operating safety. MercedesBenz therefore recommends that you use
genuine Mercedes-Benz parts, conversion
parts and accessories that have been
approved for the type of vehicle. Genuine
Mercedes-Benz parts, approved conversion
parts and accessories are available from any
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. In
addition, you will receive advice about
permissible technical modifications, and the
parts will be professionally installed.
Operator's Manual
Notes on the Operator's Manual
This Operator's Manual contains a great deal
of helpful information. We urge you to read it
carefully and familiarize yourself with the
vehicle before driving.
For your own safety and longer service life of
the vehicle, we urge you to follow the
instructions and warnings contained in this
Operator's Manual. Ignoring them could
result in damage to the vehicle or personal
injury to you or others. Vehicle damage
caused by failure to follow instructions is not
covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited
Warranty.
Vehicle equipment
This manual describes all the standard and
optional equipment of your vehicle available
at the time of publication of the Operator's
Manual. Country-specific differences are
possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all functions described. This
also refers to safety-related systems and
functions. The equipment in your vehicle may
therefore differ from that shown in the
descriptions and illustrations. All the systems
found in your vehicle are listed in the original
purchase agreement of your vehicle. Should
you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
The Operating Instructions and the
Maintenance Booklet are important
documents and should be kept in the vehicle.
Service and vehicle operation
Service and literature
The Service and Warranty Information
booklet contains detailed information about
the warranties covering your vehicle. Your
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will
replace and repair any factory-fitted parts
based on the terms and conditions of the
following warranties:
RNew
Vehicle Limited Warranty
System Warranty
REmission Performance Warranty
RCalifornia, Connecticut, Maine,
Massachusetts, New York, Pennsylvania,
Rhode Island and Vermont
RState Warranty Enforcement Laws (Lemon
Laws)
REmission
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 19
Version: 3.0.3.6
Introduction
Information for customers in
California
Under California law you may be entitled to a
replacement of your vehicle or a refund of the
purchase price or lease price, if after a
reasonable number of repair attempts
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC and/or its
authorized repair or service facilities fail to fix
one or more substantial defects or
malfunctions in the vehicle that are covered
by its express warranty. During the period of
18 months from original delivery of the
vehicle or the accumulation of 18 000 miles
(approximately 29 000 km) on the odometer
of the vehicle, whichever occurs first, a
reasonable number of repair attempts is
presumed for a retail buyer or lessee if one or
more of the following occurs:
(1) the same substantial defect or
malfunction results in a condition that is
likely to cause death or serious bodily
injury if the vehicle is driven, that defect
or malfunction has been subject to repair
two or more times, and you have directly
notified Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC in
writing of the need for its repair.
(2) the same substantial defect or
malfunction of a less serious nature than
category (1) has been subject to repair
four or more times and you have directly
notified Mercedes-Benz in writing of the
need for its repair.
(3) the vehicle is out of service by reason of
repair of the same or different substantial
defects or malfunctions for a cumulative
total of more than 30 calendar days.
Please send your written notice to:
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
Customer Assistance Center
One Mercedes Drive
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350
Maintenance
The Service and Warranty Information
Booklet describes all necessary maintenance
work that should be performed at regular
intervals.
Always have the Service and Warranty
Information Booklet with you when you bring
the vehicle to an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center. The service advisor will record each
service in the Service and Warranty
Information Booklet for you.
Breakdown assistance
The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance
Program provides factory-trained technical
help in the event of a breakdown. Calls to the
toll-free Roadside Assistance number will be
answered by Mercedes-Benz Customer
Assistance Representatives 24 hours a day,
365 days a year.
1-800-FOR-MERCedes(1-800-367-6372)
(USA)
1-800-387-0100 (Canada)
For additional information refer to the
Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance
Program brochure (in the USA) or the
Roadside Assistance section of the Service
and Warranty Information Booklet (in
Canada) You will find both in your vehicle
literature portfolio.
Change of address or ownership
In the event of a change of address, be sure
to send in the "Change of Address Notice"
found in the Service and Warranty
Information Booklet, or simply call the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center
(in the USA) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes
(1-800-367-6372) or Customer Service (in
Canada) at 1-800-387-0100. This will assist
us in contacting you in a timely manner
should the need arise.
19
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
20
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 20
Version: 3.0.3.6
Introduction
If you sell your Mercedes, please leave all
literature with the vehicle to make it available
to the next operator.
If you bought this vehicle used, be sure to
send in the "Notice of Purchase of Used Car"
found in the Service and Warranty
Information Booklet, or call the MercedesBenz Customer Assistance Center (in the
USA) at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes
(1-800-367-6372) or Customer Service (in
Canada) at 1-800-387-0100.
Vehicle operation outside the USA
and Canada
If you plan to operate your vehicle in foreign
countries, please be aware that:
RService facilities or replacement parts may
not be readily available.
gasoline for vehicles with
catalytic converters may not be available.
The use of leaded fuels can damage the
catalytic converter.
RGasoline may have a considerably lower
octane rating. Improper fuel can cause
engine damage.
Certain Mercedes-Benz models are available
for delivery in Europe under our European
Delivery Program. For details, consult an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or write to
one of the following addresses:
RUnleaded
Operating safety
Safety notes
G Warning
Work improperly carried out on electronic
components and associated software could
cause them to cease functioning. Because the
vehicle's electronic components are
interconnected, any modifications made may
produce an undesired effect on other
systems. Electronic malfunctions could
seriously impair the operating safety of your
vehicle.
Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
for repairs or modifications to electronic
components.
Other improper work or modifications on the
vehicle could also have a negative impact on
the operating safety of the vehicle.
Some safety systems only function when the
engine is running. You should therefore never
turn off the engine while driving.
G Warning
Heavy blows against the vehicle underbody or
tires/wheels may cause serious damage and
impair the operating safety of your vehicle.
Such blows can be caused, for example, by
running over an obstacle, road debris or a
pothole. If you feel a sudden significant
vibration or ride disturbance, or you suspect
that damage to your vehicle has occurred:
In the USA
Rturn
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
European Delivery Department
One Mercedes Drive
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350
Rslow
In Canada
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
European Delivery Department
98 Vanderhoof Avenue
Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9
on your hazard warning flashers.
down carefully.
Rdrive with caution to an area which is a safe
distance from the road.
Inspect the vehicle underbody and tires/
wheels for possible damage. If the vehicle
appears unsafe, have it towed to the nearest
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or other
qualified maintenance or repair facility for
further inspection or repairs.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 21
Version: 3.0.3.6
Introduction
Proper use of the vehicle
In Canada
To ensure proper use of the vehicle, you must
familiarize yourself with the following
information and rules:
Customer Relations Department
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
98 Vanderhoof Avenue
Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9
Rsafety
notes in this Operator's Manual
data in this Operator's Manual
Rtraffic rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
Rtechnical
G Warning!
Various warning labels are attached to your
vehicle. These warning labels are intended to
make you and others aware of various risks.
Do not remove any of these warning labels
unless explicitly instructed to do so by
information on the label itself.
Removing warning labels may cause you and
others to be unaware of certain risks which
may result in an accident and/or personal
injury.
Problems with your vehicle
If you should experience a problem with your
vehicle, particularly one that you believe may
affect its safe operation, we urge you to
contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
immediately to have the problem diagnosed
and rectified. If the problem is not resolved to
your satisfaction, please discuss the problem
with the Mercedes-Benz Center again or, if
necessary, contact us at one of the following
addresses.
In the USA
Customer Assistance Center
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
One Mercedes Drive
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350
Reporting malfunctions relevant to
safety
For the USA only:
The following text is reproduced as required
of all manufacturers according to Title 49,
Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575
pursuant to the National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act of 1966.
Reporting safety defects
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect
which could cause a crash or could cause
injury or death, you should immediately
inform the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to
notifying Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may
open an investigation, and if it finds that a
safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it
may order a recall and remedy campaign.
However, NHTSA cannot become involved in
individual problems between you, your
dealer, or Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle
Safety Hotline toll-free at
1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go
to: http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:
Administrator, NHTSA Headquarters,
1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE, West Building,
Washington, DC 20590.
You can also obtain additional information
about vehicle safety from:
http://www.safercar.gov.
Z
21
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Introduction
22
Limited Warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual
about the proper operation of your vehicle
as well as about possible vehicle damage.
Damage to your vehicle that arises from
culpable contraventions against these
instructions are not covered either by
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty or by the
New or Used-Vehicle Warranty of
Daimler AG.
Data stored in the vehicle
Information regarding electronic
recording devices
(Including California Code Supplement
§ 9951)
Please note that your vehicle is equipped with
devices that can record vehicle systems data.
If your vehicle is equipped with mbrace2 data
is transmitted in the event of an accident.
This information serves, for example, to test
vehicle systems after an accident and to
continually improve vehicle safety.
Daimler AG can access this data and submit
it:
Rfor
safety research or vehicle diagnosis
purposes
Rwith the consent of the vehicle owner or
lessee
Rin response to an official request by law
enforcement or other government agency
Rfor use in arbitration of disputes that
involve Daimler AG, its subsidiaries or its
sales and service organizations
Ras otherwise required or permitted by law
Please observe the mbrace2 order agreement
regarding further details on data that this
system records and transmits.
2
The system is called TELEAID in Canada.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 22
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 23
Version: 3.0.3.6
23
Exterior view .......................................
Cockpit .................................................
Instrument cluster ..............................
Multifunction steering wheel .............
Center console ....................................
Overhead control panel ......................
Door control panel ..............................
24
25
26
28
29
30
31
At a glance
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
24
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 24
Version: 3.0.3.6
Exterior view
At a glance
Exterior view
Function
Trunk lid
Vehicle tool kit
;
Page
Function
Page
C
Exterior mirrors
100
253
D
Windshield wipers
115
Rear window heating
125
E
=
Lights
111
?
Fuel filler flap
145
Opening the hood
Engine oil
Coolant
238
239
240
A
Defrosting the windshield
Cleaning the windows
124
246
F
Towing away
264
G
Tires and wheels
Flat tire
270
254
:
B
Sliding sunroof
86
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 25
Version: 3.0.3.6
Cockpit
25
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
Steering wheel paddle
shifters
141
;
Cruise control lever
156
=
Instrument cluster
26
?
Horn
A
PARKTRONIC warning
display (Canada only)
159
B
Overhead control panel
30
C
Operates the automatic
climate control system
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
:
D
Function
E
F
Page
Adjusts the steering wheel
manually
98
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
98
G
Combination switch
108
H
Parking brake
148
I
On-board diagnostics
socket
J
Opens the hood
238
120
K
Releases the parking brake
148
131
132
L
Light switch
106
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 26
Version: 3.0.3.6
Instrument cluster
26
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Overview
Function
3
Page
:
Fuel gauge
;
Coolant temperature gauge
166
=
Speedometer
167
?
Segments
167
A
Multifunction display
168
B
Tachometer
167
temperature3
C
Outside
D
Outside temperature
Additional speedometer3
Vehicles with automatic transmission.
Function
Gear indicator and drive
program display3
139
F
Clock
179
G
Brightness control knob for
the instrument cluster
lighting: turn clockwise or
anti-clockwise
E
167
167
179
Page
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 27
Version: 3.0.3.6
Instrument cluster
27
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
Page
Function
Page
:
High beam
108
F
ABS
206
;
ESP® OFF
207
G
Seat belt
204
=
Low beam
107
H
Fog lamp
108
?
Turn signal
108
I
Rear fog lamp
108
A
ESP®
207
J
Coolant
210
B
Turn signal
108
K
Brakes (USA only)
203
C
SPORT handling mode in
AMG vehicles
L
Brakes (Canada only)
203
208
M
Check Engine
210
D
Tire pressure monitor
212
N
Reserve fuel
210
E
SRS
209
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
28
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 28
Version: 3.0.3.6
Multifunction steering wheel
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
COMAND/audio system;
see the separate operating
instructions
=
?
~6
Makes/accepts or rejects/
ends a call
WX
Adjusts the volume or
operates the RACETIMER in
AMG vehicles
8
Mute
?
Activates voice control; see
the separate operating
instructions
Page
168
176
172
Function
A
%
Back or deactivates voice
control
B
=;
Selects a menu
9:
Selects the submenu or
scrolls through lists
a
Confirms selections and
hides display messages
Page
169
169
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 29
Version: 3.0.3.6
Center console
29
At a glance
Center console
Function
:
Hazard warning lamps
;
ATA indicator lamp
=
Indicator lamp 45
(USA only)
Indicator lamp 45
(Canada only)
?
Page
109
158
E
Stowage compartment
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
216
223
224
F
Gear lever
Selector lever
137
138
G
Cup holder
220
H
Stowage compartment
216
I
Audio/COMAND controller
J
Selects the drive program
41
46
COMAND/audio system;
see separate operating
instructions
Seat heating
97
B
PARKTRONIC (Canada
only)
159
Rear window roller sunblind
222
Page
Dynamic handling package
with sports mode
D
67
A
C
Function
140
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 30
Version: 3.0.3.6
Overhead control panel
30
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
:
;
=
?
A
B
4
u To switch the rear
interior lighting on/off
Page
111
| To switch the
automatic interior lighting
control on/off
111
p To switch the righthand reading lamp on/off
110
3 To open/close the
tilt/sliding sunroof
3 To open/close the
panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel with roller
sunblinds
Function
Page
C
Rear-view mirror
D
Integrated electronic
compass
235
Buttons for the garage door
opener
232
E
99
F
Microphone for mbrace
(emergency call system)
telephone and Voice
Control System4
G
F Roadside Assistance
button (mbrace system)
229
p To switch the lefthand reading lamp on/off
110
c To switch the front
interior lighting on/off
111
88
89
H
ï Button for MB info call
(mbrace system)
229
I
G SOS button (mbrace
system)
227
The Voice Control System is only available in connection with COMAND. Observe the additional operating
instructions.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 31
Version: 3.0.3.6
Door control panel
31
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
Page
:
Opens the door
78
;
%& Locks/unlocks
the vehicle
78
=
Adjusts the seat electrically
94
?
r45=
Stores settings for the seat,
exterior mirrors and
steering wheel
102
7Zª\
Adjusts and folds the
exterior mirrors in/out
electrically
100
W Opens/closes the
side windows
84
n Activates/
deactivates the override
feature for the side
windows in the rear
compartment
60
o Unlocks the trunk lid
81
A
B
C
D
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
32
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 32
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 33
Version: 3.0.3.6
33
Vehicle equipment ..............................
Occupant safety ..................................
Children in the vehicle ........................
Panic alarm ..........................................
Driving safety systems .......................
Anti-theft systems ..............................
34
34
55
61
61
66
Safety
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
34
Occupant safety
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
Safety
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 34
Version: 3.0.3.6
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
Occupant safety
Overview of occupant safety
In this section you will learn the most
important facts about the restraint system
components of the vehicle.
The restraint systems are:
RSeat
belts
RChild restraint systems
RLATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat anchors
Additional protection is provided by:
RSRS
(Supplemental Restraint System)
head restraints
RAir bag system components with:
- PASSENGER air bag OFF indicator lamp
- USA only: front passenger seat with
Occupant Classification System (OCS)
- Canada only: front passenger seat with
BabySmart™ air bag deactivation system
The different air bag systems work
independently of each other. The protective
functions of the systems work in conjunction
with each other. Not all air bags are deployed
in an accident.
RNECK-PRO
G Warning
Modifications to or work improperly
conducted on restraint system components
or their wiring, as well as tampering with
interconnected electronic systems, can lead
to the restraint systems no longer functioning
as intended.
Air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices
(ETDs), for example, could deploy
inadvertently or fail to deploy in accidents
although the deceleration threshold for air
bag deployment is exceeded. Therefore,
never modify the restraint systems. Do not
tamper with electronic components or their
software.
i See "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 55) for more information on
infants and children traveling with you in
the vehicle and restraints for infants and
children.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Introduction
SRS reduces the risk of occupants coming
into contact with the vehicle's interior in the
event of an accident. It can also reduce the
effect of the forces to which occupants are
subjected during an accident.
SRS consists of:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp
bags
Rair bag control unit (with crash sensors)
Rbelt tensioners
Rbelt force limiters
Rair
SRS warning lamps
SRS functions are checked regularly when
you switch on the ignition and when the
engine is running. Therefore, malfunctions
can be detected in good time.
The 6 SRS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out no later than a few seconds
after the engine is started.
The SRS components are in operational
readiness when the 6 SRS warning lamp
is not lit while the engine is running.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 35
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
G Warning
The SRS self-check has detected a
malfunction if the 6 SRS warning lamp:
Rdoes
not come on at all
to go out approximately 4 seconds
after the engine was started
Rcomes on after the engine was started or
while driving
For your safety, Mercedes-Benz strongly
recommends that you have the system
checked as soon as possible at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center. Otherwise the SRS
may not be activated when it is needed in an
accident, which could result in serious or fatal
injury. The SRS might also deploy
unexpectedly and unnecessarily which could
also result in injury.
In addition, improper work on the SRS creates
a risk of rendering the SRS inoperative or
causing unintended air bag deployment. Work
on the SRS must therefore only be performed
by qualified technicians. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
If it is necessary to modify an air bag system
to accommodate a person with disabilities,
contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
for details. USA only: Call our Customer
Assistance Center at 1-800-FOR-MERCedes
(1-800-367-6372) for details.
Rfails
Safety guidelines for seat belts,
Emergency Tensioning Devices (ETDs)
and air bags
G Warning
RDamaged seat belts or seat belts that have
been subjected to stress in an accident
must be replaced. Their anchoring points
must also be checked. Only use seat belts
installed or supplied by an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
RAir bags and pyrotechnic Emergency
Tensioning Devices (ETDs) contain
perchlorate material, which may require
special handling and regard for the
environment. Check your national disposal
guidelines. California residents, see
www.dtsc.ca.gov/HazardousWaste/
Perchlorate/index.cfm.
RAir bags and ETDs are designed to function
on a one-time-only basis. An air bag or ETD
that has deployed must be replaced.
RDo not pass seat belts over sharp edges.
They could tear.
RDo not make any modification that could
change the effectiveness of the seat belts.
RDo not bleach or dye seat belts as this may
severely weaken them. In a crash they may
not be able to provide adequate protection.
RNo modifications of any kind may be made
to any components or wiring of the SRS.
RDo not change or remove any component
or part of the SRS.
RDo not install additional trim material, seat
covers, badges, etc. over the steering
wheel hub, front-passenger front air bag
cover, outer sides of the seat backrests,
door trim panels, or door frame trims.
RDo not install additional electrical/
electronic equipment on or near SRS
components and wiring.
RKeep area between air bags and occupants
free of objects (e.g. packages, purses,
umbrellas, etc.).
RDo not hang items such as coat hangers
from the coat hooks or handles over the
door. These items may be thrown around in
the vehicle and cause head and other
injuries when the window curtain air bag is
deployed.
RAir bag system components will be hot after
an air bag has inflated. Do not touch them.
RNever place your feet on the instrument
panel, dashboard, or on the seat. Always
keep both feet on the floor in front of the
seat.
RImproper repair work on the SRS creates a
risk of rendering the SRS inoperative or
causing unintended air bag deployment.
Work on the SRS must therefore only be
Z
35
Safety
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Safety
36
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 36
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
performed by qualified technicians.
Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
RFor your protection and the protection of
others, when scrapping the air bag unit or
ETD, our safety instructions must be
followed. These instructions are available
from any authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
RGiven the considerable deployment speed,
required inflation volume, and the material
of the air bags, there is the possibility of
abrasions or other, potentially more serious
injuries resulting from air bag deployment.
If you sell your vehicle, Mercedes-Benz
strongly recommends that you inform the
subsequent owner that the vehicle is
equipped with SRS. Also refer them to the
applicable section in the Operator's Manual.
Air bags
Important safety notes
G Warning
Air bags are designed to reduce the incidence
of injuries and fatalities in certain situations:
Rfrontal
impacts (driver's and frontpassenger front air bags and driver's knee
bag)
Rside impacts (side impact air bags, window
curtain air bags and pelvis air bags)
However, no system available today can
completely eliminate injuries and fatalities.
When the air bags are deployed, a small
amount of powder is released. The powder
generally does not constitute a health hazard
and does not indicate that there is a fire in the
vehicle. In order to prevent potential
breathing difficulties, you should leave the
vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. If you
have any breathing difficulty but cannot get
out of the vehicle after the air bag inflates,
then get fresh air by opening a window or
door.
G Warning
To reduce the risk of injuries during front air
bag inflation, the driver and front-passenger
must always be seated correctly and have
their seat belts fastened accordingly.
For maximum protection in the event of a
collision, you must always be in the normal
seat position with your back against the
backrest. Fasten your seat belt and make sure
that it is correctly positioned on your body.
Since the air bag inflates with considerable
speed and force, a proper seating position
and correct positioning of the hands on the
steering wheel will help to keep you at a safe
distance from the air bag. Occupants who are
not wearing their seat belt, are not seated
properly or are too close to the air bag can be
seriously injured or killed by an air bag as it
inflates with great force instantaneously:
RSit with the seat belt properly fastened in a
position that is as upright as possible with
your back against the seat backrest.
RMove the driver's seat as far back as
possible, still permitting proper operation
of vehicle controls. The distance from the
center of the driver's chest to the center of
the air bag cover on the steering wheel
must be at least 10 inches(25 cm) or more.
You should be able to accomplish this by
adjusting the seat and steering wheel. If
you have any difficulties, please contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
RDo not lean your head or chest close to the
steering wheel or dashboard.
ROnly hold the steering wheel by the rim.
Placing hands and arms inside the rim can
increase the risk and potential severity of
hand/arm injury when the driver front air
bag inflates.
RAdjust the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible from the dashboard when the
seat is occupied.
ROccupants, especially children, should
never place their bodies or lean their heads
in the area of the door where the side
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 37
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
impact air bag inflates. This could result in
serious injuries or death should the side
impact air bag be deployed. Always sit as
upright as possible, wear the seat belt
properly and use an appropriately sized
child restraint, infant restraint or booster
seat recommended for the size and weight
of the child.
RCanada only: children under 12 years may
only sit in the front-passenger seat if they
are seated in a child restraint system which
is compatible with BabySmart™ and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. If the child
restraint system is installed properly, the
front-passenger front air bag is deactivated
in conjunction with the BabySmart™
system installed in the vehicle. Otherwise,
the child could be struck by the air bag
when it inflates in a crash. This could lead
to serious or fatal injuries.
Failure to follow these instructions can result
in severe injuries to you or other occupants.
If you sell your vehicle, it is important that you
make the buyer aware of this safety
information. Be sure to give the buyer this
Operator's Manual.
G Warning
Accident research shows that the safest place
for children in an automobile is in a rear seat.
A side impact air bag related injury may occur
if occupants, especially children, are not
properly seated or restrained when next to a
side impact air bag which needs to deploy
rapidly in a side impact in order to do its job.
To help avoid the possibility of injury, please
follow these guidelines:
(1)
(2)
The air bags are only deployed if the airbag
control unit detects the need for deployment.
Only in the event of such a situation will they
provide their supplemental protection.
The driver and passenger should always wear
their seat belts. Otherwise, it is not possible
for the air bags to provide their supplemental
protection.
In the event of other types of impacts and
impacts below air bag deployment
thresholds, air bags will not deploy. The driver
and passengers will then be protected to the
extent possible by a properly fastened seat
belt. A properly fastened seat belt is also
needed to provide the best possible
protection in a rollover.
Air bags offer supplemental protection but
are not a substitute for seat belts. All vehicle
occupants must fasten their seat belts
regardless of whether your vehicle is
equipped with airbags or not.
It is important for your safety and that of your
passenger to have deployed air bags replaced
and to have any malfunctioning air bags
repaired. This will help to make sure the air
bags continue to perform their protective
function for the vehicle occupants in the
event of a crash.
Front air bags
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 36).
The front air bags increase protection for the
driver's and front-passenger's head and
chest.
Always sit as upright as possible
and use the seat belts properly.
Make sure that children 12 years
old and under use an appropriately
sized child restraint, infant
restraint, or booster seat
recommended for the size and
weight of the child.
Always wear seat belts properly.
Z
37
Safety
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Occupant safety
are inflated with the maximum amount of
propellant gas available.
In impact situations with deceleration or
acceleration values lower than the vehicle
deceleration or acceleration values preset in
the system, the front air bags are not
deployed. You will then be protected by the
seat belt.
Safety
38
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 38
Version: 3.0.3.6
! Vehicles with BabySmart™ (Canada only):
Driver's air bag : deploys in front of the
steering wheel; front-passenger air bag ;
deploys in front of and above the glove box.
They are deployed:
Rin
the event of certain frontal impacts
the system determines that air bag
deployment can offer additional protection
to that provided by the seat belt
Rif the seat belt is fastened
Rindependently of other air bags in the
vehicle
If the vehicle overturns, the front air bags are
generally not deployed unless the system
detects high vehicle deceleration in a
longitudinal direction.
Your vehicle has adaptive, two-stage front air
bags. In the event of a collision, the air bag
control unit evaluates the vehicle
deceleration. When the first deployment
threshold is reached, the front air bag is filled
with enough propellant gas to reduce the risk
of injuries. The front air bag is fully deployed
if a second deployment threshold is exceeded
within a few milliseconds.
Vehicles with OCS (USA only): frontpassenger front air bag deployment is also
influenced by the passenger's weight
category as identified by the Occupant
Classification System (OCS) (Y page 41).
Vehicles with OCS (USA only): the lighter the
passenger side occupant, the higher the
vehicle deceleration rate required for second
stage inflation of the front-passenger front air
bag. In the second stage, the front air bags
Rif
do not place any objects which weigh more
than 20 lb (9 kg) on the front-passenger
seat. This could cause the system to
identify the seat as being occupied. In the
event of an accident, the restraint systems
on the front-passenger side are triggered.
Have restraint systems that have been
triggered replaced.
The front-passenger air bag will only deploy
if:
Rthe
system, based on the OCS weight
sensor readings, detects that the frontpassenger seat is occupied (USA only).
Rthe 45 indicator lamp in the center
console is not lit, USA: (Y page 41),
Canada: (Y page 46).
Rthe impact exceeds a preset deployment
threshold.
Driver's knee bag
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 36).
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 39
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
Rknee
injuries
injuries
Rlower leg injuries
Driver's knee bag : inflates beneath the
steering column. If the system determines
that deployment of driver's knee bag : can
offer additional protection to that provided by
the seat belt in the event of a frontal impact,
the system will deploy it together with the
driver's front air bag. Driver's knee bag :
operates best in conjunction with a properly
positioned and fastened seat belt.
Rthigh
When deployed, the side impact air bags offer
additional protection for the thorax of the
vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle
on which the impact occurs. However, they
do not protect the:
Safety
Driver's knee bag : increases protection for
the driver against the risk of:
Rhead
Rneck
Rarms
Side impact air bags
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 36).
G Warning!
The pressure sensors for side impact air bag
control are located in the doors. Do not
modify any components of the doors or door
trim panels including, for example, the
addition of door speakers.
Improper repair work on the doors or the
modification or addition of components to the
doors create a risk of rendering the side
impact air bags inoperative or causing
unintended air bag deployment. Work on the
doors must therefore only be performed by
qualified technicians. Contact an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
G Warning
Only use seat covers which have been tested
and approved by Mercedes-Benz for your
vehicle model. Using seat covers or other seat
coverings can cause a malfunction of the side
impact air bags and/or the pelvis air bags.
Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
for availability.
39
Side impact air bags : deploy next to the
outer seat cushion.
Side impact air bags : are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently of seat belt use
Rindependently of the front air bags
Rindependently of the Emergency
Tensioning Devices
Side air bags : will not deploy in side
impacts with deceleration rates which do not
exceed the system's preset deployment
thresholds for vehicle deceleration or
acceleration. You will then be protected by
the seat belt.
Vehicles with OCS (USA only): if the OCS
detects that the front-passenger seat is not
occupied and the front-passenger seat belt is
not fastened (the belt tongue is not engaged
in the seat belt buckle), the side impact air
bag on the front-passenger side will not
deploy. The side impact air bag on the frontpassenger side will deploy if the frontpassenger seat belt is fastened, regardless of
Rat
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
40
Occupant safety
whether the front-passenger seat is occupied
or not.
! Vehicles with BabySmart™ (Canada only):
Safety
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 40
Version: 3.0.3.6
do not place any objects which weigh more
than 20 lb (9 kg) on the front-passenger
seat. This could cause the system to
identify the seat as being occupied. In the
event of an accident, the restraint systems
on the front-passenger side are triggered.
Have restraint systems that have been
triggered replaced.
Pelvis air bags
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 36).
Pelvis air bags are not available on AMG
vehicles.
G Warning
Only use seat covers which have been tested
and approved by Mercedes-Benz for your
vehicle model. Using seat covers or other seat
coverings can cause a malfunction of the side
impact air bags and/or the pelvis air bags.
Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
for availability.
Pelvis air bag deployment enhances the level
of protection of the vehicle occupants on the
side of the vehicle on which the impact
occurs.
Pelvis air bags : deploy next to and below
the outer seat cushions. They are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently of seat belt use
Rindependently of the front air bags
Rindependently of the Emergency
Tensioning Devices
Pelvis air bags : will not deploy in side
impacts with deceleration rates which do not
exceed the system’s preset deployment
thresholds for vehicle deceleration or
acceleration. You will then be protected by
the seat belt.
Vehicles with OCS (USA only): if the OCS
detects that the front-passenger seat is not
occupied and the front-passenger seat belt is
not fastened (the belt tongue is not engaged
in the seat belt buckle), the pelvis air bag on
the front-passenger side will not deploy. The
pelvis air bag on the front-passenger side will
deploy if the front-passenger seat belt is
fastened, regardless of whether the frontpassenger seat is occupied or not.
Rat
Window curtain air bags
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 36).
The window curtain air bags enhance the level
of protection for the head (but not chest or
arms) of the vehicle occupants on the side of
the vehicle on which the impact occurs.
The window curtain air bags are integrated
into the side of the roof frame and deploy in
the area extending from the front door (Apillar) to the rear door (C-pillar).
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 41
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
41
The system does not deactivate:
Rthe
side impact air bag
pelvis air bag
Rthe window curtain air bag
Rthe Emergency Tensioning Devices
To be classified correctly, the front passenger
must sit:
Rwith
the seat belt properly fastened
a position that is as upright as possible
with the back against the seat backrest
Rwith their feet on the floor
If the front-passenger's weight is transferred
to another object in the vehicle (e.g. by
leaning on armrests), OCS may not be able to
approximate the occupant's weight category.
If the front passenger seat, the seat cover, or
the seat cushion are damaged, have the
necessary repair work carried out at an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you only use seat
accessories that have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
Both the driver and the front passenger
should observe the 45 indicator lamp
to determine whether or not the front
passenger is positioned correctly.
Rin
Window curtain air bags : are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rregardless of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
Rindependently of seat belt use
Rindependently of the front air bags
Window curtain air bags : will not deploy in
impacts with deceleration rates which do not
exceed the system’s preset deployment
thresholds for vehicle deceleration or
acceleration. You will then be protected by
the seat belt.
Rat
Occupant classification system (OCS)
How the Occupant Classification
System works
The Occupant Classification System (OCS) is
standard equipment in the USA.
OCS categorizes the occupant on the frontpassenger seat by means of a weight sensor.
The front-passenger front air bag is
automatically deactivated for certain weight
categories. The respective status can be
recognized by the 45 indicator lamp.
With the 45 indicator lamp
illuminated, the front-passenger front air bag
is deactivated.
G Warning
If the 45 indicator lamp illuminates
when an adult or someone larger than a small
individual is in the front passenger seat, have
the front passenger reposition himself or
herself in the seat until the 45
indicator lamp goes out.
In the event of a collision, the air bag control
unit will not allow front passenger front air bag
deployment when the OCS has classified the
front passenger seat occupant as weighing as
much as or less than a typical 12-month-old
child in a standard child restraint or if the front
passenger seat is classified as being empty.
When the OCS senses that the front
passenger seat occupant is classified as
being up to or less than the weight of a typical
Z
Safety
Rthe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Safety
42
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 42
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
12-month-old child in a standard child
restraint, the 45 indicator lamp will
illuminate when the engine is started and
remain illuminated. This indicates that the
front passenger front air bag is deactivated.
When the OCS senses that the front
passenger seat is classified as being empty,
the 45 indicator lamp will illuminate
when the engine is started and remain
illuminated. This indicates that the front
passenger front air bag is deactivated.
When the OCS senses that the front
passenger seat occupant is classified as
being heavier than the weight of a typical 12month-old child seated in a standard child
restraint or as being a small individual (such
as a young teenager or a small adult), the
45 indicator lamp will illuminate for
approximately 6 seconds when the engine is
started. Depending on occupant weight
sensor readings from the seat, it will then
remain illuminated or go out. With the
45 indicator lamp illuminated, the
front passenger front air bag is deactivated.
With the 45 indicator lamp out, the
front passenger front air bag is activated.
When the OCS senses that the front
passenger seat occupant is classified as an
adult or someone larger than a small
individual, the 45 indicator lamp will
illuminate for approximately six seconds
when the engine is started and then go out.
This indicates that the front passenger front
air bag is activated.
If the 45 indicator lamp is illuminated,
the front passenger front air bag is
deactivated and will not be deployed.
If the 45 indicator lamp is not
illuminated, the front passenger front air bag
is activated and will be deployed
Rin
the event of certain frontal impacts
Rif the impact exceeds a predetermined
triggering threshold
Rindependent of the side impact air bag or
pelvis air bag
If the front passenger front air bag is
deployed, the rate of inflation will be
influenced by
Rthe rate of vehicle deceleration as assessed
by the air bag control unit
front passenger's weight category as
identified by the OCS
Rthe
For further information, see the section
regarding air bag display messages
(Y page 187).
G Warning
According to accident statistics, children are
safer when properly restrained on the rear
seats than on the front-passenger seat. Thus,
we strongly recommend that children be
placed in the rear seats whenever possible.
Regardless of seating position, children 12
years old and under must be seated and
properly secured in an appropriate infant
restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat
recommended for the size and weight of the
child.
The infant or child restraint must be properly
secured with the vehicle's seat belt, the seat
belt and Top Tether strap, or lower anchors
and Top Tether strap, fully in accordance with
the child seat manufacturer's instructions.
Occupants, especially children, should always
sit as upright as possible, wear the seat belt
properly and use an appropriately sized infant
restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat
recommended for the size and weight of the
child.
Children can be killed or seriously injured by
an inflating air bag. Note the following
important information when circumstances
require you to place a child in the frontpassenger seat:
RYour
vehicle is equipped with air bag
technology designed to deactivate the
front-passenger front air bag in your vehicle
when the system senses the weight of a
typical 12-month-old child or less along
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 43
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
with the weight of a standard appropriate
child restraint on the front-passenger seat.
RA child in a rear-facing child restraint on the
front-passenger seat will be seriously
injured or even killed if the front-passenger
front air bag inflates in a collision which
could occur under some circumstances,
even with the air bag technology installed
in your vehicle. The only means to eliminate
this risk completely is never to place a child
in a rear-facing child restraint in the frontpassenger seat. We therefore strongly
recommend that you always place a child
in a rear-facing child restraint on the rear
seat.
RIf you install a rear-facing child restraint on
the front-passenger seat, make sure the
45 indicator lamp is illuminated,
indicating that the front-passenger front air
bag is deactivated. Should the 45
indicator lamp not illuminate or go out while
the restraint is installed, please check
installation. Periodically check the
45 indicator lamp while driving to
make sure that the 45 indicator
lamp is illuminated. If the 45
indicator lamp goes out or remains out, do
not transport a child on the front-passenger
seat until the system has been repaired.
A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the
front-passenger seat will be seriously
injured or even killed if the front-passenger
front air bag inflates.
RIf you place a child in a forward-facing child
restraint on the front-passenger seat:
- move the seat as far back as possible
- use the proper child restraint
recommended for the age, size and
weight of the child
- secure child restraint with the vehicle's
seat belt according to the child seat
manufacturer's instructions
RFor children larger than the typical 12month-old child, the front-passenger front
air bag may or may not be activated.
43
Deployment of the driver front air bag does
not mean that the front-passenger front air
bag should also have deployed.
OCS may have determined:
Rthat
the seat was unoccupied or occupied
by a weight of up to or less than that of a
typical 12-month-old child seated in a
standard child restraint
Rthat the seat was occupied by a small
individual (e.g. a young teenager or a small
adult) or a child who weighs more than a
typical 12-month-old child in a standard
child restraint system
These are examples of when OCS deactivates
the front-passenger front air bag. The air bag
is deactivated despite the impact fulfilling the
criteria for deploying the driver's front air bag.
If the SmartKey has been removed from the
ignition lock or is in position 0, indicator lamp
45: does not light up.
G Warning
If the red 6 SRS warning lamp in the
instrument cluster and the 45
indicator lamp light up simultaneously, the
OCS is malfunctioning. The front passenger
front air bag will be deactivated in this case.
Have the system checked by qualified
technicians as soon as possible. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Only have the seat repaired or replaced at an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Z
Safety
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
44
Occupant safety
In order to ensure proper operation of the air
bag system and OCS:
RSit with the seat belt properly fastened in a
Safety
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 44
Version: 3.0.3.6
position that is as upright as possible with
your back against the seat backrest.
RWhen seated, a passenger should not
position him/herself in such a way as to
cause the passenger's weight to be lifted
from the seat cushion as this may result in
the OCS being unable to correctly
approximate the passenger's weight
category.
RRead and observe all warnings in this
chapter.
System self-test
The 45 indicator lamp illuminates
when you:
the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock
Ron vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button once or twice
If an adult is seated properly on the passenger
seat and the OCS classifies the occupant as
an adult, the 45 indicator lamp
illuminates and goes out again after
approximately 6 seconds.
If the seat is not occupied and the OCS
classifies the front passenger seat as being
unoccupied, the 45 indicator lamp
will illuminate and not go out.
Rturn
G Warning!
If the 4 5 indicator lamp does not
illuminate, the system is not functioning. You
must contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center before seating any child on the front
passenger seat.
For more information, see "Problems with the
Occupant Classification System"
(Y page 45).
G Warning
Never place anything between seat cushion
and child seat (e.g. a pillow), since it reduces
the effectiveness of the OCS. The underside
and rear side child restraint system must be
placed entirely on the seat cushion and the
backrest of the front-passenger seat
backrest.
If necessary, adjust the tilt of the passenger
seat backrest.
An incorrectly mounted child seat could cause
injuries to the child in case of an accident,
instead of increasing protection for the child.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for
installation of child restraint systems.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 45
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
45
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The 45
indicator lamp
illuminates and
remains illuminated.
The person sitting on
the front-passenger
seat:
OCS is malfunctioning.
X Have OCS checked as soon as possible at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display (Y page 187).
Rweighs
as much as a
typical adult
Rweighs more than a
child
G Warning
If the 45 indicator lamp illuminates and remains illuminated when the weight of a typical
adult or someone larger than a small individual has been detected on the passenger seat, do not
allow any occupant to use the passenger seat until the system has been repaired.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The 45
OCS is malfunctioning.
indicator lamp does not X Make sure there is nothing between the seat cushion and the
illuminate and/or does
child seat.
not remain illuminated. X Check the installation of the child restraint system.
The front-passenger
X Make sure there are no objects applying additional weight onto
seat is:
the seat.
Runoccupied
X If the 45 indicator lamp remains out, have OCS checked
Roccupied with the
as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Do
weight of a typical
not transport a child on the front-passenger seat until OCS has
12-month-old child in
been repaired.
a standard child
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
restraint or less
display (Y page 187).
G Warning
If the 45 indicator lamp does not illuminate or remains out with the weight of a typical
12-month-old child in a standard child restraint or less, or is unoccupied, on the front-passenger
seat, do not transport a child on the front-passenger seat until the system has been repaired.
Z
Safety
Problems with the occupant classification system
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
46
Occupant safety
BabySmart™ air bag deactivation
system
How the air bag deactivation system
functions
Safety
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 46
Version: 3.0.3.6
The BabySmart™ system is standard
equipment in Canada.
G Warning
According to accident statistics, children are
safer when properly restrained on the rear
seats than on the front-passenger seat. For
this reason, Mercedes-Benz strongly advises
that you always secure children in the rear
seats. Regardless of seating position, children
12 years old and under must be seated and
properly secured in an appropriately sized
child restraint system or booster seat
recommended for the size and weight of the
child.
Secure the infant restraint system or child
restraint system, using:
Rthe
vehicle's seat belt
seat belt and a Top Tether belt
Rthe LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat mount
and a Top Tether belt
The child restraint system must be installed
and secured correctly, observing the
manufacturer's installation instructions.
Occupants, especially children, should always
sit as upright as possible, wear the seat belt
properly and use an appropriately sized infant
restraint, toddler restraint, or booster seat
recommended for the size and weight of the
child.
Children can be killed or seriously injured by
an inflating air bag. Observe the following
important information if it is necessary to
carry a child on the front-passenger seat:
Rthe
RChildren under 12 years may only sit in the
front-passenger seat if they are seated in a
child restraint system which is compatible
with BabySmart™ and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. If the child restraint
system is installed properly, the front-
passenger front air bag is deactivated in
conjunction with the BabySmart™ system.
Otherwise, the child could be struck by the
air bag when it inflates in a crash. This could
lead to serious or fatal injury.
RA child in a rear-facing child restraint on the
front-passenger seat will be seriously
injured or even killed if the front-passenger
front air bag inflates in a collision which
could occur under some circumstances,
even with the air bag technology installed
in your vehicle. The only means to eliminate
this risk completely is never to place a child
in a rear-facing child restraint in the frontpassenger seat. We therefore strongly
recommend that you always place a child
in a rear-facing child restraint on the rear
seat.
RIf it is necessary to install a BabySmart™compatible rear-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat, make
sure the 45 indicator lamp is
illuminated. This indicates that the frontpassenger front air bag is deactivated. If the
45 indicator lamp does not light up
or goes out when the child restraint system
is installed, check the anchorages of the
restraint system. Periodically check the
45 indicator lamp while driving to
make sure the 45 is illuminated. If
the 45 indicator lamp goes out or
remains out, do not transport a child on the
front-passenger seat until the system has
been repaired.
A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the
front-passenger seat will be seriously
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 47
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
indicator lamp remains out, do not use the
BabySmart™ child restraint system to carry a
child on the front-passenger seat until the
system has been repaired.
Safety
injured or even killed if the front-passenger
front air bag inflates.
RIf you have to place a child in a forwardfacing child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat, you must:
- move the seat as far back as possible
- use the proper child restraint
recommended for the age, size and
weight of the child
- secure child restraint with the vehicle's
seat belt according to the child seat
manufacturer's instructions
G Warning
The BabySmart™ air bag disabling system
ONLY works with specially adapted child
restraint systems. It does not work with child
restraint systems that are not compatible with
BabySmart™.
Never place anything between the seat
cushion and the child restraint system (e.g. a
cushion), as this reduces the effectiveness of
the BabySmart™ air bag deactivation system.
The underside of the child restraint system
must lie against the seat cushion of the frontpassenger seat. In the event of an accident,
an incorrectly installed child restraint system
could injure the child instead of offering
protection.
Observe the manufacturer's instructions
when installing special child restraint
systems.
G Warning
When using a BabySmart™-compatible child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat,
the front-passenger front air bag is only
disabled if the 45 indicator lamp is
illuminated.
Check the 45 indicator lamp
repeatedly, every time you use a
BabySmart™-compatible child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat. Should
the 45 indicator lamp not illuminate
or go out while the restraint is installed,
please check installation. If the 45
47
Special child restraint systems which are
compatible with BabySmart™ are necessary
for deactivating the front-passenger front air
bag. When the special child restraint system
which is compatible with BabySmart™ is
installed correctly and is recognized by the
sensor system in the front-passenger seat,
the front-passenger front air bag is
deactivated. In this case, 45 indicator
lamp : illuminates. If you have any
questions regarding the special child
restraint systems which are compatible with
BabySmart™, consult an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
If the key has been removed from the ignition
lock or is in position 0, indicator lamp
45: does not light up.
The system does not deactivate:
Rthe
side impact air bag
pelvis air bag
Rthe window curtain air bag
Rthe Emergency Tensioning Devices
Rthe
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
48
Occupant safety
System self-test
The 45 indicator lamp illuminates
when you:
the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock
Ron vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start-Stop button once or twice
The 45 indicator lamp goes out again
after approximately six seconds.
If the 45 indicator lamp does not
illuminate or is lit continuously, the system is
malfunctioning. Before transporting a child
on the front-passenger seat, have the
BabySmart™ system checked at an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
For more information, see "Problems with the
air bag deactivation system" section
(Y page 49)
Safety
Rturn
G Warning
Do not place powered-on laptops, mobile
phones, electronic tags such as those used in
ski passes or similar electronic devices on the
front passenger seat. Signals from such
devices may interfere with the BabySmart™
air bag deactivation system. Such signal
interference may cause the 45
indicator lamp not to come on during self-test.
The 6 SRS indicator lamp and/or the
45 indicator lamp could be
continuously lit, indicating that the system is
not functioning. The front-passenger front air
bag could deploy inadvertently or fail to
deploy in an accident.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 48
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 49
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
49
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The 45
indicator lamp
illuminates and
remains illuminated.
A special BabySmart™ compatible child restraint system is
installed on the front-passenger seat.
The front-passenger front air bag is therefore deactivated.
A BabySmart™-compatible child restraint system is not installed
on the front-passenger seat. The BabySmart™ system is
malfunctioning.
X Have the BabySmart™ system checked as soon as possible at
an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
G Warning
If the 45 indicator lamp illuminates and remains illuminated when the weight of a typical
adult or someone larger than a small individual has been detected on the passenger seat, do not
allow any occupant to use the passenger seat until the system has been repaired.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The 45
The BabySmart™ system is malfunctioning.
indicator lamp does not X Make sure there is nothing between the seat cushion and the
illuminate or does not
child seat.
remain illuminated with X Check the installation of the child restraint system.
a BabySmart™X If the 45 indicator lamp does not illuminate, have the
compatible child
BabySmart™ system checked as soon as possible at an
restraint system
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
properly installed on
Do not transport a child on the front-passenger seat until the
the front-passenger
child seat recognition system has been repaired.
seat.
NECK-PRO head restraints (except
C63 AMG)
The NECK-PRO head restraints increase
protection for the driver's and frontpassenger's head and neck. In the event of a
rear collision of a certain severity, the head
restraints on the driver's and the frontpassenger seats are moved forwards and
upwards. This provides better head support.
G Warning
Do not secure any objects (e.g. coat hangers)
on the NECK-PRO head restraints. Otherwise,
the NECK-PRO head restraints may not
function properly, or in the event of a rear-end
collision may not be able offer the level of
protection they are designed to provide.
G Warning
Only use seat covers/head restraint covers
that have been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz for your model.
Using seat covers and head restraint covers
other than those recommended may cause a
malfunction when NECK-PRO head restraints
are triggered or front side impact air bags/
Z
Safety
Problems with the air bag deactivation system
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
50
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 50
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Safety
pelvis air bags may be prevented from
deploying.
Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
for availability.
If the NECK-PRO head restraints have been
triggered in an accident, you must reset the
NECK-PRO head restraints on the driver's and
front-passenger seat (Y page 50).
Otherwise, the additional protection will not
be available in the event of another rear-end
collision. You can recognize that NECK-PRO
head restraints have been triggered by the
fact that they have moved forwards and can
no longer be adjusted.
G Warning!
For your protection, drive only with properly
positioned head restraints.
Adjust the head restraint so that it is as close
to the head as possible and the center of the
head restraint supports the back of the head
at eye level. This will reduce the potential for
injury to the head and neck in the event of an
accident or similar situation.
Resetting triggered NECK-PRO head
restraints (except AMG vehicles)
G Warning
For safety reasons, have the NECK-PRO head
restraints checked at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center after a rear-end
collision.
G Warning
When pushing back the NECK-PRO head
restraint cushion, make sure your fingers do
not become caught between the head
restraint cushion and the cover. Failure to
observe this could result in injuries.
i Resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints
requires a lot of strength. If you have
difficulty resetting the NECK-PRO head
restraints, have this work carried out at a
X
Press the base of the NECK-PRO head
restraint cushion back in the direction of
arrow ; as far as it will go.
X Push the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion
down into the guide in the direction of
arrow = as far as it will go.
X Firmly fold the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion back in the direction of arrow :
until it engages.
X Repeat this procedure for the second
NECK-PRO head restraint.
Seat belts
Important safety notes
The use of seat belts and infant and child
restraint systems is required by law in all 50
states, the District of Columbia, the U.S.
territories and all Canadian provinces.
Even where this is not the case, all vehicle
occupants should have their seat belts
fastened when the vehicle is in motion.
i See "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 55) for more information on
infants and children traveling with you in
the vehicle and restraints for infants and
children.
G Warning!
Always fasten your seat belt before driving off.
Always make sure all of your passengers are
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 51
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
properly restrained. You and your passengers
should always wear seat belts.
Failure to wear and properly fasten and
position your seat belt greatly increases your
risk of injuries and their likely severity in an
accident.
If you are ever in an accident, your injuries can
be considerably more severe without your
seat belt properly buckled. Without your seat
belt buckled, you are much more likely to hit
the interior of the vehicle or be ejected from
it. You can be seriously injured or killed.
In the same crash, the possibility of injury or
death is lessened if you are properly wearing
your seat belt. The air bags can only protect
as intended if the occupants are properly
wearing their seat belts.
G Warning
Never ride in a moving vehicle with the seat
backrest in an excessively reclined position as
this can be dangerous. You could slide under
the seat belt in a collision. If you slide under
it, the seat belt would apply force at the
abdomen or neck. That could cause serious
or even fatal injuries. The seat backrest and
seat belt provide the best restraint when the
wearer is in a position that is as upright as
possible and the seat belt is properly
positioned on the body.
G Warning
Never let more people ride in the vehicle than
there are seat belts available. Make sure
everyone riding in the vehicle is correctly
restrained with a separate seat belt. Never
use a seat belt for more than one person at a
time.
G Warning
Damaged seat belts or seat belts that have
been subjected to stress in an accident must
be replaced and their anchoring points must
also be checked.
Only use seat belts which have been approved
by Mercedes-Benz.
Do not make any modifications to the seat
belts. This can lead to unintended activation
of the ETDs or to their failure to activate when
necessary.
Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may
severely weaken them. In a crash they may
not be able to provide adequate protection.
Have all work carried out only by qualified
technicians. Contact an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
Correct use of the seat belt
G Warning
USE SEAT BELTS PROPERLY
RSeat
belts can only work when used
properly. Never wear seat belts in any other
way than as described in this section, as
that could result in serious injuries in the
event of an accident.
REach occupant should wear their seat belt
at all times, because seat belts help reduce
the likelihood of and potential severity of
injuries in accidents, including rollovers.
The integrated restraint system includes
SRS (driver front air bag, driver's side knee
bag, front-passenger front air bag, side
impact air bags, pelvis air bags, window
curtain air bags for the side windows),
Emergency Tensioning Devices, seat belt
force limiters, and front seat knee bolsters.
The system is designed to enhance the
protection offered to properly belted
occupants in certain frontal (front air bags,
driver's side knee bag, and ETDs) and side
(side impact air bags, pelvis air bags,
window curtain air bags, and ETDs) impacts
which exceed preset deployment
thresholds.
RNever wear the shoulder belt under your
arm, across your neck or off your shoulder.
In a frontal crash, your body would move
too far forward. That would increase the
chance of head and neck injuries. The seat
belt would also apply too much force to the
ribs or abdomen, which could severely
Z
51
Safety
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Safety
52
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 52
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
injure internal organs such as your liver or
spleen.
Adjust the seat belt so that the shoulder
section is located as close as possible to
the middle of the shoulder. It should not
touch the neck. Never pass the shoulder
portion of the seat belt under your arm.
RPosition the lap belt as low as possible on
your hips and not across the abdomen. If
the lap belt is positioned across your
abdomen, it could cause serious injuries in
a crash.
RNever wear seat belts over rigid or
breakable objects in or on your clothing,
such as eyeglasses, pens, keys etc., as
these might cause injuries.
RMake sure the seat belt is always fitted
snugly. Take special care of this when
wearing loose clothing.
RNever use a seat belt for more than one
person at a time. Do not fasten a seat belt
around a person and another person or
other objects at the same time.
RSeat belts should not be worn twisted. In a
crash, you would not have the full width of
the seat belt to distribute impact forces.
The twisted seat belt against your body
could cause injuries.
RPregnant women should also always use a
lap-shoulder belt. The lap belt portion
should be positioned as low as possible on
the hips to avoid any possible pressure on
the abdomen.
RPlace the seat backrest in a position that is
as upright as possible.
RCheck your seat belt during travel to make
sure it is properly positioned.
RNever place your feet on the instrument
panel, dashboard, or on the seat. Always
keep both feet on the floor in front of the
seat.
RWhen using a seat belt to secure infant
restraints, toddler restraints, or children in
booster seats, always follow the child seat
manufacturer's instructions.
G Warning
Do not pass seat belts over sharp edges. They
could tear.
Do not allow the seat belt to get caught in the
door or in the seat adjustment mechanism.
This could damage the seat belt.
Never attempt to make modifications to seat
belts. This could impair the effectiveness of
the seat belts.
Fastening seat belts
G Warning
According to accident statistics, children are
safer when properly restrained on the rear
seats than on the front-passenger seat. Thus,
we strongly recommend that children be
placed in the rear seat whenever possible.
Regardless of seating position, children 12
years old and under must be seated and
properly secured in an appropriately sized
child restraint system or booster seat
recommended for the size and weight of the
child. For additional information, see the
"Children in the vehicle" section.
A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is
significantly increased if the child restraints
are not properly secured in the vehicle and/
or the child is not properly secured in the child
restraint.
G Warning
Canada only: children 12 years old and under
may ride on the front seat if a BabySmart™
compatible child restraint system is installed
on the front-passenger seat. Use only
Mercedes-Benz approved BabySmart™
compatible child restraint systems. A
BabySmart™ compatible child restraint
system will deactivate the front-passenger
front air bag when installed correctly. The
front-passenger front air bag will not be
deactivated if the child restraint systems that
are installed are not BabySmart™ compatible
or if BabySmart™ compatible child restraint
systems are not installed correctly. If the
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 53
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
Seat belt outlet height adjustment
You can adjust the seat belt height on the
driver's seat and the front-passenger seat.
Safety
front-passenger front air bag is deployed in a
collision, the child will be struck by the air bag.
If this happens, serious or fatal injury will
result.
53
X
Adjust the seat and move the backrest to
an almost vertical position (Y page 92).
X Pull the seat belt smoothly through belt
sash guide :.
X Without twisting it, guide the shoulder
section of the seat belt across the middle
of your shoulder and the lap section across
your hips.
X Engage belt tongue ; in buckle =.
X If necessary, adjust the seat belt to the
appropriate height (Y page 53).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
All seat belts in the vehicle, except the
driver's seat belt, are equipped with a special
seat belt retractor to secure child restraint
systems properly. For further information on
"Special seat belt retractors", see
(Y page 58).
For more information about releasing the seat
belt with release button ?, see "Releasing
seat belts" (Y page 53).
Adjust the height so that the upper part of the
seat belt is routed across the center of your
shoulder.
X To raise: slide the belt sash guide upwards.
The belt sash guide engages in various
positions.
X To lower: press and hold belt sash guide
release :.
X Slide the belt sash guide downwards.
X Release belt sash guide release : and
make sure that the belt sash guide has
engaged.
Releasing seat belts
X
Press release button ? (Y page 52) and
guide belt tongue ; back towards belt
sash guide :.
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled
up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue
will be trapped in the door or in the seat
mechanism. This could damage the door,
the door trim panel and the seat belt.
Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfill
their protective function and must be
replaced. Consult an authorized MercedesBenz Center.
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Safety
54
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 54
Version: 3.0.3.6
Occupant safety
Belt warning for driver and front
passenger
or
Regardless of whether the driver's and frontpassenger seat belts have already been
fastened, the 7 seat belt warning lamp
lights up for six seconds each time the engine
is started. It then goes out once the driver and
the front passenger have fastened their seat
belts.
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened after
the engine is started, an additional warning
tone will sound. The warning tone goes out
after approximately six seconds or once the
driver's seat belt is fastened.
If, after six seconds, the driver or frontpassenger have not fastened their seat belts
and the doors are closed:
i For more information on the 7 seat
Rthe
7 seat belt warning lamp remains
illuminated as long as either the driver's or
front-passenger seat belt is not fastened.
Rif the vehicle speed exceeds 15 mph
(25 km/h), the 7 seat belt warning
lamp lights up. Additionally, a warning tone
will sound with increasing intensity for a
maximum of 60 seconds or until the
driver's and front-passenger seat belt are
fastened.
If the driver/front passenger unfasten their
seat belt while the vehicle is in motion, the
7 seat belt warning lamp lights up and a
warning tone sounds again.
The warning tone ceases even if the driver or
front passenger have still not fastened their
seat belt after 60 seconds. The 7 seat belt
warning lamp stops flashing but remains
illuminated.
After the vehicle comes to a standstill, the
warning tone is reactivated and the 7 seat
belt warning lamp flashes again if the vehicle
speed again exceeds 15 mph (25 km/h) .
The 7 seat belt warning lamp only goes
out if:
Rboth
the driver and the front passenger
have fastened their seat belts.
Rthe vehicle is stationary and a door is open.
belt warning lamp, see "Indicator and
warning lamps in the instrument cluster,
seat belt" (Y page 204).
Emergency Tensioning Devices and
seat belt force limiters
The front seat belts and the outer seat belts
in the rear are equipped with ETDs and belt
force limiters.
! If the front-passenger seat is not
occupied, do not engage the seat belt
tongue in the buckle on the frontpassenger seat. Otherwise, the Emergency
Tensioning Device could be triggered in the
event of an accident.
The ETDs tighten the seat belts in an accident,
pulling them close against the body.
ETDs do not correct incorrect seat positions
or incorrectly fastened seat belts.
ETDs do not pull vehicle occupants back
towards the backrest.
Seat belt force limiters, when activated, are
employed to help reduce the force exerted by
the seat belts on occupants during a crash.
The front belt force limiters are synchronized
with the front air bags, which take on a part
of the deceleration force. Thus, the force
exerted on the occupant is distributed over a
greater area.
The ETDs can only be activated if:
Rthe
ignition is switched on.
restraint systems are operational; see
"SRS warning lamp" (Y page 34).
Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on
each of the lap-shoulder belts in the front.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied and
the belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on
the front-passenger side.
Rthe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 55
Version: 3.0.3.6
Children in the vehicle
The ETDs on the outside seats in the rear
compartment are triggered independently of
the lock status of the seat belts.
The ETDs are triggered depending on the type
and severity of an accident:
Rin
the event of a head-on or rear-end
collision if the vehicle decelerates or
accelerates rapidly in a longitudinal
direction during the initial stages of the
impact
Rin the event of a side impact, on the side
opposite the impact if the vehicle
decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a
lateral direction
If the Emergency Tensioning Devices (ETDs)
are triggered, you will hear a bang, and a small
amount of powder may also be released. Only
in rare cases will the bang affect your hearing.
The powder that is released generally does
not constitute a health hazard. The 6 SRS
warning lamp lights up.
G Warning
Pyrotechnic ETDs that were activated must be
replaced.
For your safety, when disposing of the
pyrotechnic ETDs always follow our safety
instructions. These are available at any
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
55
Children in the vehicle
Important safety notes
G Warning
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the
SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle.
Do not leave children unattended in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised
access to a vehicle could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury. The children
could:
Rinjure
themselves on parts of the vehicle
seriously or fatally injured through
excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold
Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with
vehicle equipment that can be operated
even if the SmartKey is removed from the
ignition lock or removed from the vehicle,
such as seat adjustment, steering wheel
adjustment, or the memory function
If children open a door, they could injure other
persons or get out of the vehicle and injure
themselves or be injured by following traffic.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. The child restraint system's
metal parts, for example, could become very
hot, and the child could be burned on these
parts.
Rbe
G Warning!
Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the
passenger compartment or trunk unless they
are firmly secured in place.
Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo
increases a child's risk of injury in the event
of
Rstrong
braking maneuvers
changes of direction
Ran accident
Rsudden
Z
Safety
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Children in the vehicle
56
If an infant or child is traveling in the vehicle:
X
Safety
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 56
Version: 3.0.3.6
Secure the child using an infant or child
restraint system appropriate to the age and
weight of the child.
X Make sure that the infant or child is
properly secured at all times while the
vehicle is in motion.
Child restraint systems
Important safety notes
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 55).
We recommend all infants and children be
properly restrained using the child restraint
systems at all times while the vehicle is in
motion.
The use of infant or child restraints is required
by law in all 50 states, the District of
Columbia, the U.S. territories and all
Canadian provinces.
Infants and small children should always be
seated in an infant or child seat restraint
system appropriate for the size and weight of
the child. They must be properly secured in
accordance with the manufacturer's
installation instructions for the infant or child
seat restraint system. All infant and child seat
restraint systems must comply with the US
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213
and 225 and Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety
Standards 213 and 210.2.
A statement by the child restraint
manufacturer of compliance with these
standards can be found on the instruction
label on the restraint system. You will also
find the statement in the instruction manual
provided with the child restraint system.
When using an infant restraint system, child
restraint system or booster seat, make sure
to carefully read and follow all manufacturer's
instructions for installation and use.
Please read the warning labels affixed to the
interior of the vehicle or to the infant restraint
or child restraint system.
G Warning
Accident statistics show that children
secured in the rear seats are safer than
children secured in the front-passenger seat.
For this reason, we strongly advise that you
always secure children in the rear seats.
Regardless of the seat position, children
under 12 years must be secured correctly in
a suitable infant or child restraint system or
booster seat suitable for the size and weight
of the child.
The infant or child restraint system must be
correctly secured using the vehicle's seat
belt, the seat belt and Top Tether belt or the
lower anchorages and the Top Tether belt in
complete accordance with the child seat
manufacturer's instructions.
Occupants, in particular children, must sit as
upright as possible, fasten the seat belt
correctly and use a suitable infant restraint
system, child restraint system or booster seat
suitable for the size and weight of the child.
Children can be seriously or even fatally
injured by an air bag deploying. Observe the
following important information if it is
absolutely necessary to carry a child on the
front-passenger seat:
RUSA
only: Your vehicle is equipped with air
bag technology that is designed to
deactivate the front-passenger front air
bag, when the system on the frontpassenger seat detects the weight of a
typical 12-month old child in a standard
child restraint.
RUSA only: For children that weigh more
than a typical 12-month old child, the frontpassenger front air bag can be activated or
deactivated. Always make sure that the
45 indicator lamp is illuminated
indicating that the front-passenger front air
bag is deactivated.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 57
Version: 3.0.3.6
Children in the vehicle
RCanada
only: Children 12 years old and
under may ride on the front seat if a
BabySmart™ compatible child restraint
system is installed on the front-passenger
seat. Use only Mercedes-Benz approved
BabySmart™ compatible child restraint
systems. A BabySmart™ compatible child
restraint system will deactivate the frontpassenger front air bag when installed
correctly. The front-passenger front air bag
will not be deactivated if the child restraint
systems that are installed are not
BabySmart™ compatible or if BabySmart™
compatible child restraint systems are not
installed correctly. If the front-passenger
front air bag is deployed in a collision, the
child could be struck by the air bag. This
could lead to serious or fatal injury.
RA child in a rear-facing child restraint on the
front-passenger seat will be seriously
injured or even killed if the front-passenger
front air bag inflates in a collision which
could occur under some circumstances,
even with the air bag technology installed
in your vehicle. The only way to completely
rule out this risk is by making sure you
never place a child in a rearward-facing
child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat. For this reason, we
strongly advise that you always carry
children in a rearward-facing child restraint
system on a rear seat.
RIf you must install a rear-facing child
restraint on the front-passenger seat
because circumstances require you to do
so, make sure the 45 indicator lamp
is illuminated, indicating that the frontpassenger front air bag is deactivated. If the
45 indicator lamp does not light up
or goes out when the child restraint system
is installed, check the anchorages of the
restraint system. Check the 45
indicator lamp regularly while driving to
ensure that the 45 indicator lamp is
illuminated. If the 45 indicator lamp
goes out or remains out, you may only carry
a child on the front-passenger seat once
the system has been repaired.
A child in a rear-facing child restraint on the
front-passenger seat will be seriously
injured or even killed if the front-passenger
front air bag inflates.
Rwhen securing a child in a child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat, you
must:
- move the front-passenger seat as far
back as possible
- use a child restraint system that is
suitable for the age, size and weight of
the child
- observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions in order to install and secure
the child restraint system correctly.
G Warning
Infants and small children should never share
a seat belt with another occupant. During an
accident, they could be crushed between the
occupant and seat belt.
A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is
significantly increased if the child restraints
are not properly secured in the vehicle and/
or the child is not properly secured in the child
restraint.
Children too big for a toddler restraint must
ride in seats using regular seat belts. Position
the shoulder belt across the chest and
shoulder, not face or neck. A booster seat
may be necessary to achieve proper seat belt
positioning for children over 41 lb (18 kg) until
they reach a height where a lap/shoulder belt
fits properly without a booster.
When the child restraint is not in use, remove
it from the vehicle or secure it with the seat
belt to prevent the child restraint from
becoming a projectile in the event of an
accident.
Z
57
Safety
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Children in the vehicle
58
Special seat belt retractor
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 55).
Safety
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 58
Version: 3.0.3.6
All seat belts in the vehicle, except the
driver's seat belt, are equipped with a special
seat belt retractor. When activated, the
special seat belt retractor ensures that the
seat belt cannot slacken after being fastened.
Installing a child restraint system:
X
Always comply with the manufacturer's
installation instructions.
X Pull the seat belt smoothly from the inertia
reel.
X Engage the seat belt tongue in the belt
buckle.
Activating the special seat belt retractor:
X
Pull the seat belt out fully and let the inertia
reel retract it again.
While the seat belt is retracting, you should
hear a ratcheting sound. The special seat
belt retractor function is enabled.
X Push down on the child restraint system to
take up any slack.
Removing a child restraint system/
deactivating the special seat belt retractor:
X
Always comply with the manufacturer's
installation instructions.
X Press the seat belt release button and
guide the belt tongue to the belt outlet.
The special seat belt retractor function is
deactivated.
G Warning
Never release the seat belt buckle while the
vehicle is in motion, since the special seat belt
retractor will be deactivated.
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat anchors
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 55).
G Warning
Children that are too large for a child restraint
must travel in seats using normal seat belts.
Position shoulder belt across the chest and
shoulder, not face or neck.
In order to attain the correct seating position
for children weighing over 41 lb (18 kg), it may
be necessary to use a booster seat until they
reach a height where a normal lap/shoulder
seat belt lies properly across their bodies
without the need for a booster seat.
Install the child restraint system according to
the manufacturer's instructions.
The child restraint system must be installed
firmly on both brackets.
An incorrectly installed child restraint system
can come loose in the event of an accident,
causing the child to be severely or fatally
injured.
Child restraint systems/child restraint
retaining brackets that are damaged or have
suffered damage due to an impact must be
replaced.
ISOFIX is a standardized securing system for
specially designed child restraint systems on
the rear seats. Securing rings for two LATCHtype (ISOFIX) child restraint systems are
installed on the left and right of the rear seats.
Use the vehicle's seat belts to install child
restraint systems without the ISOFIX
securing system. Follow the manufacturer's
instructions for of child restraint systems.
! When installing the child restraint system,
make sure that the seat belt for the center
seat does not get trapped. Otherwise, the
seat belt could be damaged.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 59
Version: 3.0.3.6
Children in the vehicle
Vehicles without a through-loading feature in the
rear bench seat
Installation instruction : indicates the
installation point of securing ring =.
X
Remove protective caps ; from securing
rings = by pulling in the direction of the
arrow.
occupied by passengers. Lock the rear seat
backrests in their upright position before
installing the Top Tether straps or when the
cargo compartment is not in use. Make sure
that rear seat backrests are secured properly
by pushing and pulling on the seat backrests.
If the seat backrest is not locked properly, the
seat backrest could fold forward. The child
restraint system is no longer supported
properly or held in position and can no longer
fulfill its function. This could cause serious or
even fatal injuries.
Top Tether provides an additional attachment
point between the "LATCH" type child seat
mount (ISOFIX) child restraint system and the
rear seat. This can further reduce the risk of
injury.
The Top Tether anchorages are located in the
rear compartment behind the head restraints.
Vehicles with a through-loading feature in the rear
bench seat
X
Install the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system. Comply with the
manufacturer's instructions when
installing the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system.
Top Tether
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 55).
G Warning
Always lock the rear seat backrests in their
upright position when the rear seats are
X
Move head restraint : upwards.
X Fold up cover ; of Top Tether anchorage
=.
Z
59
Safety
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 60
Version: 3.0.3.6
Children in the vehicle
60
Safety
X
Route Top Tether belt A under the head
restraint : between both head restraint
bars.
X Hook Top Tether hook ? into Top Tether
anchorage =.
X Make sure that Top Tether belt A is not
twisted.
X Fold down cover ; of Top Tether
anchorage =.
X If necessary, push head restraint : back
down slightly (Y page 96). Make sure that
the routing of Top Tether belt A is not
impaired.
X Install the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system with Top Tether. Always
comply with the manufacturer's
installation instructions. Make sure that
Top Tether belt A is taut.
Child-proof locks
Child-proof locks for the rear doors
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 55).
G Warning
Children could open a rear door from inside
the vehicle. This could result in serious
injuries or an accident. Therefore, when
children ride in the rear always secure the rear
doors with the child-proof locks.
X
To activate: press the child-proof lock
lever up in the direction of arrow :.
X Make sure that the child-proof locks are
working properly.
X
To deactivate: press the child-proof lock
lever down in the direction of arrow ;.
Override feature for the rear side
windows
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 55).
G Warning
When children ride on the vehicle's rear seats,
activate the override switch. Otherwise, the
children could be injured, e.g. by trapping
themselves in the rear side window.
You can secure each door individually with
the child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door
secured with a child-proof lock cannot be
opened from inside the vehicle. When the
vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened
from the outside.
X
To activate/deactivate: press button ;.
If indicator lamp : is lit, operation of the
rear side windows is disabled. Operation is
only possible using the switches in the
driver's door. If indicator lamp : is off,
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 61
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving safety systems
operation is possible using the switches in
the rear compartment.
Panic alarm
This device complies with the RSS-210
regulations of Industry Canada. Operation
is subject to the following two conditions:
1. This device may not cause interference,
and
2. This device must withstand any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation of the device.
Any unauthorized modification to this
device could void the user's authority to
operate the equipment.
Driving safety systems
X
To activate: press and hold !
button : for about one second.
An alarm sounds and the exterior lighting
flashes.
X To deactivate: press ! button :
again.
or
X Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock.
or
X Press the KEYLESS-GO Start-Stop button.
The KEYLESS-GO key must be in the
vehicle.
i USA only:
This device complies with the part 15 of the
FCC regulations. Operation is subject to
the following two conditions:
1. This device may not cause interference,
and
2. This device must withstand any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Any unauthorized modification to this
device could void the user's authority to
operate the equipment.
i Canada only:
Overview of driving safety systems
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
RBAS (Brake Assist System)
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
REBD (Electronic Brake-power Distribution)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE
Important safety notes
G Warning
The following factors increase the risk of
accidents:
RExcessive
speed, especially in turns
and slippery road surfaces
RFollowing another vehicle too closely
The driving safety systems described in this
section cannot reduce these risks or prevent
the natural laws of physics from acting on the
vehicle. They cannot increase braking or
steering efficiency beyond that afforded by
the condition of the vehicle brakes and tires
or the traction afforded.
Only a safe, attentive, and skillful driver can
prevent accidents.
The capabilities of a vehicle equipped with the
driving safety systems described in this
RWet
Z
61
Safety
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Safety
62
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 62
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving safety systems
section must never be exploited in a reckless
or dangerous manner which could jeopardize
the user's safety or the safety of others.
Always adjust your driving style to the
prevailing road and weather conditions and
keep a safe distance to other road users and
objects on the street.
If a driving system malfunctions, other driving
safety systems may also switch off. Observe
indicator and warning lamps that may come
on as well as messages in the multifunction
display that may appear.
i In wintry driving conditions, always use
winter tires (M+S tires) and if necessary,
snow chains. Only in this way will the
driving safety systems described in this
section work as effectively as possible.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Important safety notes
G Warning
Braking
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel
a pulsing in the brake pedal.
X If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking
situation is over.
X To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
G Warning
If the ABS malfunctions, other driving systems
such as the BAS or the ESP® are also switched
off. Observe indicator and warning lamps that
may come on as well as messages in the
multifunction display that may appear.
If the ABS malfunctions, the wheels may lock
during hard braking, reducing the steering
capability and extending the braking distance.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an
indication of hazardous road conditions and
functions as a reminder to take extra care
while driving.
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 61).
BAS (Brake Assist)
G Warning
G Warning
Do not pump the brake pedal. Use firm, steady
brake pedal pressure instead. Pumping the
brake pedal defeats the purpose of the ABS
and significantly reduces braking
effectiveness.
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the
vehicle when braking.
ABS works from a speed of about
5 mph (8 km/h) upwards, regardless of roadsurface conditions. ABS works on slippery
surfaces, even when you only brake gently.
The ! warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out when the engine is running.
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 61).
BAS operates in emergency braking
situations. If you depress the brake pedal
quickly, BAS automatically boosts the braking
force, thus shortening the stopping distance.
X Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
G Warning
If the BAS malfunctions, the brake system still
functions, but without the additional brake
boost available that the BAS would normally
provide in an emergency braking maneuver.
Therefore, the braking distance may increase.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 63
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving safety systems
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Important safety notes
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 61).
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating
from the direction desired by the driver, one
or more wheels are braked to stabilize the
vehicle. If necessary, the engine output is also
modified to keep the vehicle on the desired
course within physical limits. ESP® assists
the driver when pulling away on wet or
slippery roads. ESP® can also stabilize the
vehicle during braking.
If ESP® intervenes, the ä warning lamp
flashes in the instrument cluster.
G Warning!
Never switch off the ESP when you see the
ESP warning lamp ä flashing in the
instrument cluster. In this case proceed as
follows:
RWhen
driving off, apply as little throttle as
possible.
RWhile driving, ease up on the accelerator
pedal.
RAdapt your speed and driving style to the
prevailing road conditions.
Failure to observe these guidelines could
cause the vehicle to skid. The ESP cannot
prevent accidents resulting from excessive
speed.
! Vehicles without 4MATIC: switch the
ignition off when:
Rthe parking brake is being tested using a
dynamometer
Rthe vehicle is being towed with the front
axle raised
Application of the brakes by ESP® may
otherwise destroy the brake system.
63
! Vehicles with 4MATIC: switch off the
ignition when the parking brake is being
tested on a brake dynamometer.
Application of the brakes by ESP® may
otherwise destroy the brake system.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC: function or
performance tests may only be carried out
on a 2-axle dynamometer. If you wish to
operate the vehicle on such a
dynamometer, please consult an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center in
advance. You could otherwise damage the
drive train or the brake system.
i Only use wheels with the recommended
tire sizes. Only then will ESP® function
properly.
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 61).
Traction control is part of ESP®.
Traction control brakes the drive wheels
individually if they spin. This enables you to
pull away and accelerate on slippery surfaces,
for example if the road surface is slippery on
one side. On vehicles with 4MATIC, more
drive torque is also transferred to the wheel
or wheels with traction.
Traction control remains active if you
deactivate ESP®.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (except
AMG vehicles)
G Warning
The ESP® should not be switched off during
normal driving other than in the
circumstances described below. Disabling
the system will reduce vehicle stability in
driving maneuvers.
Do not switch off the ESP® when a spare
wheel is mounted.
Z
Safety
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
64
Driving safety systems
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is running.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the
following situations:
Safety
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 64
Version: 3.0.3.6
Rwhen
using snow chains
Rin deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
G Warning!
ESP®
Activate
as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilize the vehicle
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts
to spin.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
Rthe engine's torque is no longer limited and
the drive wheels can spin. The spinning of
the wheels results in a cutting action, which
provides better grip.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ä warning lamp in the
instrument cluster flashes. In such situations,
ESP® will not stabilize the vehicle.
X To deactivate:(Y page 178).
The å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
G Warning
When the å ESP OFF warning lamp lights
up, ESP is switched off.
When the ä ESP warning lamp and the
å ESP OFF warning lamp are on
continuously, ESP is not operational due to a
malfunction.
When ESP is switched off or not operational,
the vehicle's stability during standard driving
maneuvers is reduced.
Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing
road conditions/weather conditions and to
the non-operating status of ESP.
! Avoid spinning a drive wheel for an
extended period with ESP switched off. This
could cause serious damage to the drive
train.
X
To activate:(Y page 178).
The å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (AMG
vehicles)
Activating/deactivating SPORT handling
mode
G Warning
The SPORT handling mode should not be
switched on during normal driving.
Switching on the SPORT handling mode will
result in the following:
Rno
restriction to the engine torque
supported traction control is
limited
The SPORT handling mode is designed for
driving on closed tracks when the vehicle's
own natural oversteer and understeer
characteristics are desired and requires a
highly skilled and experienced driver able to
handle these critical driving situations.
You could lose control of your vehicle and
cause an accident.
Please be aware of these limits when you
switch on the SPORT handling mode.
Do not switch on the SPORT handling when a
spare wheel is mounted.
Rsystem
SPORT handling mode is active automatically
as long as the engine is running.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 65
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving safety systems
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Rin
G Warning
Switch off the SPORT handling mode and
switch on the ESP® immediately if the
aforementioned circumstances do not apply
anymore. Otherwise the SPORT handling
mode will only stabilize the vehicle to a limited
extent when it is starting to skid or a wheel is
spinning.
When SPORT handling mode is activated:
RESP®
only improves driving stability to a
limited degree.
Rthe engine's torque is restricted to a limited
degree and the drive wheels can spin. The
spinning of the wheels results in a cutting
action, which provides better grip.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly.
If SPORT handling mode is activated and one
or more wheels start to spin, the ä
warning lamp in the instrument cluster
flashes. ESP® only stabilizes the vehicle to a
limited degree.
X
To deactivate: briefly press button :.
The M warning lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Activating/deactivating ESP®
G Warning!
The ESP® should not be switched off during
normal driving.
Disabling of the system will result in the
following:
Rno
restriction to engine torque
of system-supported traction control
Rloss
"ESP® OFF" is designed for driving on closed
tracks when the vehicle’s natural oversteer
and understeer characteristics are desired
and requires a highly skilled and experienced
driver able to handle these critical driving
situations.
You could lose control of your vehicle and
cause an accident.
Please be aware of these limits when you
switch off the ESP®.
Do not switch off the ESP® when a spare
wheel is mounted.
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is running.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the
following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Rin
G Warning!
X
To activate: briefly press button :.
The M warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up. The SPORT handling
Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilize the vehicle
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts
to spin.
Z
Safety
mode message appears in the multifunction
display.
It may be best to activate SPORT handling
mode in the following situations:
Rwhen
65
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 66
Version: 3.0.3.6
Anti-theft systems
66
If you deactivate ESP®:
! Avoid spinning a drive wheel for an
extended period with ESP switched off. This
could cause serious damage to the drive
train.
Safety
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
Rthe engine's torque is no longer limited and
the drive wheels are able to spin. The
spinning of the wheels results in a cutting
action, which provides better grip.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ä warning lamp in the
instrument cluster does not flash. In such
situations, ESP® will not stabilize the vehicle.
X
To activate: briefly press button :.
The å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out. The message ESC-ON
appears in the multifunction display.
EBD
G Warning
Observe "Important safety notes"
(Y page 61).
EBD monitors and controls the brake
pressure on the rear wheels to improve
driving stability while braking.
G Warning!
X
To deactivate: press button : until the
å warning lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
The message ESC-OFF appears in the
multifunction display.
G Warning
When the å ESP OFF warning lamp lights
up, ESP is switched off.
When the ä ESP warning lamp and the
å ESP OFF warning lamp are on
continuously, ESP is not operational due to a
malfunction.
When ESP is switched off or not operational,
the vehicle's stability during standard driving
maneuvers is reduced.
Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing
road conditions/weather conditions and to
the non-operating status of ESP.
If the EBD malfunctions, the brake system will
still function with full brake boost. However,
the rear wheels could lock up during
emergency braking situations, for example.
You could lose control of the vehicle and
cause an accident.
Adapt your driving style to the changed
driving characteristics.
Adaptive Brake
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety
and offers increased braking comfort. In
addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE
BRAKE also features the hill start assist
function (Y page 135). For further
information, see Driving tips (Y page 152).
Anti-theft systems
Immobilizer
The immobilizer prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 67
Version: 3.0.3.6
Anti-theft systems
i The immobilizer is always deactivated
when you start the engine.
In the event that the engine cannot be
started when the starter battery is fully
charged, the immobilizer may be faulty.
Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center or call 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in
USA) or 1-800-387-0100 (in Canada).
Safety
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. The
engine can be started by anyone with a valid
key that is left inside the vehicle.
X To activate with the SmartKey: remove
the SmartKey from the ignition lock.
X To activate with KEYLESS-GO: switch the
ignition off and open the driver's door.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
X
To arm: lock the vehicle with the SmartKey
or KEYLESS-GO.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm
system is armed after approximately 15
seconds.
X To deactivate: unlock the vehicle using the
SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO.
X
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is armed and you open:
door
Rthe vehicle with the mechanical key
Rthe trunk lid
Rthe hood
The alarm is not switched off, even if you
close the open door that has triggered it, for
example.
seconds, the emergency call system
mbrace (USA only) or TELEAID (Canada
only) initiates a call to the Customer
Assistance Center automatically. The
emergency call system initiates the call
provided that:
To stop the alarm using the SmartKey:
insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X
Press the % or & button on the
SmartKey.
The alarm is switched off.
X
To stop the alarm using KEYLESS-GO:
grasp the outside door handle. The key
must be outside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
Ra
i If the alarm stays on for more than 30
67
or
X
Press the Start/Stop button on the
dashboard. The key must be inside the
vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
Ryou
have subscribed to the mbrace/
TELEAID service.
Rthe mbrace/TELEAID service has been
activated properly.
Rthe required mobile phone, power supply
and GPS are available.
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
68
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 68
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 69
Version: 3.0.3.6
69
Vehicle equipment ..............................
SmartKey .............................................
Doors ....................................................
Trunk ....................................................
Side windows ......................................
Sliding sunroof ....................................
70
70
77
80
83
86
Opening and closing
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
70
SmartKey
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
Opening and closing
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 70
Version: 3.0.3.6
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
G Warning!
Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the
passenger compartment or trunk unless they
are firmly secured in place.
Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo
increases a child's risk of injury in the event
of
Rstrong
braking maneuvers
changes of direction
Ran accident
Rsudden
SmartKey
Important safety notes
G Warning!
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the
SmartKey from the starter switch. Always
take the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in
the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised
access to a vehicle could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury. The children
could
Rinjure
themselves on parts of the vehicle
seriously or fatally injured through
excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold
Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with
vehicle equipment that can be operated
even if the SmartKey is removed from the
starter switch or removed from the vehicle,
such as seat adjustment, steering wheel
adjustment, or the memory function
If children open a door, they could injure other
persons or get out of the vehicle and injure
themselves or be injured by following traffic.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. The child restraint system's
metal parts, for example, could become very
hot, and the child could be burned by these
parts.
General information
If the SmartKey is faulty, contact Roadside
Assistance or an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
SmartKey functions
Locking and unlocking centrally
The SmartKey centrally locks/unlocks:
Rthe
doors
trunk lid
Rthe fuel filler flap
Rthe
Rbe
: & To lock the vehicle
; F To unlock the trunk lid
= % To unlock the vehicle
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
When it is dark, the surround lighting also
comes on if it is activated in the on-board
computer.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 71
Version: 3.0.3.6
SmartKey
You can also set an audible signal to confirm
that the vehicle has been locked or unlocked.
The audible signal can be activated and
deactivated using the on-board computer
(Y page 181).
i Only for USA:
This equipment complies with Part 15 of
the FCC regulations. Operation is subject
to the following conditions:
Rthis equipment must not emit harmful,
electromagnetic radiation.
Rthis equipment may be affected by
electromagnetic radiation, including
radiation which can trigger unwanted
functions.
Any unauthorized change to this equipment
can lead to the user's operating license
being withdrawn.
i Only for Canada:
This equipment complies with the RSS-210
regulations of Industry Canada. Operation
is subject to the following conditions:
Rthis equipment must not emit harmful,
electromagnetic radiation.
Rthis equipment receives electromagnetic
radiation, including radiation which can
trigger unwanted functions.
Any unauthorized change to this equipment
can lead to the user's operating license
being withdrawn.
X
To unlock centrally: press the %
button.
If you do not open a door or the trunk lid within
approximately 40 seconds of unlocking the
vehicle:
Rthe
vehicle is locked again.
theft deterrent locking system is
activated again.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
Rthe
71
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
i Only for USA:
This equipment complies with Part 15 of
the FCC regulations. Operation is subject
to the following conditions:
Rthis equipment must not emit harmful,
electromagnetic radiation.
Rthis equipment may be affected by
electromagnetic radiation, including
radiation which can trigger unwanted
functions.
Any unauthorized change to this equipment
can lead to the user's operating license
being withdrawn.
i Only for Canada:
This equipment has been released in
accordance with RSS - 210 of Industry
Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
Rthis equipment must not emit harmful,
electromagnetic radiation.
Rthis equipment receives electromagnetic
radiation, including radiation which can
trigger unwanted functions.
Any unauthorized change to this equipment
can lead to the user's operating license
being withdrawn.
Important information for using
KEYLESS-GO
RYou
can use the KEYLESS-GO key as a
conventional key.
RYou can combine KEYLESS-GO functions
with those of a conventional key (e.g. open
with KEYLESS-GO and close with the
& button).
RAlways carry your KEYLESS-GO key on your
person.
RNever keep the KEYLESS-GO key with:
- electronic equipment, such as your
mobile phone or another key
- metal objects, such as coins or metal foil
Z
Opening and closing
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Opening and closing
72
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 72
Version: 3.0.3.6
SmartKey
This may impair the functioning of KEYLESSGO.
RTo open or close the vehicle, the KEYLESSGO key should be no more than 3 ft (1 m)
from the door or trunk.
RWhen the vehicle is parked for more than
72 hours, the KEYLESS-GO function is
deactivated. Pull one of the outer door
handles and turn on the ignition to
reactivate the KEYLESS-GO function.
RIf the KEYLESS-GO key is not near the
vehicle, it is possible that the system may
not recognize it. In this case, the vehicle
cannot be locked or started with KEYLESSGO.
RIf the KEYLESS-GO key has been removed
from the vehicle (e.g. if a passenger leaves
the vehicle with the KEYLESS-GO key):
- while someone is holding the Start/Stop
button or attempting to lock the vehicle
with the outer door handle, the message
Key not detected appears in the
multifunction display
- while the engine is running, the red
message Key not detected appears in
the multifunction display as you pull
away. Find the KEYLESS-GO key or
change its current position immediately
(e.g. place it on the front-passenger seat
or carry it in your shirt pocket.)
RIf you have started the engine using the
Start/Stop button, you can turn if off again
by:
- pressing the Start/Stop button again
- inserting the KEYLESS-GO key in the
ignition lock when the vehicle is
stationary and the automatic
transmission is in parking position P.
RYou may accidentally unlock the vehicle if
the KEYLESS-GO key is within 3 ft (1 m) of
the vehicle and:
- an outer door handle comes into contact
with water
or
- you are cleaning an outer door handle.
RNote that the engine can be started by any
vehicle occupant if a KEYLESS-GO key is in
the vehicle.
Option 1: there is a KEYLESS-GO key in the
vehicle and a KEYLESS-GO key outside the
vehicle. If you leave the KEYLESS-GO key
behind when you get out and lock the
vehicle, a message does not appear in the
multifunction display.
Option 2: there is a KEYLESS-GO key in the
vehicle but no KEYLESS-GO key outside the
vehicle. When you get out and try to lock
the vehicle, the message Key still in
vehicle appears in the multifunction
display. The vehicle is not locked in this
case.
When starting the engine and while driving,
KEYLESS-GO also checks whether a valid key
is in the vehicle by periodically establishing
radio contact.
X
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor
surface :.
X Convenience closing feature: touch
sensor surface ; for an extended period
(Y page 84).
If you pull on the handle of the trunk lid, only
the trunk/cargo area of the vehicle is
unlocked.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 73
Version: 3.0.3.6
SmartKey
time, the sensor surfaces are deactivated
automatically.
Pull the door handle to unlock the door and
turn on the ignition once to activate the
sensor surfaces again.
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the settings of the locking
system in such a way that only the driver's
door and the fuel filler flap are unlocked. This
is useful if you frequently travel on your own.
X To change the setting: press the %
and & buttons simultaneously for
approximately six seconds until the battery
check lamp flashes twice.
The SmartKey now functions as follows:
X
To unlock the driver's door: press the
% button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the %
button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as
follows:
X
To unlock the driver's door: touch the
inner surface of the door handle on the
driver's door.
X To unlock centrally: touch the inner
surface of the door handle on the frontpassenger door or the rear door.
X To lock centrally: touch sensor
surface : on one of the door handles.
Mechanical key
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or
unlocked with the SmartKey, use the
mechanical key.
If you use the mechanical key to unlock and
open the driver's door or the trunk lid, the
anti-theft alarm system will be triggered
(Y page 67).
There are several ways to turn off the alarm:
X Press the % or & button on the
SmartKey.
or
X Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock.
or
X Press the Start/Stop button in the ignition
lock. The SmartKey must be in the vehicle.
or
X Lock or unlock the vehicle using KEYLESSGO. The SmartKey must be outside the
vehicle.
If you unlock the vehicle using the mechanical
key, the fuel filler flap will not be unlocked
automatically.
X To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the
SmartKey in the ignition lock.
Removing the mechanical key
Restoring the factory settings
X
Press the % and & buttons
simultaneously for approximately six
seconds until the battery check lamp
flashes twice.
X
Push release catch : in the direction of
the arrow and at the same time remove
mechanical key ; from the SmartKey.
Z
Opening and closing
i If the vehicle has been parked for a long
73
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
SmartKey
74
SmartKey battery
Important safety notes
It is advisable to have batteries replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Opening and closing
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 74
Version: 3.0.3.6
G Warning!
Batteries are toxic and contain caustic
substances. For this reason, keep batteries
out of the reach of children.
If a battery has been swallowed, visit a doctor
immediately.
i You can obtain a SmartKey battery at any
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
i If the SmartKey battery is checked within
signal range of the vehicle, pressing the
& or % button results in the vehicle
being locked or unlocked respectively.
Changing the battery
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
X Take the mechanical key out of the
SmartKey (Y page 73).
G Warning
SmartKey batteries contain perchlorate
material, which may require special handling
and regard for the environment. Check with
your local government's disposal guidelines.
California residents, see www.dtsc.ca.gov/
HazardousWaste/Perchlorate/
index.cfm.
Checking the battery
X
Press the & or % button.
The SmartKey battery is working properly if
battery charge indicator lamp : lights up
briefly.
If battery charge indicator lamp : does not
light up briefly during the test, the SmartKey
battery is discharged.
X Replace the SmartKey battery
(Y page 74).
X
X
Press mechanical key ; into the opening
in the SmartKey in the direction of the
arrow until battery tray cover : opens. Do
not hold the cover closed while doing so.
Remove the cover of the battery tray.
Repeatedly tap the SmartKey against your
palm until battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive
pole facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth to
do so.
X
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 75
Version: 3.0.3.6
SmartKey
75
X
Opening and closing
Insert the front tabs of the battery tray's
cover first and then press to close it.
X Check the function of all SmartKey buttons
on the vehicle.
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
76
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 76
Version: 3.0.3.6
SmartKey
Problems with the SmartKey
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You cannot lock/
unlock the vehicle
using the SmartKey.
The SmartKey battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Point the tip of the SmartKey at the driver's door handle from a
distance of approximately 1.5 ft (50 cm) and try to unlock or
lock the vehicle again.
Opening and closing
Problem
If this does not work:
X Lock or unlock the vehicle using the mechanical key
(Y page 73).
X Check the key battery and replace it if necessary (Y page 74).
The SmartKey is faulty.
X Lock the vehicle as described in the "Locking the vehicle
(mechanical key)" section (Y page 79) or unlock it using the
mechanical key (Y page 73).
X Have the SmartKey checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can no longer
KEYLESS-GO is in standby mode because the vehicle has not been
lock/unlock the
unlocked for an extended period.
vehicle using KEYLESS- X Pull the door handle and then turn the SmartKey to position 2
GO.
in the ignition lock.
There is a malfunction with KEYLESS-GO.
X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
the SmartKey. Point the tip of the SmartKey at the driver's door
handle from close range and press the %/& button.
X Have the SmartKey checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
the SmartKey. Point the tip of the SmartKey at the driver's door
handle from close range and press the %/& button.
You have lost a
SmartKey.
X
You have lost the
mechanical key.
X
Have the SmartKey canceled at an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
X Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 77
Version: 3.0.3.6
Doors
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine cannot be
started using the
SmartKey.
The on-board voltage is too low.
X Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
The engine cannot be
started using the
SmartKey.
Opening and closing
If this does not work:
X Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary
(Y page 259).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 262).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The steering lock is mechanically blocked.
X Remove the SmartKey and re-insert it into the ignition lock.
While doing this, turn the steering wheel in both directions.
The engine cannot be
A door is open. Therefore, the SmartKey cannot be detected as
started using KEYLESS- easily.
GO. The SmartKey is in X Close the door and try to start the vehicle again.
the vehicle.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
X Start your vehicle with the SmartKey in the ignition lock.
Doors
Important safety notes
G Warning!
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the
SmartKey from the starter switch. Always
take the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in
the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised
access to a vehicle could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury. The children
could
Rinjure
themselves on parts of the vehicle
Rbe seriously or fatally injured through
excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold
Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with
vehicle equipment that can be operated
77
even if the SmartKey is removed from the
starter switch or removed from the vehicle,
such as seat adjustment, steering wheel
adjustment, or the memory function
If children open a door, they could injure other
persons or get out of the vehicle and injure
themselves or be injured by following traffic.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. The child restraint system's
metal parts, for example, could become very
hot, and the child could be burned by these
parts.
G Warning!
Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the
passenger compartment or trunk unless they
are firmly secured in place.
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Doors
78
Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo
increases a child's risk of injury in the event
of
Rstrong
braking maneuvers
Rsudden changes of direction
Ran accident
Opening and closing
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 78
Version: 3.0.3.6
Unlocking and opening doors from
the inside
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
The locking or unlocking buttons of the
central locking do not lock or unlock the fuel
filler flap.
i You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally
from the inside if the vehicle has been
locked with the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO.
i It is only possible to lock the vehicle
centrally if the front-passenger door is
closed.
You can open a door from inside the vehicle
even if it has been locked, unless the childproof locks have been activated (Y page 60).
Only open the door if traffic conditions allow
you to do so.
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the SmartKey or with KEYLESS-GO, opening
a door from the inside will trigger the antitheft alarm system. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 67).
X
To unlock: press button :.
X To lock: press button ;.
You can open a locked front door from inside
the vehicle. Only open the door if traffic
conditions allow you to do so.
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the central locking button:
X
Front door: pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops
up. The door is unlocked and can be
opened.
X Rear door: pull up locking knob : on the
respective rear door.
The rear door is unlocked and can be
opened.
Rand the KEYLESS-GO key is restored to the
factory settings, the entire vehicle is
unlocked if a front door is opened from
inside the vehicle.
Rand the KEYLESS-GO key is set to individual
settings, only the front door which is
opened from inside the vehicle is unlocked.
Automatic locking
i The vehicle locks automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels of
the vehicle are moving at a speed of more
than 9 mph(15 km/h). You may therefore
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 79
Version: 3.0.3.6
Doors
X
Insert the mechanical key into the lock of
the driver's door as far as it will go.
X Turn the mechanical key counter-clockwise
to position 1.
The door is unlocked.
X Turn the mechanical key back and remove
it.
Locking the vehicle (mechanical key)
Emergency locking
X
To deactivate: press and hold button :
for about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
about five seconds until a tone sounds.
i When you push either of the two buttons
and an audible warning signal does not
sound, the relevant setting has already
been selected.
On vehicles with a luxury multifunction
steering wheel, you can also activate and
deactivate the automatic locking using the
on-board computer (Y page 181).
If the vehicle can no longer be locked
centrally with the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO:
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door, the rear
doors and the trunk lid.
X Press the locking button (Y page 78).
X Make sure that the locking knobs on the
doors are still visible. Press down the
locking knobs by hand, if necessary.
X Close the driver's door.
X Take the mechanical key out of the
SmartKey (Y page 73).
Unlocking the driver's door
(mechanical key)
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked
centrally with the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO:
X Take the mechanical key out of the
SmartKey (Y page 73).
X
Insert the mechanical key into the lock of
the driver's door as far as it will go.
X Turn the mechanical key clockwise as far
as it will go to position 1.
X Turn the mechanical key back and remove
it.
X Make sure that the doors and the trunk lid
are locked.
Z
Opening and closing
lock yourself out if the vehicle is being
pushed, towed, or located on a test rig.
79
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
80
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 80
Version: 3.0.3.6
Trunk
i If you lock the vehicle as described above,
the fuel filler flap is not locked. The antitheft alarm system is not activated.
Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo
increases a child's risk of injury in the event
of
Rstrong
Trunk
Opening and closing
Important safety notes
Do not leave the SmartKey in the trunk. You
could otherwise lock yourself out.
G Warning
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the
SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle.
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system, and do not give them access
to an unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised
access to a vehicle could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury. They could:
Rinjure
themselves on vehicle parts
seriously or fatally injured by extreme
heat or cold
Rinjure themselves or have an accident with
vehicle equipment that may still be in
operation even after the SmartKey has
been removed from the ignition, such as the
seat adjustment, steering wheel
adjustment or memory function.
If children open a door, they could cause
severe or even fatal injury to other persons; if
they get out of the vehicle, they could injure
themselves when doing so or be seriously or
even fatally injured by any passing traffic.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. The child restraint system's
metal parts, for example, could become very
hot, and a child could be burned on these
parts.
Rbe
G Warning!
Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the
passenger compartment or trunk unless they
are firmly secured in place.
braking maneuvers
changes of direction
Ran accident
Rsudden
G Warning
Make sure the trunk lid is closed when the
engine is running and while driving. Among
other dangers, deadly carbon monoxide (CO)
gases may enter the vehicle interior resulting
in unconsciousness and death.
! The trunk lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the trunk lid.
For the trunk lid to be opened fully, there must
be a minimum clearance from floor to ceiling
of 5.90 ft (1.80 m).
The trunk lid can be:
Ropened
Ropened
and closed manually from outside
automatically from outside
Opening and closing manually
Opening
You can only open the trunk lid after
unlocking it first.
You can only unlock the trunk lid when the
vehicle is stationary.
X Press the % button on the SmartKey.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 81
Version: 3.0.3.6
Trunk
Pull handle :.
X Raise the trunk lid.
Closing
G Warning
To prevent possible personal injury, always
keep hands and fingers away from the trunk
opening when closing the trunk lid. Be
especially careful when small children are
around.
Opening
You can open the trunk lid automatically
using the SmartKey or the handle in the trunk
lid.
X Press and hold the F button on the
SmartKey until the trunk lid opens.
or
X When the trunk is unlocked, pull on the
trunk lid handle and let it go again
immediately.
Closing
i If you leave a KEYLESS-GO key in the
trunk, the trunk lid will not lock.
Opening automatically from the
inside
G Warning
X
Pull the trunk lid down using recess :.
X Lock the vehicle if necessary with
the & button on the SmartKey or with
KEYLESS-GO (Y page 71).
Automatic opening and closing from
the outside
Make sure the trunk lid is closed when the
engine is running and while driving. Among
other dangers, deadly carbon monoxide (CO)
gases may enter the vehicle interior resulting
in unconsciousness and death.
You can open the tailgate from the driver's
seat when the vehicle is stationary.
Important safety guidelines
G Warning
Make sure the trunk lid is closed when the
engine is running and while driving. Among
other dangers, deadly carbon monoxide (CO)
gases may enter the vehicle interior resulting
in unconsciousness and death.
! The trunk lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the trunk lid.
X
To open: press the upper section of remote
operating switch : for the trunk lid until
the trunk lid opens.
For the trunk lid to be opened fully, there must
be a minimum clearance from floor to ceiling
of 5.90 ft (1.80 m).
Z
Opening and closing
X
81
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 82
Version: 3.0.3.6
Trunk
82
Opening and closing
Locking the trunk separately
You can lock the trunk separately. If you then
unlock the vehicle centrally, the trunk
remains locked and cannot be opened.
X Close the trunk lid.
X Take the mechanical key out of the
SmartKey (Y page 73).
X
Turn the mechanical key counter-clockwise
as far as it will go to position 2.
The trunk is unlocked.
X Turn the mechanical key back to basic
position 1 and remove it.
Emergency trunk release
X
Insert the mechanical key into the trunk lid
lock as far as the stop.
X Turn the mechanical key clockwise from
position 1 to position 2.
X Remove the mechanical key.
You can open the trunk lid from inside the
vehicle with the emergency release button.
Unlocking the trunk (mechanical key)
! The trunk lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the trunk lid.
If the trunk can no longer be unlocked with
the SmartKey or KEYLESS-GO:
X Take the mechanical key out of the
SmartKey (Y page 73).
X Insert the mechanical key into the trunk lid
lock as far as the stop.
The trunk lid can be unlocked and opened
with the trunk lid emergency release when
the vehicle is stationary or while driving.
Trunk lid emergency release light:
RThe button flashes for 30 minutes after the
trunk lid is opened.
RThe button flashes for 60 minutes after the
trunk lid is closed.
The trunk lid emergency release does not
open the trunk lid if the battery is
disconnected or discharged.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 83
Version: 3.0.3.6
Side windows
Side windows
G Warning!
themselves on parts of the vehicle
seriously or fatally injured through
excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold
Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with
vehicle equipment that can be operated
even if the SmartKey is removed from the
starter switch or removed from the vehicle,
such as seat adjustment, steering wheel
adjustment, or the memory function
If children open a door, they could injure other
persons or get out of the vehicle and injure
themselves or be injured by following traffic.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. The child restraint system's
metal parts, for example, could become very
hot, and the child could be burned by these
parts.
When opening or closing the door windows,
make sure there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the opening/closing procedure.
The door windows are equipped with the
automatic operation and anti-entrapment
features. If during automatic operation a door
window encounters an obstruction that
blocks its path, the anti-entrapment feature
will stop the door window and open it slightly.
The door windows operate differently when
the switch is pulled and held. See the section
about the side windows for details.
The closing of the door windows can be
immediately halted by releasing the switch or,
if the switch was pulled past the resistance
point and released, by either pressing or
pulling the respective switch.
If a door window encounters an obstruction
that blocks its path in a circumstance where
you are closing the door windows by pressing
and holding button & on the SmartKey or
by pressing and holding the sensor surface
(vehicles with KEYLESS-GO) on an outside
door handle, the anti-entrapment feature will
not operate.
Activate the override switch when children
are riding in the back seats of the vehicle. The
children may otherwise injure themselves,
e.g. by becoming trapped in the door window
opening.
G Warning!
G Warning!
Important safety notes
G Warning!
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the
SmartKey from the starter switch. Always
take the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in
the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised
access to a vehicle could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury. The children
could
Rinjure
Rbe
Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the
passenger compartment or trunk unless they
are firmly secured in place.
Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo
increases a child's risk of injury in the event
of
83
Do not keep any part of your body up against
the window pane when opening a window. The
downward motion of the pane may pull that
part of your body down between the window
pane and the door frame and trap it there. If
there is a risk of entrapment, release the
switch and pull it to close the window.
Rstrong
braking maneuvers
changes of direction
Ran accident
Rsudden
Z
Opening and closing
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 84
Version: 3.0.3.6
Side windows
84
Opening and closing the side
windows
Convenience opening
You can ventilate the vehicle before you start
driving. To do this, you can use the key to
simultaneously:
Ropen
the side windows
the tilt/sliding sunroof or the
panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel and the roller sunblinds
Opening and closing
Ropen
i The convenience opening feature can
: Front left
; Front right
= Rear right
? Rear left
The switches for all side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch on
each door for the corresponding side window.
i Operation of the side windows in the rear
compartment is not possible when the
override switch for the side windows is
activated.
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
i You can continue to operate the side
windows after you switch off the engine.
This function remains active for five
minutes or until one of the front doors is
opened.
X
To open: press the corresponding switch.
To close: pull the corresponding switch.
i If you press the switch beyond the point
of resistance, an automatic opening/
closing process is started in the
corresponding direction. You can stop
automatic operation by pressing again.
X
only be operated using the key. The key
must be near the handle of the driver's
door.
X
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Press and hold the % button until the
side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof
or panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel are in the desired position.
The vehicle is unlocked.
If the roller sunblinds of the panorama roof
with power tilt/sliding panel are closed, the
roller sunblinds are opened first.
X Press and hold the % button again until
the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel is in the desired position.
X To interrupt the convenience opening
procedure: release the % button.
Convenience closing
General information
When you lock the vehicle, you can
simultaneously:
Rclose
the side windows
the tilt/sliding sunroof or the
panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel
On vehicles with a panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel, you can then close the
roller sunblinds.
Rclose
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 85
Version: 3.0.3.6
Side windows
When closing the door windows and the tilt/
sliding sunroof or panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel, make sure there is no
danger of anyone being harmed by the closing
procedure.
If potential danger exists, proceed as follows:
Using KEYLESS-GO
The SmartKey with KEYLESS-GO must be
outside the vehicle but no more than 3 ft (1 m)
away from a door.
X Close all the doors.
RRelease
button & to stop the closing
procedure. To open, press and hold button
%. To continue the closing procedure
after making sure that there is no danger of
anyone being harmed by the closing
procedure, press and hold button &.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO:
RRelease
the sensor surface on the outside
door handle to stop the closing procedure.
RImmediately pull on the same outside door
handle and hold firmly. The door windows
and the tilt/sliding sunroof or panorama
roof with power tilt/sliding panel will open
for as long as the door handle is held but
the door not opened.
Using the SmartKey
i The key must be near the handle of the
driver's door.
X
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Press and hold the & button until the
side windows and the tilt/sliding sunroof
or the panorama roof with power tilt/
sliding panel are fully closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
tilt/sliding sunroof or panorama roof with
power tilt/sliding panel are closed.
On vehicles with a panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel:
X
Press and hold the & button again until
the roller sunblinds of the panorama roof
with power tilt/sliding panel close.
X
To interrupt the convenience closing
procedure: release the & button.
X
Touch the sensor surface on door
handle : until the side windows and the
tilt/sliding sunroof or panorama roof with
power tilt/sliding panel are fully closed.
i Make sure you only touch sensor
surface :.
X
Make sure that all the side windows and the
tilt/sliding sunroof or panorama roof with
power tilt/sliding panel are closed.
On vehicles with a panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel:
X
Touch sensor surface : on the door
handle again until the roller sunblinds of the
panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel close.
X
To interrupt convenience closing:
release sensor surface : on the door
handle.
Resetting the side windows
You must reset all the side windows if the side
window cannot be closed fully.
X Close all the doors.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Z
Opening and closing
G Warning!
85
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Sliding sunroof
86
X
Pull on the corresponding switch on the
door control panel until the side window is
completely closed (Y page 84).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the side window opens again slightly:
X
Opening and closing
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 86
Version: 3.0.3.6
Pull the corresponding switch again
immediately and hold it for approximately
one second.
Problems with the side windows
Problem: a side window cannot be closed
because objects are trapped between the
side window and the door frame.
X
If a side window is obstructed again during
closing and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull
on the corresponding switch again until the
side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the antientrapment feature.
G Warning!
Pulling and holding the switch to close the
door window immediately after it had been
blocked two times will cause the door window
to close without the anti-entrapment feature
for as long as you hold the switch.
Remove the objects.
X Close the side window.
Sliding sunroof
Problem: a side window cannot be closed
because objects in the guide rail are
preventing the window from being raised.
G Warning!
X
Remove the objects.
X Close the side window.
Problem: a side window cannot be closed,
and you cannot see the cause.
G Warning!
Closing the side windows with increased force
or without the anti-entrapment feature could
lead to serious or even fatal injury. Make sure
that nobody can become trapped when
closing the side windows.
If a side window is obstructed during closing
and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull
on the corresponding switch again until the
side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased
force.
Important safety notes
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the
SmartKey from the starter switch. Always
take the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle. Do not leave children unattended in
the vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised
access to a vehicle could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury. The children
could
Rinjure
themselves on parts of the vehicle
seriously or fatally injured through
excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold
Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with
vehicle equipment that can be operated
even if the SmartKey is removed from the
starter switch or removed from the vehicle,
such as seat adjustment, steering wheel
adjustment, or the memory function
If children open a door, they could injure other
persons or get out of the vehicle and injure
themselves or be injured by following traffic.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. The child restraint system's
metal parts, for example, could become very
Rbe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 87
Version: 3.0.3.6
Sliding sunroof
hot, and the child could be burned by these
parts.
G Warning!
Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the
passenger compartment or trunk unless they
are firmly secured in place.
Unsecured or improperly positioned cargo
increases a child's risk of injury in the event
of
Rstrong
braking maneuvers
changes of direction
Ran accident
Rsudden
G Warning!
When opening or closing the tilt/sliding
sunroof, make sure there is no danger of
anyone being harmed by the opening/closing
procedure.
The tilt/sliding sunroof is equipped with the
automatic operation and anti-entrapment
features. If the movement of the tilt/sliding
sunroof is blocked during the closing
procedure, the tilt/sliding sunroof will stop
and open slightly.
The tilt/sliding sunroof operates differently
when the sunroof switch is pressed and held.
See the section about problems with the
sliding sunroof for details.
The opening/closing procedure of the tilt/
sliding sunroof can be immediately halted by
releasing the sunroof switch or, if the sunroof
switch was moved past the resistance point
and released, by moving the sunroof switch in
any direction.
G Warning!
The tilt/sliding sunroof is made out of glass.
In the event of an accident, the glass may
shatter. This may result in an opening in the
roof.
In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing
their seat belts or not wearing them properly
may be thrown out of the opening. Such an
opening also presents a potential for injury for
87
occupants wearing their seat belts properly as
entire body parts or portions of them may
protrude from the passenger compartment.
G Warning!
When opening or closing the tilt/sliding panel,
make sure there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the opening/closing procedure.
The tilt/sliding panel is equipped with the
automatic operation and anti-entrapment
features. If the movement of the tilt/sliding
panel is blocked during the closing procedure,
the tilt/sliding panel will stop and open
slightly.
The tilt/sliding panel operates differently
when the roof panel switch is pressed and
held. See the relevant section in this chapter
for details.
The opening/closing procedure of the tilt/
sliding panel can be immediately halted by
releasing the roof panel switch or, if the roof
panel switch was moved past the resistance
point and released, by moving the roof panel
switch in any direction.
G Warning!
The panorama roof with tilt/sliding panel is
made out of glass. In the event of an accident,
the glass may shatter. This may result in an
opening in the roof.
In a vehicle rollover, occupants not wearing
their seat belts or not wearing them properly
may be thrown out of the opening. Such an
opening also presents a potential for injury for
occupants wearing their seat belts properly as
entire body parts or portions of them may
protrude from the passenger compartment.
! Only open the sliding sunroof if it is free
of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions
may occur.
Do not allow anything to protrude from the
sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could
be damaged.
! If the sliding sunroof cannot be opened or
closed due to a malfunction, contact a
Z
Opening and closing
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Sliding sunroof
88
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
! Do not forget that the weather can
Opening and closing
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 88
Version: 3.0.3.6
change abruptly. Make certain that the
sliding sunroof is closed when you leave the
vehicle. The vehicle electronics can be
damaged if water enters the vehicle
interior.
i Resonance noises can occur in addition
to the usual airflow noises when the sliding
sunroof is open. They are caused by minor
pressure fluctuations in the vehicle interior.
Change the position of the sliding sunroof
or open a side window slightly to reduce or
eliminate these noises.
Operating the tilt/sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
i You can still operate the tilt/sliding
sunroof even if you switch off the engine or
remove the SmartKey. This function
remains active for five minutes or until one
of the front doors is opened.
Overhead control panel
: To raise
; To open
= To close
X
Switch on the ignition.
Push or pull the 3 switch in the
corresponding direction.
i If you press the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, an automatic opening/
X
closing process is started in the
corresponding direction. You can stop
automatic operation by pressing again.
Automatic opening/raising is only available
if the tilt/sliding sunroof is in the closed
position.
You can open/close the cover for the
sunblind manually when the tilt/sliding
sunroof is raised/closed.
Resetting
Reset the tilt/sliding sunroof if it does not
open smoothly.
! Contact a qualified specialist workshop if
the tilt/sliding sunroof cannot be closed
fully or reset.
X
Switch on the ignition.
Raise the tilt/sliding sunroof fully at the
rear (Y page 88).
X Keep the 3 switch pressed for another
second.
X Make sure that the tilt/sliding sunroof can
be opened or closed fully again using the
opening/closing process (Y page 88).
X If the tilt/sliding sunroof can be raised fully
at the rear it is set correctly. If this is not
the case, you must repeat the previously
described steps.
X
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 89
Version: 3.0.3.6
Sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
Overhead control panel
: To raise
; To open
= To close
The panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel can only be moved when the roller
sunblinds are open.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Push or pull the 3 switch in the
corresponding direction.
i If you press the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, an automatic opening/
closing process is started in the
corresponding direction. You can stop
automatic operation by pressing again.
Automatic raising is only available if the
panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel is in the closed position.
Operating the roller sunblinds of the
panorama sliding sunroof
General notes
The roller sunblinds provide protection from
the sun. The two roller sunblinds can only be
opened and closed together when the
panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel
is closed.
G Warning
When opening the roller sunblinds, make sure
that nobody can be injured during the opening
procedure.
The roller sunblinds are equipped with the
express operation and anti-entrapment
features. If the roller sunblinds block during
the opening procedure, the anti-entrapment
feature stops the roller sunblinds and opens
them again slightly.
The opening procedure of the roller sunblinds
can be stopped immediately by releasing the
roof switch or by operating the roof switch in
any direction if the roof switch has been
pressed beyond the point of resistance and
has been released.
Opening and closing
Overhead control panel
: To open
; To open
= To close
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Push or pull the 3 switch in the
corresponding direction.
i If you press the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, an automatic opening/
closing process is started in the
corresponding direction. You can stop
automatic operation by pressing again.
Z
Opening and closing
Operating the panorama sliding
sunroof
89
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Sliding sunroof
90
Resetting the panorama roof with
power tilt/sliding panel and the roller
sunblinds
Reset the panorama roof with power tilt/
sliding panel and the roller sunblinds if the
panorama roof with power tilt/sliding panel
or the roller sunblind do not open smoothly.
Opening and closing
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 90
Version: 3.0.3.6
! Do not open the panorama sliding sunroof
until it has been reset properly. Otherwise,
the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel may lock in the open position.
If the panorama roof with power tilt/sliding
panel cannot be closed or adjusted,
contact a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Center.
Problems with the sliding sunroof
Problem: the sunroof cannot be closed
and you cannot see the cause.
G Warning!
You could be severely or even fatally injured
when closing the sliding sunroof with
increased closing force or if the antientrapment feature is deactivated. Make sure
that nobody can become trapped when
closing the sliding sunroof.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during
closing:
X
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the 3 switch to the point of
resistance in the direction of arrow ; and
hold it until the roller sunblinds are fully
open.
X Press the 3 switch to the point of
resistance in the direction of arrow ; and
hold it until the panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel has opened about 10 cm.
X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point
of resistance in the direction of arrow =
until the panorama roof with power tilt/
sliding panel is fully closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an
additional second.
X Pull the 3 switch to the point of
resistance in the direction of arrow = and
hold it until the roller sunblinds are fully
closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an
additional second.
X Make sure that the panorama roof with
power tilt/sliding panel can be opened fully
again (Y page 89).
X If this is not the case, the previously
described steps must be repeated or you
should consult a qualified specialist
workshop.
Immediately after the sliding sunroof
blocks, pull the 3 switch in the
overhead control panel down to the point
of resistance and hold it until the sliding
sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed with increased
force.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during
closing again:
X
Immediately after the sliding sunroof
blocks, pull the 3 switch in the
overhead control panel down to the point
of resistance and hold it until the sliding
sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed without the
anti-entrapment feature.
G Warning!
Pressing and holding the sliding sunroof
switch to close the sliding sunroof
immediately after it had been blocked two
times will cause the sliding sunroof to close
without the anti-entrapment feature for as
long as you hold the switch.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 91
Version: 3.0.3.6
91
Vehicle equipment .............................. 92
Correct driver's seat position ............ 92
Seats .................................................... 93
Steering wheel .................................... 98
Mirrors ................................................. 99
Memory functions ............................. 102
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
92
Correct driver's seat position
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 92
Version: 3.0.3.6
Correct driver's seat position
Ryou
have moved the backrest to an
almost vertical position.
Ryou have set the seat cushion angle so
that your thighs are gently supported.
Ryou can depress the pedals properly.
X Check whether the head restraint is
adjusted properly (Y page 95).
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back
of your head is supported at eye level by
the center of the head restraint.
Observe the important safety notes on
(Y page 98).
X Check whether steering wheel : is
adjusted properly.
Adjusting the steering wheel
manually(Y page 98)
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
(Y page 98)
When adjusting the steering wheel, make
sure:
Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent.
can move your legs freely.
Ryou can see all the displays in the
instrument cluster clearly.
Ryou
Observe the important safety notes on
(Y page 93).
X Check whether you have adjusted seat =
properly.
Manual and electrical seat adjustment
(Y page 94)
Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 94)
When adjusting the seat, make sure:
Ryou
are as far away from the driver's air
bag as possible.
Ryou are sitting in a normal upright
position.
Ryou can fasten the seat belt properly.
Observe the important safety notes on
(Y page 50).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 52).
The seat belt should:
Rfit
snugly across your body
routed across the middle of your
shoulder
Rbe routed in your pelvic area across the
hip joints
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view
mirror and the exterior mirrors
(Y page 100) in such a way that you have
a good view of road and traffic conditions.
X Vehicles with memory function: save the
seat, steering wheel and exterior mirror
settings (Y page 102).
Rbe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 93
Version: 3.0.3.6
Seats
Seats
Important safety notes
G Warning
In order to avoid possible loss of vehicle
control, all seat, head restraint, steering
wheel and rear view mirror adjustments, as
well as fastening of seat belts, must be done
before setting the vehicle in motion.
G Warning
Do not adjust the driver's seat while driving.
Adjusting the seat while driving could cause
the driver to lose control of the vehicle.
Never travel in a moving vehicle with the seat
backrest in an excessively reclined position as
this can be dangerous. You could slide under
the seat belt in a collision. If you slide under
it, the seat belt would apply force at the
abdomen or neck. This could cause serious or
fatal injuries. The seat backrest and seat belts
provide the best restraint when the wearer is
in a position that is as upright as possible and
seat belts are properly positioned on the
body.
G Warning
Your seat belt must be adjusted so that you
can correctly fasten your seat belt.
Observe the following points:
Radjust the seat backrest until your arms are
slightly angled when holding the steering
wheel.
Radjust the seat to a comfortable seating
position that still allows you to reach the
accelerator/brake pedal safely. The
position should be as far back as possible
with the driver still able to operate the
controls properly.
Radjust the head restraint so that it is as
close to the head as possible and the center
93
of the head restraint supports the back of
the head at eye level.
Rnever place hands under the seat or near
any moving parts while a seat is being
adjusted.
Failure to do so could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury.
G Warning
The electrically adjustable seats can be
operated at any time. Therefore, do not leave
children unattended in the vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. A child's
unsupervised access to a vehicle could result
in an accident and/or serious personal injury.
G Warning!
According to accident statistics, children are
safer when properly restrained in the rear
seating positions than in the front seating
position. Thus, we strongly recommend that
children be placed in the rear seats whenever
possible. Regardless of seating position,
children 12 years old and under must be
seated and properly secured in an
appropriately sized infant restraint, toddler
restraint, or booster seat recommended for
the size and weight of the child. For additional
information, see "Children in the vehicle".
A child's risk of serious or fatal injuries is
significantly increased if the child restraints
are not properly secured in the vehicle and/
or the child is not properly secured in the child
restraint.
G Warning
For your protection, drive only with properly
positioned head restraints.
Adjust the head restraint so that it is as close
to the head as possible and the center of the
head restraint supports the back of the head
at eye level. This will reduce the potential for
injury to the head and neck in the event of an
accident or similar situation.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
94
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 94
Version: 3.0.3.6
Seats
Do not drive the vehicle without the seat head
restraints. Head restraints are intended to
help reduce injuries during an accident.
Adjusting the seat manually and
electrically
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Rdo
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not to be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see the " Interior care" section.
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating
materials, e.g. covers, bags, seat covers,
child seats or booster seats.
! When you move the seats, make sure that
there are no objects in the footwell or
behind the seats. Otherwise, you could
damage the seats and the objects.
i The head restraints in the front seats are
installed with the NECK-PRO system
(Y page 49). For this reason, it is not
possible to remove the head restraints
from the front seats.
Vehicles without the through-loading
feature: the head restraints cannot be
removed from the rear compartment seats.
Please contact an authorized MercedesBenz Center for more information.
i Related topics:
RThrough-loading
feature in the rear
bench seat (Y page 218)
: Backrest angle
; Seat height
= Seat cushion angle
? Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
i AMG vehicles are equipped with a seat
with an integrated head restraint. It is,
therefore, not possible to set the height and
angle of the head restraint.
i Adjust the seat cushion angle so that your
thighs are lightly supported.
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
X
Lift handle ? and slide the seat forwards
or backwards.
X Release lever ? again.
Make sure that you hear the seat engage in
position.
Seat cushion angle
X
Turn handwheel = in the desired direction.
Adjusting the seat electrically
i Vehicles without the memory function:
the seats can be adjusted within five
minutes of opening a front door.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 95
Version: 3.0.3.6
Seats
The time span starts over if, within these
five minutes, you:
consequently the head restraint
adjustment button is disabled. It is,
therefore, not possible to set the height and
angle of the head restraint.
Ropen
Rinsert
Depending on the equipment, the seat
adjustment switches are located either on the
side of the seat or on the door control panel.
Adjusting the head restraints
Adjusting the head restraints manually
Adjusting the head restraint height6
X
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch : in the
direction of the arrow and push the head
restraint down to the desired position.
Adjusting the angle of the head restraints
: Seat cushion angle
; Seat height
= Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
? Backrest angle
A Head restraint height5
i You can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 102).
X
Push or pull the lower edge of the head
restraint in the direction of the arrow.
i AMG vehicles are equipped with a seat
with an integrated head restraint and
5
6
Only for vehicles with the memory function.
For vehicles without memory function only.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
or close a front door
the key into or remove the key
from the ignition lock
Rswitch the ignition on or off.
If the key is in position 2 in the ignition, you
can adjust the seats at any time.
95
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 96
Version: 3.0.3.6
Seats
96
Adjusting the head restraints
electrically7
X
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X
X
To lower: press release catch : and push
the head restraint down until it is in the
desired position.
To adjust the head restraint height: slide
the switch for head restraint adjustment
(Y page 94) up or down in the direction of
the arrow.
Rear seat head restraints
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G Warning!
For your protection, drive only with properly
positioned head restraints.
Adjust the head restraint in such a way that it
is as close to the head as possible and the
center of the head restraint supports the back
of the head at eye level. This will reduce the
potential for injury to the head and neck in the
event of an accident or similar situation.
With a rear seat occupied, make sure to move
the respective head restraint up from the
lowest non-use position and have the
occupant adjust the head restraint properly.
Do not drive the vehicle without the seat head
restraints installed when the rear seats are
occupied. Head restraints are intended to
help reduce injuries during an accident.
Adjusting the rear seat head restraint
height
If the head restraint is fully lowered, it is
necessary to press release catch :.
7
8
Only for vehicles with memory function.
Only for vehicles with the through-loading feature.
Removing and installing the rear head
restraints8
G Warning!
Occupants should only travel sitting on seats
which have the head restraints installed. In
the event of an accident, this reduces the risk
of injury for passengers seated in the rear
compartment.
X
Release the rear seat backrest and fold it
slightly forwards (Y page 218).
X To remove: pull the head restraint up to
the stop.
X Press release catch : and pull the head
restraint out of the guides.
X To re-install: insert the head restraint so
that the notches on the bar are on the left
when viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear
it engage in position.
X Fold back the rear seat backrest until it
engages.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 97
Version: 3.0.3.6
Seats
Adjusting the lumbar support
You can adjust the contour of the front seats
so as to provide optimum support for your
back.
97
i If, after a certain amount of time, the seat
no longer has the desired contour, repeat
the adjustment.
Switching the seat heating on/off
Switching on/off
X
Move adjustment lever : in the direction
of the arrow until the desired backrest
contour is achieved.
Adaptive seat backrests (AMG
vehicles)
Repeatedly setting the seat heating to level
3 may result in excessive seat temperatures.
The health of passengers that have limited
temperature sensitivity or a limited ability to
react to excessively high temperatures may
be affected or they may even suffer burn-like
injuries. Therefore, do not use seat heating
level 3 repeatedly.
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
You can adjust the contour of the front seat
backrests individually so as to provide
optimum support for your back.
Driver's and front-passenger seat
: To adjust the upper back support
; To adjust the contour of the backrest in
the lumbar region
= To adjust the lateral structure and support
of the seat
X
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
The system automatically switches down
from level 3 to level 2 after approximately
eight minutes.
The system automatically switches down
from level 2 to level 1 after approximately ten
minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G Warning!
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 98
Version: 3.0.3.6
Steering wheel
98
X
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
Adjusting the steering wheel
manually
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Problems with the seat heating
The seat heating has switched itself off
prematurely or cannot be switched on. The
vehicle's electrical system voltage is too low
because too many electrical consumers are
switched on.
: Release lever
X
; To adjust the steering wheel height
Switch off electrical consumers which you
do not need, such as the rear window
defroster or interior lighting.
= To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
X
Steering wheel
Important safety notes
G Warning
Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving.
Adjusting the steering wheel while driving, or
driving without the steering wheel adjustment
feature locked could cause the driver to lose
control of the vehicle.
The electrical steering wheel adjustment
feature can be operated at any time.
Therefore, do not leave children unattended
in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked
vehicle. A child's unsupervised access to a
vehicle could result in an accident and/or
serious personal injury.
Push release lever : down completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
X Push release lever : up completely.
The steering column is locked.
X Check if the steering column is locked.
When doing so, try to push the steering
wheel up or down or try to move it in the
fore-and-aft direction.
Adjusting the steering wheel
electrically
: To adjust the steering wheel height
; To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 99
Version: 3.0.3.6
Mirrors
i Related topics:
REASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature
(Y page 99)
Rstoring settings (Y page 102)
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT
G Warning!
You must make sure no one can become
trapped or injured by the moving steering
wheel when the easy-entry/exit feature is
activated.
To stop steering wheel movement, move
steering wheel adjustment stalk or press the
memory position switch.
Do not leave children unattended in the
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Children could open the driver's door and
unintentionally activate the easy-entry/exit
feature, which could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury.
The EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature makes getting
in and out of your vehicle easier.
The steering wheel swings upwards when
you:
Rremove
also automatically moved to the previously
set position.
The last position of the steering wheel is
stored when you switch off the ignition or
when you store the setting with the memory
function (Y page 102).
You can activate and deactivate the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature in the on-board
computer (Y page 181).
G Warning
Let the system complete the adjustment
procedure before setting the vehicle in
motion. All steering wheel adjustment must
be completed before setting the vehicle in
motion. Driving off with the steering wheel
still adjusting could cause the driver to lose
control of the vehicle.
i If the crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature
is triggered in an accident, the steering
column will move upwards when the
driver's door is opened. This occurs
irrespective of the position of the key in the
ignition lock. This makes it easier to exit the
vehicle and rescue the occupants.
The crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is
only operational after an accident if the
EASY-EXIT/ENTRY feature is activated in
the on-board computer.
the key from the ignition lock.
the driver's door and KEYLESS-GO is
in position 1
Ropen the driver's door and the key is in
position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock.
Mirrors
i The steering wheel only moves upwards if
Rear-view mirror
Ropen
it has not already reached the upper end
stop.
Rear-view mirror (manual anti-glare)
The steering wheel is moved to the last
selected position when:
Rthe
Ryou
99
driver's door is closed, and
insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
Rin vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, you press the
Start/Stop button once.
When you close the driver's door with the
ignition switched on, the steering wheel is
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 100
Version: 3.0.3.6
Mirrors
100
X
Anti-glare mode: flick anti-glare
switch : forwards or back.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
Folding the exterior mirrors in or out
electrically
This function is only available in vehicles for
Canada.
! Fold in the exterior mirrors when driving
the vehicle into an automatic car wash. The
mirrors could otherwise be damaged.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G Warning
Exercise care when using the passenger-side
exterior rear view mirror. The mirror surface
is convex (outwardly curved surface for a
wider field of view). Objects in mirror are
closer than they appear. Check your interior
rear view mirror and glance over your
shoulder before changing lanes.
The exterior mirrors are automatically heated
if the rear window defroster is switched on
and the outside temperature is low.
X
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while the vehicle is
in motion as they may otherwise vibrate.
i If you are driving faster than
X
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X Press button : for the left-hand exterior
mirror or button ; for the right-hand
exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding
button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button = as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button = up, down, to
the right or to the left until the exterior
mirror is set to a position which provides
you with a good overview of traffic
conditions.
9 mph(15 km/h), you can no longer fold in
the exterior mirrors.
Resetting the exterior mirrors
This function is only available in vehicles for
Canada.
If the battery has been disconnected or
completely discharged, the exterior mirrors
must be reset. The exterior mirrors will
otherwise not fold in when you select the
"Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the
on-board computer (Y page 182).
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 in
the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 101
Version: 3.0.3.6
Mirrors
This function is only available in vehicles for
Canada.
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function
is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 182):
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the
outside.
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again
automatically as soon as you unlock the
vehicle and then open the driver's or frontpassenger door.
i The mirrors do not fold out if they have
been folded in manually.
Exterior mirror out of position
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position, proceed as follows:
X
Vehicles without electrically folding
exterior mirrors: move the exterior mirror
into the correct position manually.
X Vehicles with electrically folding
exterior mirrors (only vehicles for
Canada): press the mirror-folding button
(Y page 100) repeatedly until you hear the
mirror engage in position.
The mirror housing is engaged again and
you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 100).
Automatic anti-glare mirrors
G Warning!
The auto dimming function does not react if
incoming light is not aimed directly at sensors
in the interior rear view mirror.
The interior rear view mirror and the exterior
rear view mirror on the driver's side do not
react, for example, if the rear window
sunshade is in raised position.
Light hitting the mirror(s) at certain angles
(incident light) could blind you. As a result,
you may not be able to observe traffic
conditions and could cause an accident.
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror
on the driver's side automatically go into antiglare mode if the ignition is switched on and
incident light from headlamps strikes the
sensor in the rear-view mirror.
The mirrors do not go into anti-glare mode if
reverse gear is engaged or the interior lighting
is switched on.
Parking position for the exterior
mirror on the front-passenger side
Setting and storing the parking position
You can position the front-passenger side
exterior mirror in such a way that you can see
the rear wheel on that side as soon as you
engage reverse gear. You can store this
position.
X
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Folding the exterior mirrors in or out
automatically
101
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Memory functions
102
X
Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror to a position which allows
you to see the rear wheel and the curb.
The parking position is stored.
i If you shift the transmission to another
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 102
Version: 3.0.3.6
position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving
position.
i You can also store the parking position
using memory button M ?.
X
With the key in position 2 in the
ignition lock and with the exterior
mirror on the front-passenger side
activated, use adjustment button = to
set the exterior mirror such that the
rear wheel and curb are visible.
X Press memory button M ? and one of
the arrows on adjustment button =
within three seconds.
The parking position is stored if the
exterior mirror does not move.
If the mirror moves out of position, repeat
the steps.
Calling up a stored parking position
setting
X
With the key in position 2 in the ignition
lock and the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side activated, engage reverse
gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves back to its original position:
Ras
soon as you exceed a speed of 6 mph
(10 km/h)
Rabout ten seconds after you have
disengaged reverse gear
Rif you press button : for the exterior
mirror on the driver's side
Memory functions
Storing settings
With the memory function, you can store up
to three different settings, e.g. for three
different people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Rposition of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
Rdriver's side: steering wheel position
Rdriver's side: position of the exterior
mirrors on the driver's and front-passenger
sides
G Warning!
The memory function can still be used when
the key has been removed. For this reason,
children should never be left unsupervised in
the vehicle. They could otherwise become
trapped when adjusting the seat or the
steering wheel.
G Warning!
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side when the vehicle is stationary. You could
otherwise be distracted from the traffic
conditions by the steering wheel and seat
moving of their own accord, and as a result
cause an accident.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 103
Version: 3.0.3.6
Memory functions
103
X
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjust the seat (Y page 94).
X On the driver's side, adjust the steering
wheel (Y page 98) and the exterior mirrors
(Y page 100).
X Press memory button M and one of the
storage position buttons 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected
preset position. A tone sounds when the
settings have been completed.
Calling up a stored setting
! If you want to move the seat from the fully
reclined position to a stored seat position,
first raise the backrest. The seat could
otherwise be damaged.
X
Press and hold the relevant storage
position button 1, 2 or 3, until the seat,
steering wheel and exterior mirrors are in
the stored position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as
soon as you release the storage position
button.
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
104
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 104
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 105
Version: 3.0.3.6
105
Vehicle equipment ............................
Exterior lighting ................................
Interior lighting .................................
Changing bulbs .................................
Windshield wipers ............................
106
106
110
111
115
Lights and windshield wipers
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
106
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 106
Version: 3.0.3.6
Exterior lighting
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
Light switch
Operation
Lights and windshield wipers
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
Exterior lighting
Important safety notes
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you drive with the lights
switched on even during the daytime. In some
countries, operation of the headlamps varies
due to legal requirements and self-imposed
obligations. In these countries, the daytime
running lamps are automatically switched on
when the engine is started.
Notes on driving abroad
Converting to symmetrical low beam
when driving abroad: switch the headlamps
to symmetrical low beam in countries in
which traffic drives on the opposite side of the
road to the country where the vehicle is
registered. This prevents oncoming traffic
from being dazzled. Symmetrical lights do not
illuminate as large an area of the edge of the
road.
Have the headlamps converted at a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center, as close to the border
as possible before driving in these countries.
Converting to asymmetrical low beam
after returning: have the headlamps
converted back to asymmetrical low beam at
a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, as soon as
possible after crossing the border when
returning.
1W Left-hand standing lamps
2X Right-hand standing lamps
3T Parking lamps, license plate and
instrument lighting
4c Automatic headlamp mode/daytime
running lamps
5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps
BR Rear fog lamp
CN Front fog lamps
The turn signals, high-beam headlamps and
the high beam flasher are operated using the
combination switch (Y page 108).
! Switch off the parking lamps and standing
lamps when you leave the vehicle. This
prevents the battery from discharging.
The exterior lighting (except the parking
lamps/standing lamps) switches off
automatically if you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door with the key in
position 0
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X Turn the light switch to c.
Ropen
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 107
Version: 3.0.3.6
Exterior lighting
X
To switch on the low-beam headlamps:
turn the key in the ignition lock to position
2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The L indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
Daytime running lamps
Daytime running lamps in Canada
In Canada, the "daytime running lamps"
function is required by law. It can therefore
not be deactivated.
X Turn the light switch to c.
With the engine running: depending on the
ambient light, either the daytime running
lamps or the low-beam headlamps are
switched on.
If the low-beam headlamps are switched
on, the L indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
With the engine running while the vehicle is
stationary: if you shift the selector lever to P
from a driving position (vehicles with
automatic transmission), or if the parking
brake is applied, the low-beam headlamps
switch off automatically after 3 minutes.
With the engine running while the vehicle is
stationary: if you set the light switch to
T, the parking lamps and the low-beam
headlamps switch on.
Daytime running lamps in the USA
This function is only available on vehicles
equipped with daytime running lamps.
The daytime running lamps are deactivated
ex works on vehicles for the USA.
X To switch on the daytime running
lamps (vehicles with luxury
multifunction steering wheel): switch on
9
the "daytime running lamps" function via
the on-board computer (Y page 180).
X Turn the light switch to c.
With the engine running: depending on the
ambient light, either the daytime running
lamps or the low-beam headlamps are
switched on.
If the low-beam headlamps are switched
on, the L indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
You can only switch on the high-beam
headlamps if there is little ambient light.
However, the headlamp flashers can always
be applied.
If you set the light switch to T or L
while the engine is running, the manual
setting overrides the daytime running lamps.
Automatic headlamps
G Risk of accident
If the light switch is set to c, the low-beam
headlamps will not come on automatically if
it is foggy. This could endanger you and
others. Therefore, turn the light switch to
L in fog.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle's
lighting at all times.
X
To switch on automatic headlamp
mode: turn the light switch to c.
SmartKey in position 1 in the ignition lock:
the parking lamps are switched on or off
automatically depending on the brightness
of the ambient light.
With the engine running: depending on the
brightness of the ambient light, the daytime
running lamps9 or the low-beam headlamps
are switched on or off automatically.
When the low-beam headlamps are
switched on, the L indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
Only if daytime running lamps have been activated via the on-board computer.
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
Low-beam headlamps
107
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 108
Version: 3.0.3.6
Exterior lighting
108
Fog lamps and rear fog lamps
Front fog lamps
Only vehicles with front fog lamps have the
"fog lamps" function.
Combination switch
Turn signals
G Warning!
Lights and windshield wipers
If you suspect that driving conditions will be
foggy, turn the light switch to L before you
start your journey. Otherwise, your vehicle
may not be visible and you could endanger
yourself and others.
X
To switch on the front fog lamps: turn
the key in the ignition lock to position 2 or
start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or c.
X Press the N button.
The green N indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the front fog lamps: press
the N button.
The green N indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Rear fog lamp
X To switch on the rear fog lamp: turn the
key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start
the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or c.
When the light switch is set to c, the
rear fog lamp only lights up if the low-beam
headlamps are switched on.
X Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear fog lamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
: High-beam headlamps
; Right turn signal
= High beam flasher
? Left turn signal
X
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction
of arrow ; or ?.
High-beam headlamps
X
To switch on the high-beam headlamps:
turn the key in the ignition lock to position
2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or c.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of
arrow :.
In the c position, the high-beam
headlamps are only switched on when it is
dark and the engine is running.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 109
Version: 3.0.3.6
Exterior lighting
The K indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the high-beam
headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the high-beam
headlamps: move the combination switch
back to its normal position.
The K indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
High-beam flasher
X
To switch on: turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 1 or 2 or start the engine.
X Pull the combination switch briefly in the
direction of arrow =.
Hazard warning lamps
The hazard warning lamps automatically
switch on:
Rif
an air bag is deployed
vehicle decelerates rapidly from a
speed of more than 45 mph (70 km/h) and
comes to a standstill.
X To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on
a turn signal using the combination switch,
only the turn signal lamp on the
corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning
lamps: press button :.
Rthe
109
vehicle then reaches a speed above
6 mph (10 km/h) again.
i The hazard warning lamps still operate if
the ignition is switched off.
Headlamp cleaning system
The headlamps are cleaned automatically if
the "Wipe with washer fluid" function is
operated ten times while the lights are on and
the engine is running (Y page 116). When you
switch off the ignition, the automatic
headlamp cleaning system is reset and
counting is resumed from 0.
Active light function
The active light function is a system that
moves the headlamps according to the
steering movements of the front wheels. In
this way, relevant areas remain illuminated
while driving. This allows you to recognize
pedestrians, cyclists and animals.
Active: when the lights are switched on.
The hazard warning lamp switches off
automatically after full brake application if the
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
110
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 110
Version: 3.0.3.6
Interior lighting
Cornering light function
Interior lighting
Lights and windshield wipers
Overview of interior lighting
The cornering light function improves the
illumination of the road over a wide angle in
the direction you are turning, enabling better
visibility in tight bends, for example. It can
only be activated when the low-beam
headlamps are switched on.
Active: if you are driving at speeds below
25 mph (40 km/h) and switch on the turn
signals or turn the steering wheel.
Not active: if you are driving at speeds above
25 mph (40 km/h) or switch off the turn
signal or turn the steering wheel to the
straight-ahead position.
The cornering light function may remain lit for
a short time, but is automatically switched off
after no more than three minutes.
: u To switch the rear interior lighting
on/off
; | To switch the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
= p To switch the right-hand front
reading lamp on/off
? c To switch the front interior lighting
on/off
A p To switch the left-hand front reading
lamp on/off
B Front reading lamps
Headlamps fogged up on the inside
The headlamps may fog up on the inside if
there is high atmospheric humidity.
X Drive with the headlamps switched on.
The headlamps clear up after a short
distance.
If the moisture does not disappear, the
headlamp casing is not sealed correctly and
moisture has been able to enter.
X Have the headlamps checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
C Front interior lighting
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 111
Version: 3.0.3.6
Changing bulbs
111
Manual interior lighting control
X
To switch the front interior lighting on/
off: press the c button.
X To switch the rear interior lighting on/
off: press the u button.
X To switch the reading lamps on/off:
press the p button.
lamp on/off
; p To switch the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
Interior lighting control
Important notes
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time
except for when the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Automatic interior lighting control
X
To switch on/off: press the | button.
When the automatic interior lighting
control is activated, the button is flush with
the overhead control panel.
The interior lighting automatically switches
on if you:
Runlock
the vehicle
a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
The interior light is activated for a short while
when the key is removed from the ignition
lock. You can activate this delayed switch-off
using the on-board computer (Y page 180).
Ropen
Crash-responsive emergency lighting
If the interior lighting is set to automatic, the
interior lighting is activated automatically if
the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X To switch off the crash-responsive
emergency lighting: press the hazard
warning lamp button.
or
X Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
key.
Changing bulbs
Important safety notes
Xenon bulbs
If your vehicle is equipped with Xenon bulbs,
you can recognize this by the following: the
cone of light from the Xenon bulbs moves
from the top to the bottom and back again
when you start the engine. For this to be
observed, the lights must be switched on
before starting the engine.
G Warning!
Xenon bulbs carry a high voltage. You could
get an electric shock and be seriously or even
fatally injured if you touch the electric
contacts on Xenon bulbs. Therefore, never
remove the cover from Xenon bulbs.
Do not change Xenon bulbs yourself, but have
them replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop which has the necessary specialist
knowledge and tools to carry out the work
required.
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
Rear-compartment overhead control panel
: p To switch the right-hand reading
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
112
Changing bulbs
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this
purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety
or on safety-related systems must be carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Other bulbs
Lights and windshield wipers
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 112
Version: 3.0.3.6
G Warning!
Bulbs and lamps can be very hot. You should
therefore allow them to cool down before you
change them. Otherwise, you could be burned
if you touch them.
Keep bulbs out of the reach of children.
Otherwise, they could damage the bulbs, for
example, and injure themselves.
Never use a bulb which has been dropped.
Such a bulb may break or even explode and
injure you.
Halogen bulbs are pressurized and can
explode when you change them, particularly
if they are very hot. You should therefore wear
eye protection and gloves when you are
changing them.
There are bulbs other than the Xenon bulbs
that you cannot replace. Replace only the
bulbs listed (Y page 112). Have the bulbs that
you cannot replace yourself changed at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this
purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety
or on safety-related systems must be carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
If you require assistance changing bulbs,
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Do not touch the glass tube of new bulbs with
your bare hands. Even minor contamination
can burn into the glass surface and reduce
the service life of the bulbs. Always use a lint-
free cloth or only touch the base of the bulb
when installing.
Only use bulbs of the correct type.
If the new bulb still does not light up, consult
a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Overview: changing bulbs/bulb types
You can change the following bulbs. The bulb
type can be found in the legend.
Halogen headlamps
: Low-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
; High-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
= Parking lamp/standing lamp: W 5 W
? Parking lamp/standing lamp: W 5 W
A Turn signal lamp: 3457A
Bi-Xenon headlamps
: High-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
; Parking lamp/standing lamp: W 5 W
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 113
Version: 3.0.3.6
Changing bulbs
= Parking lamp/standing lamp: W 5 W
? Turn signal lamp: 3457A
113
X
Detach retaining spring = downwards.
X Pull out bulb ?.
X Insert the new bulb.
X Attach retaining spring =.
X Attach connector ; to bulb ?.
X Place housing cover : and turn it
clockwise until it engages.
Tail lamp with/without LED
: Fog lamp/tail lamp (driver's side), tail
lamp (passenger side): P 21 W
; Side marker lamp: W 5 W
= Turn signal lamp10: PY 21 W
? Brake lamp/tail lamp: P 21 W
A Brake lamp/tail lamp: P 21 W
B Backup lamp: P 21 W
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the hood.
X Turn housing cover : counter-clockwise
and pull it out.
X Push bulb = on connector ; down until
it is released.
X Pull connector ; from bulb =.
X Attach connector ; to new bulb =.
X Align new bulb = at the bottom and push
connector ; upwards until it engages.
X Align housing cover : and turn it
clockwise until it engages.
X
Changing the front bulbs
Low-beam headlamp (halogen
headlamp)
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the hood.
X Turn housing cover : counter-clockwise
and pull it out.
X Pull connector ; from bulb ?.
X
10 Vehicles
with LED turn signal lamps: the bulb cannot be changed.
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
High-beam headlamps
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 114
Version: 3.0.3.6
Changing bulbs
114
Standing lamps/parking lamps
X
Insert the new bulb into bulb holder : and
turn it clockwise while applying slight
pressure.
X Place bulb holder : in the headlamp so
that retainer = is upright and mark ; is
at the top.
X Insert bulb holder : into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
Lights and windshield wipers
Changing the rear bulbs
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the hood.
X Turn housing cover : counter-clockwise
and pull it out.
X Pull out bulb holder ;.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ;.
X Align housing cover : and turn it
clockwise until it engages.
X
Opening/closing the side trim
You must open the side trim panel in the trunk
before you can change the bulbs in the tail
lamps.
Turn signals
Left-hand side trim panel
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the hood.
X Turn bulb holder : counter-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Turn the bulb counter-clockwise, applying
slight pressure, and remove it from bulb
holder :.
X
Right-hand side trim panel
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 115
Version: 3.0.3.6
Windshield wipers
To open: turn release knob : 90° in the
direction of the arrow and remove side trim
panel ;.
X To close: insert side trim panel ; and turn
release knob : 90° in the opposite
direction to the arrow.
Tail lamp
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the trunk.
X Open the side trim panel (Y page 114).
X
X
Simultaneously press retaining lugs : in
the direction of the arrow and slightly pull
out the bulb holder with the bulbs.
X Vehicles with LED turn signals:
disconnect the cables of the LED turn
signal from the bulb holder connectors.
X Pull the bulb holder out with the bulbs.
? Parking lamp/standing lamp/brake
lamp/tail lamp
A Brake lamp/tail lamp
B Backup lamp
X
Rear fog lamp/turn signal lamp/
parking lamp/standing lamp/brake
lamp/tail lamp/backup lamp: press the
respective bulb back and turn it counterclockwise to remove it from the bulb
holder.
X Side marker lamp: remove bulb ; from
the bulb holder.
X Rear fog lamp/turn signal/parking
lamp/standing lamp/brake lamp/tail
lamp/backup lamp: insert the new bulb
into the bulb holder and turn it clockwise.
X Side marker lamp: insert the new bulb
into the bulb holder and press it in.
X Insert the bulb holder again and lock it in.
X Close the side trim panel (Y page 114).
Windshield wipers
Important safety notes
G Warning!
Wiper blades are components that are subject
to wear and tear. Replace the wiper blades
twice a year, preferably in the spring and fall.
Otherwise the windshield will not be wiped
properly. As a result, you may not be able to
observe surrounding traffic conditions and
could cause an accident.
! Do not operate the windshield wipers
Bulb holder without LED turn signal lamp
: Rear fog lamp/side marker lamp
; Side marker lamp
= Turn signals
when the windshield is dry, as this could
damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust
that has collected on the windshield can
scratch the glass if wiping takes place when
the windshield is dry.
If it is necessary to switch on the windshield
wipers in dry weather conditions, always
use washer fluid when operating the
windshield wipers.
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
X
115
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Windshield wipers
116
! If the windshield wipers leave smears on
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, wax or
other residues may be the reason for this.
Clean the windshield using washer fluid
after washing the vehicle in an automatic
car wash.
Switching the windshield wipers on/
off
Lights and windshield wipers
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 116
Version: 3.0.3.6
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windshield wipers in dry weather.
Vehicles with a rain sensor: in the Ä or
Å position, the appropriate wiping
frequency is automatically set according to
the intensity of the rain. In the Å position,
the rain sensor is more sensitive than in
the Ä position, causing the windshield
wipers to wipe more frequently.
Intermittent wiping is interrupted when you
stop the vehicle and open a front door. This
prevents a person from being splashed
inadvertently when getting into or out of the
vehicle.
Intermittent wiping continues when all doors
are closed and
Ryou
Combination switch
1 $ Windshield wipers off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low11
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high12
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/ î to wipe the
windshield using washer fluid
Switch the ignition on.
X Turn the combination switch to the
corresponding position.
X
i When you stop the vehicle, the wipers
wipe more slowly.
! Vehicles with a rain sensor: if the
windshield becomes dirty in dry weather
conditions, the windshield wipers may be
activated inadvertently. This could then
damage the windshield wiper blades or
scratch the windshield.
11 Rain
12 Rain
sensor set to low sensitivity.
sensor set to high sensitivity.
depress the clutch (vehicles with
manual transmission)
or
Ryou shift the automatic transmission to
drive position D (vehicles with automatic
transmission) or to reverse gear R
or
Ryou change the wipe setting on the
combination switch.
i To prevent smearing on the windshield or
noise when wiping, wipe the windshield
occasionally with washer fluid.
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
G Warning
For safety reasons, switch off the windshield
wipers and remove the key from the ignition
lock before changing the wiper blades
(vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: make sure that
the on-board electronics are in state 0).
Otherwise, the wiper motor could be switched
on suddenly and cause injury.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 117
Version: 3.0.3.6
Windshield wipers
make sure that you touch only the wiper
arm of the wiper.
Replacing the wiper blades
Removing the wiper blades
X Remove the key from the ignition lock or
turn the key to position 0 (KEYLESS-GO).
X Fold the wiper arm away from the
windshield until it engages.
X Set the wiper blade at right angles to the
wiper arm.
X
X
For safety reasons, you should remove the
key from the ignition lock.
or
X
Switch off the engine using the Start/Stop
button and open the driver's door.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windshield wipers back on.
The windshield wipers are inoperative
The windshield wiper drive is malfunctioning.
X Select another wiper speed on the
combination switch.
X Have the windshield wipers checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Remove the wiper blade from the retainer
on the wiper arm in the direction of the
arrow.
Installing the wiper blade
X Slide the new wiper blade into the retainer
on the wiper arm in the opposite direction
to the arrow.
Make sure that the wiper blade slides fully
into the retainer on the wiper arm.
X Turn the wiper blade parallel to the wiper
arm.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the
windshield.
Problems with the windshield wipers
The windshield wipers are obstructed
Leaves or snow, for example, may be
obstructing the windshield wiper movement.
The wiper motor has been deactivated.
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
! To avoid damaging the wiper blades,
117
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
118
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 118
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 119
Version: 3.0.3.6
119
Vehicle equipment ............................
Overview of climate control systems ...................................................
Operating the control systems ........
Setting the air vents .........................
120
120
122
126
Climate control
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
120
Overview of climate control systems
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
Overview of climate control systems
Important safety notes
Climate control
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 120
Version: 3.0.3.6
G Warning
Severe conditions (e.g. strong air pollution)
may require replacement of the filter before
its scheduled replacement interval. A clogged
filter will reduce the air volume to the interior
and the windows could fog up, impairing
visibility and endangering you and others.
Have a clogged filter replaced as soon as
possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
G Warning
Follow the recommended settings for heating
and cooling given on the following pages.
Otherwise, the windows could fog up,
impairing visibility and endangering you and
others.
Dual-zone automatic climate control controls
the temperature and the humidity of the
vehicle interior and filters out undesirable
substances from the air.
Dual-zone automatic climate control is only
operational when the engine is running.
Optimum operation is only achieved when
you drive with the side windows and tilt/
sliding sunroof/panorama roof with power
tilt/sliding panel closed.
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather, e.g. using the
convenience opening feature (Y page 84).
This will speed up the cooling process and
the desired vehicle interior temperature
will be reached more quickly.
i The integrated filter can filter out most
particles of dust and completely filters out
pollen. A clogged filter reduces the amount
of air supplied to the vehicle interior. For
this reason, you should always observe the
interval for replacing the filter, which is
specified in the Service Booklet. As it
depends on environmental conditions, e.g.
heavy air pollution, the interval may be
shorter than stated in the Service Booklet.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 121
Version: 3.0.3.6
Overview of climate control systems
121
Control panel for the dual-zone automatic climate control
i Notes/tips
: Sets the temperature, left
Set the temperature to 72 ‡ (22 †).
; Sets climate control to
automatic
Activate climate control using the à and ¿
buttons. The indicator lamps in the à and ¿
buttons light up.
= Switches climate control on/
off
Activate climate control using the à and ¿
buttons. The indicator lamps in the à and ¿
buttons light up.
? Switches the MONO/ZONE
function on/off13
Switches maximum cooling
MAX COOL on/off14
Use the MONO function if you want to adopt the
temperature and air distribution settings from the
driver's side for the front-passenger side. The
indicator lamp in the º button lights up.
A Switches cooling with air
dehumidification on/off
Activate climate control using the à and ¿
buttons. The indicator lamps in the à and ¿
buttons light up.
B Defrosts the windshield
Only use the "defrosting" function briefly until the
windshield is clear again.
C Activates/deactivates airrecirculation mode
Only use "air-recirculation" mode briefly, e.g. if there
are unpleasant outside odors or when in a tunnel. The
windows could otherwise fog up as, in airrecirculation mode, no fresh air is drawn into the
vehicle.
D Sets the temperature, right
Set the temperature to 72 ‡ (22 †).
E Switches the rear window
heating on/off
F Increases the airflow
13 Only
14 Only
for Canada.
for USA.
Z
Climate control
Function
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 122
Version: 3.0.3.6
Operating the control systems
122
Function
i Notes/tips
G Reduces the airflow
H Display
I Sets the air distribution
Operating the control systems
Switching the control on/off
Important information
Climate control
G Warning!
When the climate control system is
deactivated, the outside air supply and
circulation are also deactivated. Only choose
this setting for a short time. Otherwise the
windows could fog up, impairing visibility and
endangering you and others.
i Activate climate control primarily using
the à button (Y page 123).
Activating/deactivating
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X Press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previously selected settings come
into effect again.
X To deactivate: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
Switching cooling with air
dehumidification on/off
Important information
The cooling with air dehumidification function
is only available when the engine is running.
The air inside the vehicle is cooled and
dehumidified according to the temperature
selected.
G Warning
If you switch off the cooling function, the
vehicle will not be cooled when weather
conditions are warm. The windows can fog up
more quickly. Window fogging may impair
visibility and endanger you and others.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when automatic climate control is
in cooling mode. This is normal and not a sign
that there is a malfunction.
i The cooling with air dehumidification
function uses refrigerant R134a. This
coolant does not contain
chlorofluorocarbons, and therefore does
not damage the ozone layer.
Activating/deactivating
i The evaporator is ventilated when the airconditioning system is operated. The
blower switches on automatically
approximately one hour after the vehicle is
locked. The blower runs for 30 minutes on
the lowest level. The blower noise is normal
and not a sign that there is a malfunction.
If you unlock the vehicle during this time,
the ventilation will be interrupted. To save
battery power, the evaporator will not
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 123
Version: 3.0.3.6
Operating the control systems
X
To switch on: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up.
X To switch off: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes
out. The cooling with air dehumidification
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
Problems with the "cooling with air
dehumidification" function
If the indicator lamp in the ¿ button does
not go out when switched off, the cooling with
air dehumidification function is switched off
due to a malfunction. You can no longer
activate the cooling with air dehumidification
function.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Setting climate control to automatic
G Warning
If you switch off the cooling function, the
vehicle will not be cooled when weather
conditions are warm. The windows can fog up
more quickly. Window fogging may impair
visibility and endanger you and others.
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the
temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow
and the air distribution.
Automatic mode will achieve optimal
operation if cooling with air dehumidification
is also activated. If desired, cooling with air
dehumidification can be deactivated.
15 USA
X
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are activated.
X
To deactivate: press the _ button.
or
X
Press the K or I button.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are deactivated.
Setting the temperature
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
X
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X To increase/reduce: turn controls : and
D clockwise or counter-clockwise
(Y page 121). Only change the temperature
setting in small increments. Start at
72 ‡ (22 †).
Setting the air distribution
Dual-zone automatic climate control: the air
distribution can be set individually for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
¯ directs the airflow through the
defroster vents
P directs the airflow through the center
and side air vents
O directs the airflow through the footwell
air vents
S directs the airflow through the center
and side air vents, as well as the
footwell air vents15
only.
Z
Climate control
ventilate automatically if the starter battery
is weak.
123
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Operating the control systems
124
_ directs the airflow to the entire vehicle
interior16
b directs the airflow through the
defroster, center and side air vents16
a directs the airflow through the footwell
and defroster vents
You can use this function to defrost the
windshield or to defrost the inside of the
windshield and the side windows.
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
X
airflow is always directed through the side
air vents. The side air vents can only be
closed when the controls on the side air
vents are turned downwards.
X
Climate control
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 124
Version: 3.0.3.6
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the _ button repeatedly until the
desired symbol appears in the display.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out. Automatic control is deactivated and
the air distribution is controlled according
to the selected setting.
Setting the airflow
Defrosting the windshield
i You should only select the defrosting
function until the windshield is clear again.
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X To activate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
Rcooling
with air dehumidification on
airflow17
Rhigh temperature17
Rair distribution to the windshield and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
Rhigh
X
X
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X To increase/reduce: press the K or
I button.
To deactivate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previously selected settings come
into effect again. The cooling with air
dehumidification function remains on. Airrecirculation mode remains deactivated.
or
Switching the MONO function on/off
This function is only available in vehicles in
Canada.
You can use the MONO function to adopt the
temperature and air distribution settings on
the driver's side for the front-passenger side.
X Press the º button.
The indicator lamp in the º button lights
up or goes out.
X
Press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X
Turn controls : or D clockwise or
counter-clockwise (Y page 121).
or
X
Press the K or I button.
Maximum cooling MAX COOL
The MAX COOL function is only available in
vehicles for the USA.
16 Canada
only.
on the outside temperature.
17 Depending
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 125
Version: 3.0.3.6
Operating the control systems
Rmaximum
cooling
airflow
Rair-recirculation mode on
X To activate: press the Ù button.
The indicator lamp in the button lights up.
X To deactivate: press the Ù button
again.
The indicator lamp goes out. The previously
selected settings come into effect again.
Rmaximum
Defrosting the windows
Windows fogged up on the inside
X
Activate the "cooling with air
dehumidification" function ¿.
X Activate automatic mode Ã.
X If the windows continue to fog up, activate
the defrosting function (Y page 124).
i You should only select this setting until
the windshield is clear again.
Windows fogged up on the outside
X
Switch on the windshield wipers.
X Press the _ button repeatedly until the
O or P symbol appears in the
display.
i You should only select this setting until
the windshield is clear again.
Rear window heating
Activating/deactivating
G Warning
Any accumulation of snow and ice should be
removed from the rear window before driving.
Visibility could otherwise be impaired,
endangering you and others.
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as
soon as the window is clear as it only switches
off automatically after several minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear
window heating may switch off.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Press the ¤ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
Problems with the rear window heating
The rear window heating has deactivated
itself prematurely or cannot be activated.
X Switch off any consumers that are not
required, e.g. reading lamps or interior
lighting.
When the battery is sufficiently charged,
the rear window heating is activated again
automatically.
Activating/deactivating airrecirculation mode
You can deactivate the flow of fresh air if
unpleasant odors are entering the vehicle
from outside. The air already inside the
vehicle will then be recirculated.
G Warning
Fogged windows impair visibility,
endangering you and others. If the windows
begin to fog on the inside, switching off the
air recirculation mode immediately should
clear interior window fogging. If interior
window fogging persists, make sure the air
conditioning is activated, or press the ¬
button.
X
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X To activate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up.
Z
Climate control
MAX COOL is only operational when the
engine is running.
When you activate MAX COOL, climate
control switches to the following functions:
125
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 126
Version: 3.0.3.6
Setting the air vents
126
i Air-recirculation mode is activated
automatically at high outside
temperatures. When air-recirculation mode
is activated automatically, the indicator
lamp in the g button is not lit.
Outside air is added after about 30
minutes.
X
To deactivate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out.
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
Rkeep
the air inlet between the windshield
and the hood free of blockages, such as ice,
snow or leaves
Rnever cover the vents or air inlet and outlet
grilles in the vehicle interior.
i For virtually draft-free ventilation, adjust
the sliders of the air vents to the center
position.
i Air-recirculation mode switches off
automatically:
Climate control
Rafter
approximately five minutes if
outside temperatures are under about
41 ‡ (5 †)
Rafter approximately five minutes if
cooling with air dehumidification is
deactivated
Rafter approximately 30 minutes if outside
temperatures are over about
41 ‡ (5 †)
Setting the center air vents
Setting the air vents
Important safety notes
G Warning
When operating the climate control, the air
that enters the passenger compartment
through the air vents can be very hot or very
cold (depending on the set temperature). This
could cause burns or frostbite to unprotected
skin in the immediate area of the air vents.
Always keep sufficient distance between
unprotected parts of the body and the air
vents. If necessary, use the air distribution
adjustment to direct the air to air vents in the
vehicle interior that are not in the immediate
area of unprotected skin.
: Center air vent, left
; Center air vent, right
= Center vent thumbwheel, right
? Center vent thumbwheel, left
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheels =
and ? up or down.
Setting the side air vents
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 127
Version: 3.0.3.6
Setting the air vents
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel = up or
down.
i Side window defroster vent : is never
completely shut, even if side air vent ; is
shut.
127
Setting the rear-compartment air
vents
Setting the center vents in the rear
compartment
Setting the air vent in the glove box
! Close the air vent when heating the
vehicle.
At high outside temperatures, open the air
vent and activate the "cooling with air
dehumidification" function. Otherwise,
temperature-sensitive items stored in the
glove box could be damaged.
: Rear-compartment air vent thumbwheel
; Rear-compartment air vent, right
= Rear-compartment air vent, left
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel : up or
down.
: Air vent thumbwheel
; Air vent
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel :
clockwise or counter-clockwise.
Z
Climate control
When automatic climate control is activated,
the glove box can be ventilated, for instance
to cool its contents. The level of airflow
depends on the airflow and air distribution
settings.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
128
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 128
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 129
Version: 3.0.3.6
129
Vehicle equipment ............................
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle
Driving ...............................................
Manual transmission ........................
Automatic transmission ...................
Refueling ............................................
Parking ...............................................
Driving tips ........................................
Driving systems ................................
130
130
130
137
138
145
148
150
156
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
130
Driving
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
Driving and parking
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 130
Version: 3.0.3.6
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle
Additional breaking-in notes for AMG
vehicles:
RFor
the first 1000 miles (1500 km), do not
exceed a speed of 85 mph (140 km/h).
ROnly allow the engine to briefly reach a
maximum engine speed of 4500 rpm.
RShift gears in good time.
i Also observe these breaking-in notes
when the vehicle's engine or axle gear have
been replaced.
i Always observe the respective limit
speeds.
The first 1000 miles (1500 km)
The more you look after the engine when it is
new, the happier you will be with its
performance in the future.
RDrive
at varying vehicle speeds and engine
speeds for the first 1000 miles (1500 km)
for this reason.
RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RChange gear in good time, at the latest
when the tachometer needle is 2/3 of the
way to the red area in the tachometer
display.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
RIdeally, drive program C should be selected
for driving the first 1000 miles (1500 km).
RDo not manually shift to a lower gear to
brake the vehicle.
RIf possible, do not depress the accelerator
pedal past the point of resistance
(kickdown).
ROnly select shift ranges 3, 2 or 1 when
driving slowly, e.g. in mountainous terrain.
After 1000 miles (1500 km) you may
gradually bring the vehicle up to full road and
engine speeds.
AMG vehicles with rear axle locking
differential
Your vehicle is equipped with a self-locking
differential on the rear axle. Change the oil
after a breaking-in period of
2000 miles(3000 km) to improve protection
of the rear axle differential. This oil change
extends the service life of the differential.
Have the oil change carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you use an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center for this purpose.
Driving
Important safety notes
G Warning
Make sure absolutely no objects are
obstructing the pedals' range of movement.
Keep the driver's footwell clear of all
obstacles. If there are any floormats or
carpets in the footwell, make sure the pedals
still have sufficient clearance.
During sudden driving or braking maneuvers
the objects could get caught between the
pedals. You could then no longer brake or
accelerate. This could lead to accidents and
injury.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 131
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving
G Warning
On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in
order to obtain braking action. This could
result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle
control. Your vehicle's ABS will not prevent
this type of loss of control.
SmartKey positions
SmartKey
G Warning
Manual transmission: Wait until the vehicle is
stationary before removing the SmartKey
from the starter switch. The vehicle cannot be
steered when the SmartKey is removed from
the starter switch.
G Warning
It is dangerous to shift the automatic
transmission out of parking position P or
neutral position N if the engine speed is
higher than idle speed. If your foot is not firmly
on the brake pedal, the vehicle could
accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You
could lose control of the vehicle and hit
someone or something. Only shift into gear
when the engine is idling normally and when
your right foot is firmly on the brake pedal.
! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use
the engine's full performance until it has
reached operating temperature.
Only shift the automatic transmission to
the desired drive position when the vehicle
is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery
roads. You could otherwise damage the
drive train.
! AMG vehicles: at low engine oil
temperatures (below 68 ‡ (+20 †), the
maximum engine speed is restricted in
order to protect the engine. To protect the
engine and maintain smooth engine
operation, avoid driving at full throttle when
the engine is cold.
131
g To remove the SmartKey
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position P.
1 Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windshield wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 To start the engine
Once the ignition is switched on, all the
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light
up. The indicator lamps of the low-beam
headlamps, high-beam headlamps, turn
signal lamps or front fog lamps only light up
if the low-beam headlamps, high-beam
headlamps, turn signal lamps or front fog
lamps are switched on. If an indicator lamp
does not light up when the ignition is switched
on, check it and replace it if necessary. If an
indicator lamp does not go out after starting
the engine or lights up while the vehicle is in
motion, see (Y page 203).
If the SmartKey is in position 0 in the ignition
lock for an extended period of time, it can no
longer be turned in the ignition lock. The
steering is then locked. To unlock, remove the
SmartKey and reinsert it in the ignition lock.
The steering is locked when you remove the
SmartKey from the ignition lock.
X Remove the SmartKey when the engine is
switched off.
The battery may otherwise discharge.
Z
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Driving and parking
132
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 132
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving
If you cannot turn the SmartKey in the ignition
lock, the vehicle battery may not be charged
sufficiently.
X Check the vehicle battery and charge if
necessary (Y page 261).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 262).
i The SmartKey can be turned in the
ignition lock even if it is not the correct
SmartKey for the vehicle. The ignition is not
switched on. The engine cannot be started.
KEYLESS-GO
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO are equipped with
a SmartKey with an integrated KEYLESS-GO
function and a detachable Start/Stop button.
The Start/Stop button must be inserted in the
ignition lock and the SmartKey must be in the
vehicle.
Pressing the Start/Stop button several times
in succession corresponds to the different
key positions in the ignition lock. This is only
the case if you are not depressing the brake
pedal.
If you depress the brake pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts
immediately.
The Start/Stop button can be removed from
the ignition lock. Then you can insert the
SmartKey in the ignition lock.
: Start/Stop button
; Ignition lock
X
Insert Start/Stop button : into ignition
lock ;.
i When you insert Start/Stop button :
into ignition lock ;, the system requires a
detection time of two seconds before you
can use Start/Stop button :.
X
Vehicles with manual transmission: shift to
neutral.
or
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift
the transmission to position N.
X
Do not press the brake pedal.
i You do not have to remove the Start/Stop
button from the ignition lock when you
leave the vehicle. However, you should
always take the SmartKey with you when
leaving the vehicle. The vehicle can be
started with the Start/Stop button and the
electrical equipment can be operated while
the SmartKey is in the vehicle.
Start/Stop button
= USA only
? Canada only
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 133
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving
Position 0: if Start/Stop button : has not
yet been pressed, this corresponds to the
SmartKey being removed from the ignition.
X Position 1: press Start/Stop button :.
You can now activate the windshield
wipers, for example.
i If you then open the driver's door when in
this position, the power supply is
deactivated.
X
Position 2 (ignition): press Start/Stop
button : twice.
i If you press Start/Stop button : once
when in this position and the driver's door
is open, the power supply is deactivated
again.
As soon as the ignition is switched on, all the
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster light
up. The indicator lamps of the low-beam
headlamps, high-beam headlamps, turn
signal lamps or front fog lamps only light up
if the low-beam headlamps, high-beam
headlamps, turn signal lamps or front fog
lamps are switched on. If an indicator lamp
does not light up when the ignition is switched
on, check it and replace it if necessary. If an
indicator lamp does not go out after the
engine is started or if it lights up while the
vehicle is in motion, see (Y page 203).
Starting the engine
Important safety notes
G Warning
Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your
health. All exhaust gas contains carbon
monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause
unconsciousness and possible death.
Do not run the engine in confined areas (such
as a garage) which are not properly ventilated.
If you think that exhaust gas fumes are
entering the vehicle while driving, have the
cause determined and corrected
immediately. If you must drive under these
conditions, drive only with at least one
window fully open at all times.
! Do not depress the accelerator pedal
when starting the engine.
Manual transmission
X
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Fully depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to neutral N.
i You can only start the engine when the
clutch pedal is fully depressed.
Automatic transmission
X
Shift the transmission to position P.
i The transmission position display in the
multifunction display shows P.
Starting procedure with the SmartKey
X
Turn the SmartKey to position 3 in the
ignition lock (Y page 131) and release it as
soon as the engine is running.
Using KEYLESS-GO to start the engine
G Warning!
As long as the SmartKey is in your vehicle, the
vehicle can be started. Therefore, never leave
children unattended in the vehicle, as they
could otherwise accidentally start the engine.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Do
not leave children unattended in the vehicle,
or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A
child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could
result in an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
i The Start/Stop button can be used to
start the vehicle without inserting the
SmartKey in the ignition lock. The
SmartKey must be in the vehicle.
Z
Driving and parking
X
133
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Driving
134
X
The Start/Stop button must be inserted in
the ignition lock.
i To start the engine with the SmartKey
Driving and parking
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 134
Version: 3.0.3.6
instead of with KEYLESS-GO, remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock.
X
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Press the Start/Stop button once
(Y page 132).
The engine starts.
Pulling away
Automatic transmission
G Warning
It is dangerous to shift the automatic
transmission out of parking position P or
neutral position N if the engine speed is
higher than idle speed. If your foot is not firmly
on the brake pedal, the vehicle could
accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You
could lose control of the vehicle and hit
someone or something. Only shift into gear
when the engine is idling normally and when
your right foot is firmly on the brake pedal.
i It is only possible to shift the transmission
from position P to the desired position if
you depress the brake pedal. Only then is
the selector lever lock released.
Manual transmission
X
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Fully depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to either 1st gear or reverse gear R.
X Release the parking brake (Y page 149).
X Release the brake pedal.
X Slowly release the clutch pedal and gently
depress the accelerator pedal.
! If a warning signal sounds and the
Release the parking brake message
appears in the instrument cluster, the
parking brake is still applied. Release the
parking brake.
! Change gear in good time and avoid
spinning the wheels. You could otherwise
damage the vehicle.
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic
locking feature (Y page 181).
X
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
X Wait until the gear change is completed
before pulling away.
X Release the parking brake (Y page 149).
X Release the brake pedal.
X Carefully depress the accelerator pedal.
! If a warning tone sounds and the
Release Park. Brake message appears
in the instrument cluster, the parking brake
is still applied. Release the parking brake.
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic
locking feature (Y page 181).
i Upshifts take place at higher engine
speeds after a cold start. This helps the
catalytic converter to reach its operating
temperature more quickly.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 135
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving
135
Hill start assist
Driving and parking
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away
forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient.
It holds the vehicle for a short time after you
have removed your foot from the brake pedal.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
and depress it before the vehicle begins to
roll.
G Warning
Never leave the vehicle when it is held by hill
start assist. After approximately one second,
hill start assist will no longer brake your
vehicle and it could roll away.
X
Take your foot off the brake pedal.
i Once you have taken your foot off the
brake pedal, the vehicle is held for around
one second.
X
Pull away.
Hill start assist will not function if:
Ryou
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission is in position N.
Rthe parking brake is applied.
RESP® is malfunctioning.
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
136
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 136
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving
Driving and parking
Problems with the engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
can be heard.
RThere
is a malfunction in the engine electronics.
is a malfunction in the fuel supply.
X Turn the SmartKey back to position 0 in the ignition lock before
the next attempt to start with the SmartKey.
X Before the next starting attempt with KEYLESS-GO: shut all open
vehicle doors so that the signals from the SmartKey may be
better received.
or
X Pull the Start/Stop button out of the ignition.
X Use the SmartKey to start the engine, (Y page 133) as external
radio signals cause KEYLESS-GO to malfunction. Avoid
excessively long and frequent attempts to start the engine as
these will drain the battery.
RThere
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine does not
start. You cannot hear
the starter motor.
The on-board voltage is too low because the starter battery is too
weak or discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 262).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high.
X Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two
minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 137
Version: 3.0.3.6
Manual transmission
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine is not
running smoothly and
is misfiring.
There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or a mechanical
component of the engine management system.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic
converter and damage it.
The coolant
temperature gauge
shows a value above
248 ‡(120 †).
The coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine
is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant
to cool down.
X Check the coolant level (Y page 240). Observe the warning
notes as you do so and add coolant if necessary.
Manual transmission
! When shifting between 5th and 6th gear,
you should always push the gear lever all
the way to the right. You could otherwise
shift unintentionally into 3rd or 4th gear
and damage the transmission.
If you shift down at too high a speed
(transmission braking), this can cause the
engine to overrev, leading to engine
damage.
Never hold the vehicle stopped on a hill by
using the clutch pedal. There is otherwise
a risk of damaging the clutch.
Important safety notes
G Warning
When working on the vehicle, engage the
parking brake and shift the manual
transmission into the 1st gear or reverse R.
The vehicle could otherwise roll away, which
could result in an accident and/or serious
personal injury.
Gear lever
Engaging reverse gear
! Only shift into reverse gear R when the
vehicle is stationary as you can otherwise
damage the transmission.
X
Stop the vehicle.
Depress the clutch pedal fully.
X Shift to neutral.
X Move the gear lever firmly to the left
beyond the point of resistance and then
forwards.
X
Gear lever
k
Reverse
1 to 6 Forward gears
Z
137
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Automatic transmission
138
Shift recommendation
Driving and parking
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 138
Version: 3.0.3.6
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The
recommended gear is shown in the
multifunction display.
Otherwise the vehicle could roll away which
could result in an accident and/or serious
personal injury.
Selector lever
Overview of transmission positions
X
Shift gear according to the gearshift
recommendation : shown in the
multifunction display of the instrument
cluster.
Automatic transmission
Important safety notes
G Warning
Selector lever
P Park position with selector lever lock
R Reverse
N Neutral
D Drive
Transmission position display
It is dangerous to shift the automatic
transmission out of parking position P or
neutral position N if the engine speed is
higher than idle speed. If your foot is not firmly
on the brake pedal, the vehicle could
accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You
could lose control of the vehicle and hit
someone or something. Only shift into gear
when the engine is idling normally and when
your right foot is firmly on the brake pedal.
G Warning!
Keep in mind that turning off the engine alone
only will shift the automatic transmission into
neutral position N automatically.
Always shift the automatic transmission into
park position P before turning off the engine.
: Transmission position display
Displays on the cover beside the selector
lever also indicate the current position of the
selector lever.
The displays light up when the SmartKey is
inserted in the ignition lock. The displays go
out when the SmartKey is removed from the
ignition lock.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 139
Version: 3.0.3.6
Automatic transmission
Drive program display
A
: Drive program display
! Driving in neutral N can
Transmission positions
B
C
Park position
Do not shift the transmission into
position P unless the vehicle is
stationary. The parking lock should
not be used as a brake when
parking. In addition to engaging the
parking lock, you must always
apply the parking brake to secure
the vehicle.
The SmartKey can only be removed
if the transmission is in position P.
If the SmartKey is removed from
the ignition lock, the selector lever
is locked.
In the event of a fault in the vehicle
electronics, the selector lever can
be locked in position P. To release
the selector lever lock, see
"Releasing the parking lock
manually" (Y page 144).
Reverse
Only shift the transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
Neutral
Do not shift the transmission to N
while driving. The transmission
could otherwise be damaged.
No power is transmitted from the
engine to the drive wheels.
Releasing the brakes will allow you
to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to
push it or tow it.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty:
only shift the transmission to
position N if the vehicle is in danger
of skidding, e.g. on icy roads.
damage the drive train.
7
Drive
The automatic transmission
changes gear automatically. All
forward gears are available.
Gearshifting
The automatic transmission shifts to the
individual gears automatically when it is in
transmission position D. This automatic
gearshifting behavior is determined by:
Ra
shift range restriction, if selected
selected drive program
E/S or M (vehicles with the dynamic
handling package and AMG vehicles)
(Y page 140)
Rthe position of the accelerator pedal
Rthe road speed
Rthe
Driving tips
AMG vehicles
When shifting down, the double-clutch
function is active regardless of the currently
selected drive program. The double-clutch
function reduces load change reactions and
is conducive to a sporty driving style. The
Z
139
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 140
Version: 3.0.3.6
Automatic transmission
140
Driving and parking
sound generated by the double-clutch
function depends on the drive program
selected.
Kickdown
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration.
X
Vehicles for USA except AMG vehicles:
fully depress the accelerator pedal.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Vehicles for Canada except AMG
vehicles: depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
Program selector button on AMG vehicles
Working on the vehicle
G Warning
When working on the vehicle, engage the
parking brake and shift the automatic
transmission into park position P. Otherwise
the vehicle could roll away which could result
in an accident and/or serious personal injury.
Program selector button
Program selector button on vehicles with the
dynamic handling package
E Economy
Comfortable, economical
driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
i For further information on "Automatic
drive program" (Y page 141).
Program selector button
Only change from automatic drive program
E or S to manual drive program M when the
vehicle is stationary.
X Press program selector button :
repeatedly until the letter for the desired
gearshift program appears in the
multifunction display.
i The automatic transmission switches to
automatic drive program E each time the
engine is started.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 141
Version: 3.0.3.6
Automatic transmission
Steering wheel paddle shifters
141
Shift ranges
When the automatic transmission is in
position D, it is possible to restrict or
derestrict the shift range (Y page 141).
The shift range selected is shown in the
multifunction display. The automatic
transmission shifts only as far as the selected
gear.
Driving situations
: Left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter
=
You can use the engine's braking
effect.
In the automatic drive program, you can
restrict or derestrict the shift range by using
the steering wheel paddle shifters
(Y page 141).
In the manual drive program, you can change
gear using the steering wheel paddle shifters
or the selector lever (Y page 141).
5
To use the braking effect of the
engine on downhill gradients and
for driving:
i You can only change gear with the
4
; Right-hand steering wheel paddle shifter
Ron
steep mountain roads
mountainous terrain
Rin arduous conditions
Rin
steering wheel paddle shifters when the
transmission is in position D.
Automatic drive program
Drive program E is characterized by the
following:
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears, unless the
accelerator pedal is depressed fully
Rincreased sensitivity, which improves
driving stability on slippery road surfaces,
for example
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
sooner, which results in the vehicle being
driven at lower engine speeds and the
wheels being less likely to spin
In drive program S, the automatic
transmission shifts up later.
To use the braking effect of the
engine on extremely steep downhill
gradients and on long downhill
stretches
Restricting the shift range
X
Press the selector lever to the left towards
D–.
or
X
Pull the left-hand steering wheel paddle
shifter.
The shift range is restricted.
i In order to prevent the engine from
overrevving, the automatic transmission
does not shift down when the engine speed
is too high.
i If the maximum engine speed for the shift
range is reached and you continue to
accelerate, the automatic transmission
shifts up in order to prevent the engine
from overrevving, even if the shift range is
restricted.
Z
Driving and parking
Introduction
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Automatic transmission
142
Derestricting the shift range
X
Driving and parking
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 142
Version: 3.0.3.6
Briefly press the selector lever to the right
towards D+.
or
X
Pull the right-hand steering wheel paddle
shifter.
The shift range is derestricted.
Clearing the shift range restriction
X
Press and hold the selector lever towards
D+ until D is shown once more in the
multifunction display.
Manual drive program M can be selected
using the program selector button. You can
change gears using the steering wheel paddle
shifters or the selector lever in manual drive
program M if the transmission is in position
D. The gear selected is shown in the
multifunction display.
X Press program selector button
(Y page 140) repeatedly until M appears in
the multifunction display.
Upshifting
i Vehicles with the dynamic handling
package: if the maximum engine speed for
the shift range is reached and you continue
to accelerate, the automatic transmission
shifts up, except when manual program M
is selected.
or
X
Pull and hold the right-hand steering wheel
paddle shifter until D is shown again in the
multifunction display.
The automatic transmission shifts from the
current shift range directly to D.
Selecting the ideal shift range
Vehicles with AMG engines
X Briefly press the selector lever to the right
towards D+.
X
or
Press the selector lever to the left towards
D– and hold it in position.
or
X
Pull the left-hand steering wheel paddle
shifter and hold it in position.
The automatic transmission shifts to the
gear which allows ideal acceleration and
deceleration. To do this, the automatic
transmission shifts down one or more
gears.
X
Pull the right-hand steering wheel paddle
shifter (Y page 141).
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
AMG vehicles: before the engine speed
reaches the red area, you will see an upshift
indicator in the multifunction display.
Manual drive program
Switching on the manual drive program
The manual drive program is only available for
vehicles with the dynamic handling package
and for AMG vehicles.
Manual drive program M is different from
drive program S with regard to spontaneity,
responsiveness and smoothness of gear
changes.
: Gear indicator
; Upshift indicator
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 143
Version: 3.0.3.6
Automatic transmission
Downshifting
Switching off the manual drive program
X
X
Briefly press the selector lever to the left
towards D–.
or
X
Pull the left-hand steering wheel paddle
shifter (Y page 141).
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
AMG vehicles: press the program selector
button (Y page 140) repeatedly until E or
S appears in the multifunction display.
X Vehicles with the dynamic handling
package: press the program selector
button (Y page 140). M is no longer shown
in the multifunction display.
i If you brake the vehicle or stop without
shifting down, the automatic transmission
will shift down to a gear that will allow the
vehicle to accelerate or pull away again.
i Vehicles with the dynamic handling
package: to avoid overrevving the engine
when downshifting, the automatic
transmission does not shift to a lower gear
if this would result in the maximum engine
speed being exceeded.
i If you desire maximum acceleration, push
the selector lever to the left or pull and hold
the left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter
until the transmission shifts to the optimal
gear for the current speed.
Kickdown
i Vehicles with an AMG engine: it is not
possible to use kickdown in manual drive
program M.
You can also use kickdown for maximum
acceleration in manual drive program M.
X
Vehicles for USA: fully depress the
accelerator pedal.
The automatic transmission shifts to a
lower gear depending on the engine speed.
X Vehicles for Canada: depress the
accelerator pedal beyond the pressure
point.
The automatic transmission shifts to a
lower gear depending on the engine speed.
i During kickdown, you cannot change gear
using the steering wheel paddle shifters or
the selector lever.
Z
143
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 144
Version: 3.0.3.6
Automatic transmission
144
Problems with the transmission
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode.
is deteriorating.
It is only possible to shift into 2nd gear and reverse gear.
The transmission no
X Stop the vehicle.
longer changes gear.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Wait at least 10 seconds before restarting the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
If D is selected, the transmission shifts into 2nd gear; if R is
selected, the transmission shifts into reverse gear.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
Releasing the parking lock manually
In the event of an electrical malfunction, it is
possible to release the selector lever lock
manually to move it out of position P, e.g. if
you wish to tow the vehicle away.
cloth) from the right-hand edge, pulling it
up and out.
X Press release button ; down and
simultaneously move the selector lever out
of position P.
The selector lever can now be moved freely
until it is returned to position P.
Transfer case
This section is only valid for vehicles with 4wheel drive (4MATIC). Power is always
transmitted to both axles.
! Performance tests may only be carried
! Do not use any sharp-edged objects to
remove the selector lever cover in the
center console. This can damage the
selector lever cover.
X
X
Depress the parking brake firmly.
Pry out selector lever gaiter : with a flat,
blunt object (e.g. a screwdriver wrapped in
out on a 2-axle dynamometer. The brake
system or transfer case could otherwise be
damaged. Contact an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center for a performance
test. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
for this purpose.
! If the parking brake is being tested on a
brake dynamometer, the ignition must be
switched off (SmartKey or Start/Stop
button in position 0 or 1), as ESP® will
otherwise automatically intervene. The
brake system could otherwise be damaged.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 145
Version: 3.0.3.6
Refueling
Refueling
Important safety notes
G Warning
Gasoline is highly flammable and poisonous.
It burns violently and can cause serious
personal injury.
Never allow sparks, flames or smoking
materials near gasoline.
Turn off the engine before refueling.
Whenever you are around gasoline, avoid
inhaling fumes and any skin or clothing
contact.
Direct skin contact with fuels and the
inhalation of fuel vapors are damaging to your
health.
! Do not switch on the ignition if you
accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel.
Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel lines.
Notify a qualified specialist workshop and
have the fuel tank and fuel lines drained
completely.
gasoline
Fuel grade
! You should only refuel with unleaded
G Warning
premium-grade gasoline as this avoids
damaging the catalytic converter.
Flexible fuel vehicles (recognizable by the
sticker Premium gasoline or E85 only! on
the inside of the fuel filler flap) can be
refueled with E85. For further information
on flexible fuel, see "Fuel".
If engine running problems are apparent,
have the cause checked immediately and
repaired. Excess unburned fuel can
otherwise enter the catalytic converter,
leading to overheating and possibly
causing a fire.
G Warning!
i Only refuel with unleaded premium-grade
Overfilling of the fuel tank may create
pressure in the system which could cause a
gas discharge. This could cause the gasoline
to spray back out when removing the fuel
pump nozzle, which could cause personal
injury.
C 300 and C 300 Sport with automatic
transmission:
Flexible Fuel Vehicles (identified by a label
reading Premium gasoline or E85 only! on
the fuel filler flap):
Ethanol fuel (E85) and its fumes are highly
flammable, poisonous and burn easily.
Ethanol fuel can cause serious injuries if
ignited or if you come into contact with it or
inhale fumes of it. Avoid inhalation of ethanol
fumes and skin contact with ethanol.
Extinguish all open flames before refueling.
Never smoke or create sparks close to
ethanol.
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
gasoline engine. Even small amounts of the
wrong fuel result in damage to the fuel
system and engine.
145
gasoline with a specified minimum octane
number of 91 (average value of 96 RON/
86 MON).
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find
the label on the gasoline pump, ask the gas
station staff.
C 300 and C 300 Sport with automatic
transmission: you can recognize flexible
fuel vehicles by the sticker Premium
gasoline or E85 only! on the inside of the
fuel filler flap.
You can find further information under
"Fuel" (Y page 306), by consulting an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or
visiting http://www.mbusa.com (USA
only).
Z
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Refueling
146
Refueling
Fuel filler flap
Driving and parking
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 146
Version: 3.0.3.6
The fuel filler flap is unlocked or locked
automatically when you open or close the
vehicle with the SmartKey or using KEYLESSGO.
The position of the fuel filler flap is to the rear
on the right. The position of the fuel filler cap
is displayed in the instrument cluster 8.
The arrow next to the gas pump indicates the
side of the vehicle.
removed. The driver's door can be closed
again.
X Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap opens slightly.
X Open the fuel filler flap.
X Turn the fuel filler cap counter-clockwise
and remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder
bracket on the inside of filler flap ;.
X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel
pump nozzle into the tank and refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
Closing
X
: To open the fuel filler flap
; To insert the fuel filler cap
= Tire pressure table
? Fuel type
Replace the fuel filler cap and turn it
clockwise. The fuel filler cap audibly
engages.
i Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
vehicle. A locking pin otherwise prevents
the fuel filler flap from closing after the
vehicle has been locked.
X
Close the fuel filler flap.
Opening
X
Switch off the engine.
i When the engine is running and the fuel
filler flap is open, the ; engine
diagnostics warning lamp may light up.
For further information on warning and
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster,
see (Y page 210).
X
Remove the SmartKey from the ignition
lock.
KEYLESS-GO: the driver's door is open.
This returns the ignition to position 0,
which corresponds to the SmartKey being
Emergency fuel filler flap release
G Warning!
Avoid contact with the vehicle walls as they
may contain sharp edges. Otherwise, you
could injure yourself while releasing the fuel
filler flap.
The emergency release is located behind the
side trim panel in the trunk.
X Open the trunk lid.
X Open the right-hand side trim panel
(Y page 268).
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 147
Version: 3.0.3.6
147
Driving and parking
Refueling
X
Pull emergency release : in the direction
of the arrow.
The fuel filler flap is unlocked.
X Open the fuel filler flap.
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
148
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 148
Version: 3.0.3.6
Parking
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Driving and parking
Problem
Fuel is leaking from the
vehicle.
The fuel filler flap
cannot be opened.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of explosion or fire
The fuel line or the fuel tank is defective.
X Turn the key to position 0(Y page 131) in the ignition lock
immediately and remove it.
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The fuel filler flap is not unlocked.
or
The key batteries are discharged.
X Unlock the vehicle using the mechanical key (Y page 73).
X Open the trunk lid.
X Manually unlock the fuel filler flap using the emergency release
(Y page 146).
The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is
jammed.
X Manually unlock the fuel filler flap using the emergency release
(Y page 146).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking
Important safety notes
G Warning
Do not park this vehicle in areas where
combustible materials such as grass, hay or
leaves can come into contact with the hot
exhaust system. These materials could be
ignited and cause a vehicle fire.
Vehicle movement can cause serious
personal injury or damage to the vehicle or
the vehicle drivetrain. Therefore, always do
the following before turning off the engine and
leaving the vehicle:
RKeep
right foot on the brake pedal.
the parking brake.
REngage
RManual
transmission: Shift the manual
transmission into 1st gear or reverse gear
R.
RAutomatic transmission: Shift the
automatic transmission into park position
P.
RSlowly release the brake pedal.
RWhen parked on an incline, always turn the
front wheels towards the road curb.
RTurn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to
position 0 and remove it from the ignition
lock or press the KEYLESS-GO Start/Stop
button.
RTake the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle when leaving.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 149
Version: 3.0.3.6
Parking
G Warning
Switching off the engine
button moves to position 0. This
corresponds to removing the SmartKey.
If you attempt to turn off the engine when the
selector lever is not in position P, a warning
signal sounds.
Observe the messages in the multifunction
display.
i In an emergency, you can turn off the
engine while the vehicle is in motion by
pressing and holding the Start/Stop button
for three seconds.
Important safety notes
G Warning
Do not turn off the engine before the vehicle
has come to a complete stop. With the engine
not running, there is no power assistance for
the brake and steering systems. In this case,
it is important to keep in mind that a
considerably higher degree of effort is
necessary to brake and steer the vehicle.
If you have started the engine with the Start/
Stop button and it cannot be switched off as
described:
X
remove the Start/Stop button from the
ignition lock.
X insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock.
The engine stops. The ignition lock is in
position 0.
Vehicles with manual transmission
X
Shift to either first gear or reverse gear R.
Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the
ignition lock and remove it.
The immobilizer is activated.
X Apply the parking brake firmly.
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission
X
X
Apply the parking brake firmly.
Shift the transmission to position P.
Using the SmartKey
X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the
ignition lock and remove it.
The immobilizer is activated.
i The SmartKey can only be removed if the
transmission is in position P.
Using KEYLESS-GO
X Press the Start/Stop button (Y page 132).
When the driver's door is closed, the Start/
Stop button is in position 1. When the
driver's door is opened, the Start/Stop
Parking brake
G Warning
Engaging the parking brake while the vehicle
is in motion can cause the rear wheels to lock
up. You could lose control of the vehicle and
cause an accident. In addition, the vehicle's
brake lights do not light up when the parking
brake is engaged.
G Warning
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the
SmartKey from the starter switch, take it with
you, and lock the vehicle. Do not leave
children unattended in the vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could
release the parking brake and/or shift the
automatic transmission out of park position
P (manual transmission: shift into the neutral
position), either of which could result in an
accident and/or serious personal injury.
Z
Driving and parking
Manual transmission: Wait until the vehicle is
stationary before removing the SmartKey
from the starter switch. The vehicle cannot be
steered when the SmartKey is removed from
the starter switch.
149
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 150
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving tips
150
Driving tips
General driving tips
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
G Warning
X
To apply: depress parking brake ; firmly.
When the engine is running, the $ (USA
only) or J (Canada only) indicator lamp
lights up in the instrument cluster.
X To release: depress the brake pedal and
keep it depressed.
X Pull release handle :.
When the ignition is switched on or the
engine is running, the $ (USA only) or
J (Canada only) indicator lamp goes out
in the instrument cluster.
Parking up the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than four weeks, the battery may be damaged
by exhaustive discharge.
X Disconnect the battery or connect it to a
trickle charger.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. an authorized MercedesBenz Center.
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than six weeks, the vehicle may suffer
damage as a result of lack of use.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
18 Observe
all legal requirements.
Please do not forget that your primary
responsibility is to drive the vehicle. A driver's
attention to the road must always be his/her
primary focus when driving. For your safety
and the safety of others, we recommend that
you pull over to a safe location and stop
before placing or taking a telephone call.
If you use the telephone18 while driving,
please use the hands-free device and only use
the telephone when road, weather and traffic
conditions permit. Some jurisdictions prohibit
the driver from using a mobile telephone while
driving a vehicle.
Only operate the audio system or
COMAND18 (Cockpit Management and Data
System) if road, weather and traffic
conditions permit. Otherwise, you may not be
able to observe traffic conditions and could
endanger yourself and others.
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph
(approximately 50 km/h), your vehicle is
covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately
14 m) every second.
Drive sensibly – save fuel
To save fuel, observe the following notes:
X
Keep tires at the recommended inflation
pressures.
X Remove unnecessary cargo.
X Remove the roof rack when not in use.
X Maintain a low engine speed until the
engine is warm.
X Avoid frequent acceleration and
deceleration.
X Have all maintenance work performed at
the service intervals specified in the
Service Booklet or indicated by the service
interval indicator.
Fuel consumption is also increased by driving
in cold weather, in stop-and-go traffic, on
short trips and in mountainous areas.
Drinking and driving
G Warning
Drinking and driving and/or taking drugs and
driving are very dangerous combinations.
Even a small amount of alcohol or drugs can
affect your reflexes, perceptions and
judgment.
The possibility of a serious or even fatal
accident are greatly increased when you drink
or take drugs and drive.
Do not drink or take drugs and drive or allow
anyone to drive who has been drinking or
taking drugs.
Pedals
G Warning
Make sure absolutely no objects are
obstructing the pedals' range of movement.
Keep the driver's footwell clear of all
obstacles. If there are any floormats or
carpets in the footwell, make sure that the
pedals still have sufficient clearance.
During sudden driving or braking maneuvers,
the objects could get caught between the
pedals. You could then no longer brake or
accelerate. This could lead to accidents and
injury.
Coasting with the engine switched off
G Warning!
There is no power assistance for the steering
and the brake when the engine is not running.
Steering and braking requires significantly
more effort and you could lose control of the
vehicle and cause an accident as a result.
Do not turn off the engine while the vehicle is
in motion.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 151
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving tips
151
Inhalation of exhaust gas is hazardous to your
health. All exhaust gas contains carbon
monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can cause
unconsciousness and possible death.
Do not run the engine in confined areas (such
as a garage) which are not properly ventilated.
If you think that exhaust gas fumes are
entering the vehicle while driving, have the
cause determined and corrected
immediately. If you must drive under these
conditions, drive only with at least one
window fully open at all times.
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Exhaust check
G Warning
Certain engine systems are designed to keep
the level of poisonous components in exhaust
fumes within legal limits.
These systems only work optimally if they are
maintained exactly in accordance with the
manufacturer's specifications. For this
reason, all work on the engine must be carried
out by qualified and authorized MercedesBenz technicians.
The engine settings must not be changed in
any circumstances. Furthermore, all specific
service work must be carried out at regular
intervals and in accordance with the
Mercedes-Benz service requirements. Details
can be found in the Service Booklet.
Brakes
Important safety notes
G Warning
On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in
order to obtain braking action. This could
result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle
control. Your vehicle's ABS will not prevent
this type of loss of control.
G Warning
Make sure that you do not endanger other
road users when you apply the brakes.
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
152
Driving tips
Downhill gradients
! On long and steep gradients, you must
Driving and parking
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 152
Version: 3.0.3.6
reduce the cargo on the brakes by shifting
to a lower gear in good time. This allows
you to take advantage of engine braking
and helps you to avoid overheating the
brakes and wearing them out excessively.
When you take advantage of engine
braking, a drive wheel may not turn for
some time, e.g. on a slippery road surface.
This could cause damage to the drive train.
Such damage is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz warranty.
Heavy and light loads
G Warning
Depressing the brake pedal constantly results
in excessive and premature wear to the brake
pads.
It may also cause the brakes to overheat,
seriously impairing their effectiveness. It may
then not be possible to stop the vehicle in
sufficient time to avoid an accident.
If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy
cargo, do not stop the vehicle immediately,
but drive on for a short while. This allows the
airflow to cool the brakes more quickly.
Wet roads
G Warning
After driving in heavy rain for some time
without applying the brakes or through water
deep enough to wet brake components, the
first braking action may be somewhat
reduced. You have to depress the brake pedal
more firmly. Maintain a safe distance from
vehicles in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the
vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying
attention to the traffic conditions. This will
warm up the brake discs, thereby drying them
more quickly and protecting them against
corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salt
treated roads
G Warning
The layer of salt on the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings may cause a delay in the
braking effect, resulting in a significantly
longer braking distance, which could lead to
an accident.
To avoid this danger, you should:
Roccasionally brake carefully, without
putting other road users at risk, when you
are driving on salted roads. This helps to
remove any salt that may have started to
build up on the brake discs and the brake
pads/linings.
Rmaintain a greater distance to the vehicle
ahead and drive with particular care.
Rcarefully apply the brakes at the end of a
trip and immediately after commencing a
new trip, so that salt residues are removed
from the brake discs.
Maintenance of the brakes
! If the red brake warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster and you hear a
warning tone while the engine is running,
the brake fluid level may be too low.
Observe additional warning messages in
the multifunction display.
The brake fluid level may be too low due to
brake pad wear or leaking brake lines.
Have the brake system checked
immediately. This work should be carried
out at an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
All checks and maintenance work on the
brake system must be carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop. This work
should be carried out at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
Only install brake pads and use brake fluid
recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 153
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving tips
G Warning
If other than recommended brake pads are
installed, or other than recommended brake
fluid is used, the braking properties of the
vehicle can be degraded to an extent that safe
braking is substantially impaired. This could
result in an accident.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC: a function or
performance test may only be carried out
on a two-axle dynamometer. If you are
planning to have the vehicle tested on such
a dynamometer, contact an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center to obtain further
information first. Otherwise, the drive train
or the brake system may suffer damage.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC: as the ESP®
system operates automatically, the engine
and the ignition must be switched off
(SmartKey in position 0 or 1 in the ignition
lock or Start/Stop button in position 0 or
1) while the parking brake is being tested
on a brake dynamometer.
Braking maneuvers triggered automatically
by ESP® may seriously damage the brake
system.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC: as the ESP®
G Warning
Make sure that you do not endanger other
road users when you apply the brakes.
You can find a description of Brake Assist
(BAS) on (Y page 62).
High-performance brake system for
AMG vehicles
The high-performance brake system is only
installed on the C 63 AMG.
G Warning
New vehicle brake pads and discs, and
replacement brake pads and discs may take
several hundred miles of driving until they
provide optimum braking efficiency. Until that
time, you may need to use increased brake
pedal pressure while braking. Please be aware
of this and adjust your driving and braking
accordingly during this break-in period.
Excessive high-demand braking will cause
correspondingly high brake wear. Please be
attentive to the brake warning lamp in the
instrument cluster and brake condition
messages in the multifunction display.
Especially for high performance driving, it is
important to maintain and have the brake
system checked regularly.
system operates automatically, the engine
and the ignition system must be switched
off (SmartKey in position 0 or 1 in the
ignition lock or Start/Stop button in
position 0 or 1) when:
The high-performance brake system is
designed for heavy loads. This may lead to
noise when braking. This will depend on:
Rtesting
Rspeed
the parking brake on a brake
dynamometer.
Ryou intend to have the vehicle towed with
the front axle raised.
Braking maneuvers triggered automatically
by ESP® may seriously damage the brake
system.
If your brake system is only subjected to
moderate loads, you should regularly test
your brake system's function by forcefully
depressing the brake pedal when driving at
high speed. This will give the brake pads
better grip.
153
Rbraking
force
Renvironmental
conditions, such as
temperature and humidity
The wear of individual components of the
brake system, such as the brake pads/linings
or brake discs, depends on the individual
driving style and operating conditions.
Z
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
154
Driving tips
Driving on wet roads
Hydroplaning
Driving and parking
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 154
Version: 3.0.3.6
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of
hydroplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou
drive at low speeds
tires have adequate tread depth
For this reason, in the event of heavy rain or
in conditions in which hydroplaning can occur
you must drive in the following manner:
Rthe
RLower
your speed
ruts
RBrake carefully
RAvoid
Driving on flooded roads
! Do not drive through flooded areas.
Check the depth of any water before driving
through it. Drive slowly through standing
water. Otherwise, water may enter the
vehicle interior or the engine compartment.
This can damage the electronic
components in the engine or the automatic
transmission. Water can also be drawn in
by the engine's air suction nozzles and this
can cause engine damage.
Winter driving
General information
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center, at the onset of
winter.
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 155).
Winter tires
At temperatures below 45 ‡(+7 †), use
winter tires or all-season tires. Both types of
tire are identified by the M+S marking.
Only winter tires also bearing the i
snowflake symbol next to the M+S marking
provide the best possible grip in wintry road
conditions. Only these tires will allow driving
safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to
function optimally in winter, as these tires
have been designed specifically for driving on
snow.
Use M+S tires of the same make and tread on
all wheels to maintain safe handling
characteristics.
G Warning
M+S tires with a tread depth of less than 1/6
inch (4 mm) must be replaced. They are no
longer suitable for winter operation.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tires you have
mounted.
Once you have installed the winter tires:
X
Check the tire pressures (Y page 275).
X Restart the tire pressure monitor
(Y page 277).
G Warning
If you use your spare wheel when M+S tires
are fitted on the other wheels, be aware that
the difference in tire characteristics may very
well impair turning stability and that overall
driving stability may be reduced. Adapt your
driving style accordingly.
Have the spare wheel replaced by a regular
road wheel with an M+S tire at the nearest
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Snow chains
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you only use snow chains
which have been specially approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or are of a
corresponding standard of quality.
! There is not enough space for snow
chains on some wheel sizes. Observe the
information under "Tires and wheels" in the
"Technical Data" section to avoid damage
to the vehicle or the wheels.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 155
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving tips
ROnly
use snow chains when driving on an
area completely covered by snow. Do not
exceed the maximum permissible speed of
30 mph (50 km/h). Remove the snow
chains as soon as possible when you are no
longer driving on snow-covered roads.
RLocal regulations may restrict the use of
snow chains. Applicable regulations must
be observed if you wish to mount snow
chains.
RSnow chains must not be mounted on
emergency spare wheels.
If you intend to mount snow chains, please
bear the following points in mind:
Ryou
may not attach snow chains to all
wheel-tire combinations; see the "Tires and
wheels" section in the "Technical data"
chapter.
Rmount snow chains only in pairs and only
on the rear wheels. Observe the
manufacturer's installation instructions.
! If snow chains are mounted on the front
wheels, the snow chains could grind
against the bodywork or components of the
chassis. This could result in damage to the
vehicle or the tires.
! Vehicles with steel wheels
If you wish to mount snow chains to steel
wheels, make sure that you remove the
respective wheels' hubcaps first. The
hubcaps may otherwise be damaged.
i You may wish to deactivate
ESP®(Y page 63) when pulling away with
snow chains installed. This way you can
allow the wheels to spin in a controlled
manner, achieving an increased driving
force (cutting action).
(CO) gases may enter vehicle interior
resulting in unconsciousness and death.
To assure sufficient fresh air ventilation, open
a window slightly on the side of the vehicle
not facing the wind.
G Warning!
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device
and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Indicated temperatures just above the
freezing point do not guarantee that the road
surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy,
especially in wooded areas or on bridges.
G Warning
On slippery road surfaces, never downshift in
order to obtain braking action. This could
result in drive wheel slip and reduced vehicle
control. Your vehicle's ABS will not prevent
this type of loss of control.
You should drive particularly carefully on
slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden
acceleration, steering and braking
maneuvers. Do not use cruise control.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
X
Vehicles with manual transmission: engage
neutral.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift
the transmission to position N.
i For more information on driving with
snow chains, see (Y page 154).
G Warning
Make sure that you do not endanger other
road users when you apply the brakes.
Slippery road surfaces
G Warning
If the vehicle becomes stuck in snow, make
sure snow is kept clear of the exhaust pipe
and from around the vehicle with the engine
running. Otherwise, deadly carbon monoxide
Driving abroad
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network
is also available in other countries. The
Service Hotline's current telephone numbers
for use when you are abroad are to be found
Z
155
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
156
Driving systems
in the "Service24h" section of the Service
Booklet.
Driving and parking
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 156
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving systems
Cruise control
Important safety notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. It brakes automatically in order
to avoid exceeding the set speed. On long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden, you must shift to a lower gear
in good time or select shift range 1, 2 or 3 in
vehicles with automatic transmission. By
doing so, you will make use of the braking
effect of the engine, which relieves the load
on the brake system and prevents the brakes
from overheating and wearing too quickly.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic
conditions make it appropriate to maintain a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
store any road speed above 20 mph
(30 km/h).
G Warning
The cruise control is a convenience system
designed to assist the driver during vehicle
operation. The driver is and must always
remain responsible for the vehicle's speed
and for safe brake operation.
Only use the cruise control if the road, traffic,
and weather conditions make it advisable to
travel at a constant speed.
RThe use of the cruise control can be
dangerous on winding roads or in heavy
traffic because conditions do not allow safe
driving at a constant speed.
RThe use of the cruise control can be
dangerous on slippery roads. Rapid
changes in tire traction can result in wheel
spin and loss of control.
RDeactivate the cruise control when driving
in fog.
The "Resume" function should only be
operated if the driver is fully aware of the
previously set speed and wishes to resume
this particular preset speed.
G Warning!
The cruise control brakes automatically so
that the set speed is not exceeded.
Cruise control lever
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; To store the current speed or a lower
speed
= To deactivate cruise control
? To store the current speed or to call up
the last stored speed
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display
for five seconds. In the multifunction display,
the segments between the stored speed and
the maximum speed light up.
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
You can store the current speed if you are
driving faster than 20 mph (30 km/h).
X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever
up : or down ; to the pressure point.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the stored speed.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 157
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving systems
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by
automatically applying the brakes.
i Vehicles with manual transmission:
RAlways
drive at adequate, but not
excessive, engine speeds.
RChange gear in good time.
RIf possible, do not change down several
gears at a time.
Storing the current speed or calling up
the last stored speed
G Warning
The set speed stored in memory should only
be set again if prevailing road conditions and
legal speed limits permit. Possible
acceleration or deceleration differences
arising from returning to the preset speed
could cause an accident and/or serious injury
to you and others.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously
stored speed.
Setting a speed
G Warning
Keep in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has made the necessary
adjustments.
Increase or decrease the set vehicle speed to
a value that the prevailing road conditions and
legal speed limits permit. Otherwise, sudden
and unexpected acceleration or deceleration
of the vehicle could cause an accident and/
or serious injury to you and others.
X
Press the cruise control lever to the
pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For
example, if you accelerate briefly to
overtake, cruise control adjusts the
vehicle's speed to the last speed stored
after you have finished overtaking.
Setting in 1 mph (Canada: 1 km/h)
increments
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever to the
pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down ; for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Setting in 5 mph (Canada: 10 km/h)
increments
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever
beyond the pressure point, up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Deactivating cruise control
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever
forwards =.
or
X
Brake.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou
depress the parking brake.
are driving below 20 mph (30 km/h).
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®.
Ryou
Z
Driving and parking
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
157
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
158
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 158
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Ryou
shift into neutral in a vehicle with
manual transmission while driving, or
depress the clutch pedal for longer than 6
seconds.
Ron vehicles with manual transmission, you
shift to a gear that is too high, and as a
result the engine speed is too low.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
you shift into position N while driving.
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear
a warning tone. You will see the Cruise
control off message in the multifunction
display for approximately five seconds.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Dynamic handling package with
sports mode
General notes
The most important part of the dynamic
handling package with sports mode is the
adjustable suspension system. This
automatically controls and adapts the
suspension to the respective driving
situation.
The calibration of the suspension depends
on:
X
Start the engine.
Sports tuning
The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in
sports mode ensures even better contact
with the road. Select this mode when
employing a sporty driving style, e.g. on
winding country roads.
Your selection remains stored until you
switch off the engine.
X Press button ;.
Indicator lamp : lights up. Sports
suspension tuning is selected. Depending
on the engine output, the accelerator pedal
is more responsive. On vehicles with
automatic transmission, drive program S is
selected.
Ryour
Comfort tuning
Rthe
In comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select
this mode if you prefer a more comfortable
driving style, but also when driving fast on
straight roads, e.g. highways.
X Press button ;.
Indicator lamp : goes out. Comfortable
suspension tuning is selected. On vehicles
with automatic transmission, drive
program C is selected.
driving style
road surface conditions
Ryour individual selection; see the following
description
If your vehicle is equipped with automatic
transmission, the dynamic handling package
with sports mode also includes steering
wheel paddle shifters (Y page 141) with a
manual drive program (Y page 142).
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 159
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving systems
4MATIC (permanent four-wheel drive)
4MATIC ensures that all four wheels are
permanently driven. Together with ESP®, it
improves the traction of your vehicle
whenever a drive wheel spins due to
insufficient grip.
G Warning!
If a drive wheel is spinning due to insufficient
traction:
RWhile
driving off, apply as little throttle as
possible.
RWhile driving, ease up on the accelerator
pedal.
RAdapt your speed and driving style to the
prevailing road conditions.
Failure to observe these guidelines could
cause the vehicle to skid.
The 4MATIC cannot prevent accidents
resulting from excessive speed.
! Never tow the vehicle with one axle
raised. This may damage the transfer case.
Damage of this sort is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty. All
wheels must remain either on the ground
or be fully raised. Observe the instructions
for towing the vehicle with all wheels in full
contact with the ground.
G Warning!
Make sure no persons or animals are in or
near the area in which you are parking/
maneuvering. Otherwise, they could be
injured.
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It indicates visually and
audibly the distance between your vehicle
and an object.
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically when
you:
Rswitch
on the ignition.
the transmission to position D, R or
N on vehicles with automatic transmission.
Rrelease the parking brake.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
11 mph (18 km/h). It is reactivated at lower
speeds.
PARKTRONIC monitors the area around your
vehicle using six sensors in the front bumper
and four sensors in the rear bumper.
Rshift
i In wintry driving conditions, the maximum
effect of 4MATIC can only be achieved if
you use winter tires (M+S tires), with snow
chains if necessary.
: Sensors in the front bumper, left-hand
side (example)
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
i PARKTRONIC is only available in Canada.
G Warning!
The PARKTRONIC is a supplemental system.
It is not intended to, nor does it replace, the
need for extreme care. The responsibility
during parking and other critical maneuvers
always remains with the driver.
159
Range of the sensors
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and
slush; otherwise they may not function
correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 247).
Z
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
160
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 160
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Minimum distance
Center
Approx. 8 in (20 cm)
Corners
Approx. 6 in (15 cm)
If there is an obstacle within this range, all
warning displays light up and a warning tone
sounds. If the distance falls below the
minimum, the distance may no longer be
shown.
Side view
Warning displays
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located
on the dashboard above the center air vents.
The warning display for the rear area is
located on the headliner in the rear
compartment.
Top view
Front sensors
Center
Approx. 40 in (100 cm)
Corners
Approx. 24 in (60 cm)
Rear sensors
Center
Approx. 48 in (120 cm)
Corners
Approx. 32 in (80 cm)
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer drawbars.
PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects
when they are in the immediate vicinity of
the vehicle. You could damage the vehicle
or the objects.
Ultrasonic sources such as an automatic
car wash, a truck's compressed-air brakes
or a pneumatic drill could cause
PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
Warning display for the front area
: Segments on the left-hand side of the
vehicle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the
vehicle
= Segments showing operational readiness
The warning display for each side of the
vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red
segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if
yellow segments showing operational
readiness = light up.
The gear lever position or the transmission
position of the automatic transmission
determines which warning display is active
when the engine is running.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 161
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving systems
161
Gear lever
position
Warning display
Forwards gear
or
Neutral
Front area activated
Reverse gear
Rear and front areas
activated
Automatic transmission:
: To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC
Transmission
position
Warning display
; Indicator lamp
D
Front area activated
If indicator lamp ; lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated.
R or N
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
when you turn the SmartKey to position 2
in the ignition lock.
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
From the:
Rsixth
segment onwards, you will hear an
intermittent warning tone for
approximately two seconds.
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately two
seconds. This indicates that you have now
reached the minimum distance.
Z
Driving and parking
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
Manual transmission:
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
162
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 162
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving systems
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has switched off.
in the PARKTRONIC
X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified
warning displays are lit.
specialist workshop.
You also hear a warning
tone for approximately
two seconds.
PARKTRONIC is
deactivated after
approximately
20 seconds, and the
indicator lamp in the
PARKTRONIC button
lights up.
Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
in the PARKTRONIC
X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 247).
warning displays are lit. X
Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is
deactivated after
The problem may be caused by an external source of radio or
approximately 20
ultrasound waves.
seconds.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Rear view camera
Important safety notes
The rear view camera is an optical parking aid.
It shows the area behind your vehicle in the
COMAND display.
G Warning!
Make sure no persons or animals are in or
near the area in which you are parking/
maneuvering. Otherwise, they could be
injured.
The rear view camera is located in the handle
strip of the trunk lid.
: Rear view camera
View through the camera
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 163
Version: 3.0.3.6
Driving systems
G Warning!
The rear view camera is only an aid and may
display obstacles
Rfrom
a distorted perspective
Rinaccurately
Rmay
not display obstacles at all
The rear view camera does not relieve you of
the responsibility to be cautious. Take care
and pay careful attention. The rear view
camera may not show objects which are
Rvery
close to the rear bumper
the rear bumper
Rabove the trunk handle
You are responsible for safety at all times and
must continue to pay attention to the
immediate surroundings when parking and
maneuvering. This includes the area behind,
in front of, and beside the vehicle. Otherwise
you could endanger yourself and/or others.
Runder
Do not use the rear view camera in these
situations. Otherwise you could injure
yourself or others and/or damage property
including your vehicle while parking/
maneuvering.
Activating the rear view camera
X
Make sure that the SmartKey is in
position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the "rear view camera"
function is selected in COMAND (see the
separate operating instructions for
COMAND).
X Engage reverse gear.
The area behind the vehicle is shown in the
COMAND display.
G Warning!
The rear view camera either will not function
or will not function to its full capability if
Rthe trunk lid is open
Rit is raining very hard, snowing or foggy
Rit is night or you are parking/maneuvering
your vehicle in an area where it is very dark
Rthe camera is exposed to a very bright white
light
Rthe immediate surroundings are
illuminated with fluorescent light (the
COMAND system display can flicker)
Rthere is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. if you drive into a heated garage from
the cold (lens condensation)
Rthe camera lens is dirty or covered
Rthe rear of your vehicle is damaged
In this case, have the position and setting
of the camera checked by a qualified
specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you contact a MercedesBenz Center for this purpose.
Z
163
Driving and parking
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
164
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 164
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 165
Version: 3.0.3.6
165
Vehicle equipment ............................
Important safety notes ....................
Displays and operation ....................
Menus and submenus ......................
Display messages .............................
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster ............................
166
166
166
169
183
203
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
166
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 166
Version: 3.0.3.6
Displays and operation
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
Important safety notes
You will find an illustration of the instrument
cluster in the "At a glance" section
(Y page 26).
G Warning
A driver's attention to the road and traffic
conditions must always be his/her primary
focus when driving.
For your safety and the safety of others,
selecting features through the multifunction
steering wheel should only be done by the
driver when traffic and road conditions permit
it to be done safely.
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph
(approximately 50 km/h ), your vehicle is
covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately
14 m) every second.
G Warning!
No messages will be displayed if either the
instrument cluster or the multifunction
display is inoperative.
As a result, you will not be able to see
information about your driving conditions,
such as
Rspeed
Routside temperature
Rwarning/indicator lamps
Rmalfunction/warning messages
Rfailure of any systems
Driving characteristics may be impaired.
If you must continue to drive, do so with added
caution. Contact an authorized MercedesBenz Center as soon as possible.
G Warning
Malfunction and warning messages are only
indicated for certain systems and are
intentionally not very detailed. The
malfunction and warning messages are
simply a reminder with respect to the
operation of certain systems. They do not
replace the owner's and/or driver's
responsibility to maintain the vehicle's
operating safety. Have all required
maintenance and safety checks performed on
the vehicle. Bring the vehicle to an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center to address the
malfunction and warning messages.
Displays and operation
Coolant temperature gauge
G Warning
Driving when your engine is overheated can
cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire. You
could be seriously burned.
Steam from an overheated engine can cause
serious burns which can occur just by opening
the engine hood. Stay away from the engine
if you see or hear steam coming from it.
Stop the vehicle in a safe location away from
other traffic. Turn off the engine, get out of the
vehicle and do not stand near the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
The coolant temperature gauge is in the
instrument cluster on the right-hand side.
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant
temperature may rise to 248 ‡ (120 †).
! If the coolant temperature is too high a
display message is shown.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 167
Version: 3.0.3.6
Displays and operation
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
On-board computer and displays
If the coolant temperature rises above
248 ‡(120 †), do not drive any further as
this could damage the engine.
Tachometer
The red band in the tachometer indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
! Do not drive in the overrevving range, as
this could damage the engine.
The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the
engine when the red band is reached.
Outside temperature display
The outside temperature display is in the
multifunction display.
G Warning!
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device
and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Indicated temperatures just above the
freezing point do not guarantee that the road
surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy,
especially in wooded areas or on bridges.
:
Multifunction display
;
~6
Makes/accepts or rejects/ends a
call
WX
Adjusts the volume or operates the
RACETIMER in AMG vehicles
8
Mute
=
?
Activates voice control; see the
separate operating instructions
?
%Press briefly:
Back
Deactivates voice control
Hides display messages
Changes in the outside temperature are
displayed after a short delay.
Speedometer with segments
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
Cruise control mode:
The segments light up from the stored speed
to the maximum speed.
Operating the on-board computer
The on-board computer is activated as soon
as you turn the SmartKey to position 1 in the
ignition lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
%Press and hold:
Selects the standard display
A
167
=;
Calls up the menu and menu bar
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
168
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 168
Version: 3.0.3.6
Displays and operation
9:Press briefly:
Selects the submenu or scrolls
through lists
In the Audio menu: selects a stored
station, an audio track or a video
scene
In the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone number
9:Press and hold:
In the Audio menu: selects the
previous/next station or selects an
audio track or a video scene using
rapid scrolling
In the Tel (telephone) menu: starts
rapid scrolling through the phone
book
a
Confirms selections and hides
display messages
In the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
starts dialing
Multifunction display
To activate the multifunction display:
Rswitch
on the ignition.
on the lights.
Ropen the driver's door.
Values and settings as well as display
messages are shown in the multifunction
display.
Rswitch
: Description field
; Menu bar
X
To show menu bar ;: press the =
or ; button on the steering wheel.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 169
Version: 3.0.3.6
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menu overview
The number of menus shown depends on the optional equipment in the vehicle.
Function
:
Trip menu (Y page 170)
;
AMG menu in AMG vehicles (Y page 171)
=
Navi menu (navigation details) (Y page 174)
?
Audio menu (Y page 175)
A
Tel menu (telephone) (Y page 176)
B
DriveAssist menu (assistance) (Y page 178)
C
Serv. menu (Y page 178)
Rcall up display messages (Y page 183)
Rtire pressure loss warning system (Canada only) (Y page 275)
Rtire pressure monitor (USA only) (Y page 277)
RASSYST PLUS service interval display (Y page 243)
D
Settings menu (Y page 178)
169
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Menus and submenus
170
On-board computer and displays
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 170
Version: 3.0.3.6
The Audio and Tel menus differ slightly in vehicles with an audio system and vehicles with
COMAND. The examples given in this Operator's Manual apply to vehicles equipped with
COMAND.
Trip menu
Standard display
X
Press and hold the % button on the
steering wheel until the Trip menu with
odometer : and trip odometer ; is
shown.
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
The values in the From Start submenu are
calculated from the start of a journey whilst
the values in the From Reset submenu are
calculated from the last time the submenu
was reset.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Trip menu.
X Press 9 or : to select From Start
or From Reset.
The From Start trip computer is reset
automatically when
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than 4 hours.
R999 hours have been exceeded.
R9999 miles have been exceeded.
The From Reset trip computer is
automatically reset if the trip exceeds
9999 hours or 99,999 miles.
You can select km or miles as the unit of
measurement for distance (Y page 178).
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
X
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
current fuel consumption and approximate
range.
: Current fuel consumption19
; Approximate range
Trip computer "After start" (example)
: Distance
; Time
= Average speed
? Average fuel consumption
19 Not
in AMG vehicles.
Approximate range ; is calculated
according to current driving style and the
amount of fuel in the tank. If there is only a
small amount of fuel left in the fuel tank, the
display shows a vehicle being refueled C
instead of range ;.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 171
Version: 3.0.3.6
Menus and submenus
Digital speedometer
X
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Trip menu.
X Press 9 or : to select the digital
speedometer.
AMG menu in AMG vehicles
AMG displays
X
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
: Shift recommendation
; Digital speedometer
i If the gearshift recommendation is shown
in the multifunction display, it is not shown
in the status bar.
Further information on gearshift
recommendations (Y page 138).
Resetting values
You can reset the values of the following
functions:
RTrip
odometer
computer "From start"
RTrip computer "From reset"
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Trip menu.
X Press 9 or : to select the function
that you wish to reset.
X Press a.
RTrip
Resetting the trip computer "From start" (example)
X
: Digital speedometer
; Gear indicator
= Upshift instruction
? Engine oil temperature
A Coolant temperature
Shift UP instruction = indicates that the
engine has reached the overrevving range
when in the manual gearshift program. Shift
up instruction = overrides other messages
in the multifunction display until you have
shifted up.
When the engine temperature is below
80 †, the oil temperature gauge flashes.
Avoid driving at full engine output during this
time.
SETUP
SETUP shows the drive program, the ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program) mode and the
SPORT handling mode.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until
SETUP is displayed.
Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
Z
171
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Menus and submenus
172
On-board computer and displays
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 172
Version: 3.0.3.6
: Drive program (S/C/M)
: RACETIMER
; ESP® mode (ON/OFF) or SPORT handling
; Lap
mode (SPORT)
RACETIMER
You can start the RACETIMER when the
engine is running or if the SmartKey is in
position 2 in the ignition lock.
Displaying and starting RACETIMER
X
G Warning
The RACETIMER feature is only for use on
roads and in conditions where high speed
driving is permitted. Racing on public roads is
prohibited under all circumstances. The driver
is and must always remain responsible for
following posted speed limits.
You can use the RACETIMER to store lap
times.
When RACETIMER is displayed, you cannot
adjust the volume using the W and X
buttons on the steering wheel.
X
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
RACETIMER is shown.
To start: press the W button to start the
RACETIMER.
X To display the intermediate time: press
X to show the intermediate time.
The intermediate time is displayed for five
seconds.
X To stop: press the W button to stop the
RACETIMER.
The RACETIMER interrupts timing when you
stop the vehicle and turn the SmartKey to
position 1 in the ignition lock. When you turn
the SmartKey to position 2 or 3 and then
press the W button, timing is continued.
Storing the lap time and starting a new lap
It is possible to store a maximum of sixteen
laps.
X Press the X button on the steering
wheel to show the intermediate time during
timing.
The intermediate time is displayed for five
seconds.
X Press the X button again within five
seconds.
The displayed intermediate time is stored
as a lap time.
Timing starts for a new lap. The new lap is
timed from when the intermediate time is
called up.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 173
Version: 3.0.3.6
Menus and submenus
Overall evaluation
This function is shown if you have stored at
least one lap and stopped the RACETIMER.
X
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
overall evaluation is shown.
: RACETIMER
; Fastest lap time (best lap)
= Lap
Resetting the current lap
X Press the W button on the steering
wheel to stop the RACETIMER.
X Press X to reset the lap time to "0”.
Deleting all laps
You cannot delete individual stored laps.
X Press the W button on the steering
wheel to stop the RACETIMER.
X Press a.
Reset Race Timer? appears in the
multifunction display.
: RACETIMER overall evaluation
; Total time driven
= Average speed
? Distance covered
A Top speed
Lap evaluation
This function is only available if you have
stored at least two laps and have stopped the
RACETIMER.
X
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
lap evaluation is shown.
Each lap is shown in a separate submenu.
The fastest lap is indicated by flashing
symbol :.
X
Press the : button to select YES and
press the a button to confirm.
All laps are deleted.
Z
173
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Menus and submenus
174
On-board computer and displays
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 174
Version: 3.0.3.6
Route guidance active
No change of direction announced
: Lap
; Lap time
= Average lap speed
? Lap length
A Top speed during lap
X
Press 9 or : to select a different lap
evaluation.
: Distance to destination
; Distance to next change of direction
= Current road
? Symbol for "follow the road's course"
Change of direction announced without a
lane recommendation
Navigation menu
Displaying navigation instructions
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows navigation instructions. For more
information, see the separate operating
instructions.
X Switch on COMAND (see the separate
operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Navi menu.
Route guidance inactive
: Road into which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Symbol for change of direction
When a change of direction has been
announced, you will see visual distance
display ; next to symbol = for the change
of direction. This decreases in size as you
approach the announced change of direction.
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
Lane recommendations are only displayed if
the relevant data is available on the digital
map.
: Direction of travel
; Current road
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 175
Version: 3.0.3.6
Menus and submenus
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
i SIRIUS XM satellite radio acts like a
normal radio.
For more information on satellite radio
operation, see the separate operating
instructions.
: Road into which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Lane recommendation
? Symbol for change of direction
On multi-lane roads, lane recommendation
= may be shown for the next change of
direction. Lanes may be added during a
change of direction.
You can only change the waveband and store
new stations using the audio system or
COMAND.
X Switch on the audio system or COMAND
and select Radio (see the separate
operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
Lane recommendation display (example)
: Uninterrupted lane
: Waveband20
; Station
; New lane during a change of direction
X
= Lane recommended for the change of
direction
Other status indicators of the
navigation system
you have reached the destination.
Route... or Calculating Route: a
new route is being calculated.
ROff Map or Off Mapped Road: the vehicle
position is outside the area of the digital
map (off-map position).
RNo Route: no route could be calculated to
the selected destination.
RO:
RNew
To select a stored channel: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a channel from the channel
list: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
X To select a station using the station
search21: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
Audio player or audio media operation
Audio data from various audio devices or
media can be played, depending on the
equipment installed in the vehicle.
20 When
21 Only
station ; has been stored, the memory position will also be displayed.
if no station list is received.
Z
175
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Menus and submenus
176
On-board computer and displays
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 176
Version: 3.0.3.6
X
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
and select the audio drive or medium (see
the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
9 or : button until the desired
scene has been reached.
Telephone menu
Introduction
You can establish a Bluetooth® wireless
connection to the audio system or to
COMAND (see the separate operating
instructions).
CD player display (example)
: Current track
X
To select the next/previous track:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the
9 or : button until the desired track
has been reached.
If track information is stored on the audio
player or medium, the multifunction display
will show the number and name of the track.
The current track does not appear in audio
AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external
audio source connected).
Video DVD operation
X
Switch on COMAND and select video DVD
(see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
G Warning
A driver's attention to the road must always
be his/her primary focus when driving. For
your safety and the safety of others, we
recommend that you pull over to a safe
location and stop before placing or taking a
telephone call. If you choose to use the
telephone while driving, please use the handsfree device and only use the telephone when
weather, road and traffic conditions permit.
Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from
using a mobile phone while driving a vehicle.
Bear in mind that at a speed of just 30 mph
(approximately 50 km/h ), your vehicle is
covering a distance of 44 feet (approximately
14 m) every second.
X
Switch on the mobile phone and audio
system or COMAND (see the separate
operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
You will see one of the following display
messages in the multifunction display:
RTelephone Ready or the name of the
network provider: the mobile phone has
found a network and is ready to receive.
RNo Service: No network is available.
: Current scene
X
To select the next or previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or the : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the
Accepting a call
If someone calls you when you are in the
Tel menu, a display message appears in the
multifunction display, for example:
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 177
Version: 3.0.3.6
Menus and submenus
X
If only one telephone number is stored
for a name: press the 6 or a button
to start dialing.
or
X
X
Press 6 on the steering wheel to accept
an incoming call.
You can accept a call even if you are not in
the Tel menu.
Rejecting or ending a call
X
Press the ~ button on the steering
wheel.
You can end or reject a call even if you are not
in the Tel menu.
Dialing a number from the phone book
If your mobile phone is able to receive calls,
you can search for and dial a number from the
phone book in the audio system or COMAND
at any time.
X Copy the telephone book of the mobile
phone into the audio system or to COMAND
(see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to call
up the phone book.
X Press 9 or : to select the name you
are searching for.
To start scrolling rapidly, press and hold the
9 or : button for longer than one
second. After a short time, the rapid scroll
speeds up.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start
dialing.
or
X If you do not want to make a call: press
the ~ button.
Redialing
The on-board computer saves the last names
or numbers dialed in the redial memory.
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X Press the 6 or a button to start
dialing.
Assistance menu
Deactivating/activating ESP®
G Warning!
Never switch off the ESP when you see the
ESP warning lamp ä flashing in the
instrument cluster. In this case proceed as
follows:
RWhen
driving off, apply as little throttle as
possible.
RWhile driving, ease up on the accelerator
pedal.
RAdapt your speed and driving style to the
prevailing road conditions.
Z
177
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Menus and submenus
178
On-board computer and displays
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 178
Version: 3.0.3.6
Failure to observe these guidelines could
cause the vehicle to skid. The ESP cannot
prevent accidents resulting from excessive
speed.
Further information about ESP®(Y page 63).
This function is not available in AMG vehicles.
X Start the engine.
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the DriveAssist
menu.
X Press 9 or : to select ESP.
X Press a.
X To deactivate: press a again.
The å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster comes on.
In the Service menu you can:
Rcall up display messages (Y page 183)
Rrestart the tire pressure loss warning
system (Canada only) (Y page 275)
Rcheck the tire pressure electronically (USA
only) (Y page 277)
Rcall up the service due date (Y page 243)
Settings menu
Introduction
G Warning
When the å ESP OFF warning lamp lights
up, ESP is switched off.
When the ä ESP warning lamp and the
å ESP OFF warning lamp are on
continuously, ESP is not operational due to a
malfunction.
When ESP is switched off or not operational,
the vehicle's stability during standard driving
maneuvers is reduced.
Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing
road conditions/weather conditions and to
the non-operating status of ESP.
X
To activate: press a again.
The å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Maintenance menu
In the Settings menu, you have the following
options:
RChanging the instrument cluster settings
RChanging the time/date settings22
RChanging the lighting settings
RChanging the vehicle settings
RChanging the convenience settings
RRestoring the factory settings
Instrument cluster
Selecting the unit of measurement for
distance
The Display Unit Speed-/Odometer:
function allows you to choose whether
certain displays appear in km/h or mph in the
multifunction display.
The selected unit of measurement for
distance applies to:
digital speedometer in the Trip menu
odometer and the trip odometer
Rthe trip computer
Rthe navigation instructions in the Navi
menu
Rthe
Rthe
22 This
function is not available in vehicles with COMAND.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 179
Version: 3.0.3.6
Menus and submenus
X
Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instr. Cluster submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display Unit Speed-/Odometer.
function.
You will see the selected setting: km or
miles.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Switching the additional speedometer
on/off
Only vehicles with manual transmission have
this function.
The Additional Speedometer: function
allows you to choose whether the
multifunction display also shows the speed in
km/h (USA) or mph (Canada).
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instr. Cluster submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Additional Speedometer function.
You will see the selected setting: On or
Off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Selecting the permanent display function
Only vehicles with automatic transmission
have this function.
The Permanent Display: function allows
you to choose whether the multifunction
display always shows the outside
temperature or the speed in km/h (USA) or
mph (Canada).
X
Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instr. Cluster submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the
Permanent Display: function.
You will see the selected setting Outside
Temperature or Speedometer [km/h]:.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Time/date
This submenu is only available on vehicles
with Audio 20. To set the time and date on
vehicles with COMAND, see the separate
operating instructions.
In the Time/date submenu, you can set the
time and date.
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Time/date submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
Time: or Date:.
The current time or date set is displayed.
X Press a to change the setting.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
display you want to change: hour, minute,
day, month, year.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
selected display.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
Lights
Switching the daytime running lamps on/
off
This function is not available in Canada.
If you have activated the Daytime Running
Lights: function and the light switch is in the
Z
179
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
180
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 180
Version: 3.0.3.6
Menus and submenus
c position the daytime running lamps are
switched on automatically when the engine is
running.
In the dark, the following also light up:
Rthe
low-beam headlamps
parking lamps
Rthe tail lamps
Rthe license plate lamp
Rthe side marker lamps
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Daytime Running Lights: function.
You will see the selected setting: Enabled
or Disabled.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Rthe
Activating/deactivating surround
lighting and exterior lighting delayed
switch-off
If you switch on the Locator Lighting:
function and the light switch is set to c,
Rthe exterior lighting switches on when it is
dark after unlocking the vehicle with the
SmartKey.
The exterior lighting switches off when you
open the driver’s door.
Rthe exterior lighting remains on for 15
seconds when it is dark after closing the
doors.
If the engine is switched off and then none
of the doors are opened, or if an open door
is not closed, the exterior lighting goes out
after 60 seconds.
If you activate the Locator Lighting:
function, the following light up:
23 Only
24 Only
for vehicles with front fog lamps.
for vehicles without front fog lamps.
Rthe
parking lamps
tail lamps
Rthe fog lamps23
Rthe low-beam headlamps24
Rthe license plate lamp
Rthe side marker lamps
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Locator Lighting: function.
You will see the selected setting: Enabled
or Disabled.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Rthe
To deactivate the delayed shut-off
temporarily:
X
Before leaving the vehicle, turn the
SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock and back to position 0.
The delayed shut-off is deactivated.
The delayed shut-off is reactivated the next
time you start the engine.
Activating/deactivating the interior
lighting delayed switch-off
If the Interior Lighting Delay: function
is activated and you pull the SmartKey out of
the ignition lock, the interior lighting remains
on for around 10 seconds.
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 181
Version: 3.0.3.6
Menus and submenus
X
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Interior Lighting Delay: function.
You will see the selected setting: Enabled
or Disabled.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Vehicle
Convenience
Activating/deactivating the automatic
locking feature
If you select the Automatic Door Lock:
function, the vehicle is centrally locked above
a speed of around 9 mph (15 km/h).
Activating/deactivating the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature
You can use the Easy Entry/Exit: function
to activate or deactivate the easy-entry/exit
feature (Y page 99).
i Further information on the automatic
locking feature (Y page 78).
X
Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Automatic Door Lock: function.
You will see the selected setting: Enabled
or Disabled.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking confirmation
If you switch on the Acoustic Lock
Feedback: function, an acoustic signal
sounds when you lock or unlock the vehicle.
When unlocking, the signal sounds once.
When locking, it sounds three times.
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Acoustic Lock Feedback: function.
You will see the selected setting: Enabled
or Disabled.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
G Warning!
You must make sure no one can become
trapped or injured by the moving steering
wheel when the easy-entry/exit feature is
activated.
To stop steering wheel movement, move
steering wheel adjustment lever or press one
of the memory position buttons.
Do not leave children unattended in the
vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle.
Children could open the driver's door and
unintentionally activate the easy-entry/exit
feature, which could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury.
X
Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Easy Entry/Exit: feature.
You will see the selected setting: Enabled
or Disabled.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Switching the fold in mirrors when
locking function on/off
This function is only available in Canada.
If you switch on the Fold Mirrors In when
Locking: function, the exterior mirrors fold
Z
181
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
182
Menus and submenus
in when you lock the vehicle. When you
unlock the vehicle and then open the driver's
or front-passenger door, the exterior mirrors
fold out again.
If you have switched the function on and you
fold the exterior mirrors in using the button
on the door (Y page 100), they will not fold
out automatically. The exterior mirrors can
then only be folded out using the button on
the door.
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Fold Mirrors in when Locking:
function.
You will see the selected setting: Enabled
or Disabled.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Resetting to factory settings
For safety reasons, the Daytime Running
Lights: function in the Light submenu is
only reset if the vehicle is stationary.
X Press the = or ; button on the
steering wheel to select the Settings
menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory Setting submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
The Reset All Settings? message
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
No or Yes.
X Press the a button to confirm the
selection.
If you have selected Yes, the multifunction
display shows a confirmation message.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 182
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 183
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
Display messages
Hiding display messages
G Warning
All categories of messages contain important information which should be taken note of and,
where a malfunction is indicated, addressed as soon as possible at an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
Failure to repair the condition noted may cause damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz
Limited Warranty, or result in property damage or personal injury.
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
X Press the a or % button on the steering wheel to hide the display message.
The display message is cleared.
The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red.
You cannot hide display messages of the highest priority. The multifunction display shows
these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in
this Operator's Manual.
Message memory
You can read the display messages in the message memory.
X
Press = or ; on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 messages, for example.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages.
X Confirm with a.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been
rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted.
Z
183
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
184
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 184
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
Safety systems
Display messages
÷
Inoperative See
Operator's Manual
÷
ESC Currently
Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist) and hill
start assist are not available due to a malfunction. In addition, the
ä and å warning lamps light up in the instrument cluster.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are temporarily unavailable. In
addition, the ä and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
The self-diagnosis function might not be complete, for example.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
X Carefully drive a suitable distance making slight steering
movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h).
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are temporarily unavailable. In
addition, the ä and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
The on-board voltage may be insufficient, for example.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
X Drive on carefully.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 185
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
If the display message is shown and the ä warning lamp flashes
at the same time, ETS (Electronic Traction System) is deactivated.
The brakes on the drive wheels could otherwise overheat.
X Let the brakes cool down until the display message disappears
and the ä warning lamp goes out.
ETS is active again.
G
Tele Aid
Inoperative
Check Child Seat
Pos.
See Operator's
Manual
USA only: one or more main functions in the mbrace system are
malfunctioning.
Canada only: one or more of the main functions of the TELEAID
system is malfunctioning.
X USA only: have the mbrace system checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
X Canada only: have the TELEAID system checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
Vehicles with BabySmart™ (Canada only):
The BabySmart™ child seat is positioned incorrectly.
X Install the child seat in the correct position.
G Risk of injury
Vehicles with BabySmart™ (Canada only):
The sensor for automatic child seat recognition is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
6
SRS Malfunction
Service Required
6
Front Left SRS
Malfunction
Service Required
or
Front Right SRS
Malfunction
Service Required
G Risk of injury
There is a malfunction in the SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System). The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument
cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
SRS has malfunctioned at the front on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
185
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
186
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Display messages
6
Rear Left SRS
Malfunction
Service Required
or
Rear Right SRS
Malfunction
Service Required
6
Rear Center SRS
Malfunction
Service Required
6
Left Side Curtain
Airbag Malfunction
Service Required
or
Right Side Curtain
Airbag Malfunction
Service Required
G Warning
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 186
Version: 3.0.3.6
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of injury
SRS has malfunctioned at the rear on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
SRS has malfunctioned at the rear center. The 6 warning lamp
also lights up in the instrument cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
There is a malfunction in the left-hand and/or right-hand window
curtain air bag. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the
instrument cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
In the event a malfunction of the SRS is indicated as outlined above, the SRS may not be
operational.
For your safety, we strongly recommend that you contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
immediately to have the system checked. Otherwise the SRS may not be activated when needed
in an accident, which could result in serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy unexpectedly and
unnecessarily which could also result in injury.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 187
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Front Passenger
Airbag Enabled
See Operator's
Manual
The front-passenger air bag is enabled during the journey,
although:
Rthere is a child, a small adult or an object weighing less than the
system's weight threshold on the front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is unoccupied.
The system may detect the additional weight of objects on the
seat or forces acting on the seat.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Engage the parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition.
X Open the front-passenger door.
X Remove the child and the child restraint system from the frontpassenger seat.
X If necessary, secure the child in a child restraint system on a
suitable rear seat.
X Make sure that there are no objects adding to the weight applied
to the seat. The system may otherwise detect the additional
weight and interpret the seat occupant's weight as greater than
it actually is.
X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied and has no objects placed
on it, close the front-passenger door, and switch on the ignition.
Observe the 45(Y page 41) indicator lamps and the
multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
Rthe 45 indicator lamp must light up and remain lit. When
the indicator lamp is on, OCS (Y page 41) has deactivated the
front-passenger air bag.
RThe Front Passenger Airbag Enabled See Operator's
Manual or Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See
Operator's Manual display messages must not appear. Wait
for at least 60 seconds until the necessary system checks have
been completed and to make sure that the display messages do
not appear in the multifunction display.
If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be
occupied again. Whether the 45 indicator lamp remains lit
or goes out depends on how OCS classifies the occupant.
If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
187
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
188
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 188
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
G Warning
If the 45 indicator lamp remains off even after performing the above corrective steps, do
not have any children 12 years old and under and other small individuals use the front-passenger
seat until the system has been repaired.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Front Passenger
Airbag Disabled
See Operator's
Manual
The front-passenger air bag is deactivated during the journey even
though an adult or a person larger than a certain size is occupying
the front-passenger seat. If additional forces are applied to the
seat, the system may interpret the occupant's weight as lower
than it actually is.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Engage the parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition.
X Have the occupant get out of the vehicle.
X Make sure that the seat is unoccupied and has no objects placed
on it, close the front-passenger door, and switch on the ignition.
Observe the 45(Y page 41) indicator lamps and the
multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
Rthe 45 indicator lamp must light up and remain lit. When
the indicator lamp is on, OCS (Y page 41) has deactivated the
front-passenger air bag.
RThe Front Passenger Airbag Enabled See Operator's
Manual or Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See
Operator's Manual display messages must not appear. Wait
for at least 60 seconds until the necessary system checks have
been completed and to make sure that the display messages do
not appear in the multifunction display.
If these conditions are met, the front-passenger seat can be
occupied again. Whether the 45 indicator lamp remains lit
or goes out depends on how OCS classifies the occupant.
If the conditions are not met, the system is not operating correctly.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
G Warning
If the 45 indicator lamp remains lit with an adult occupant on the front-passenger seat
even after performing the above corrective steps, do not have any passenger use the frontpassenger seat until the system has been repaired.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 189
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
Brakes
Display messages
$(USA only)
J(Canada only)
ABS and ESC
Currently
Unavailable See
Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP® (Electronic Stability
Program), BAS (Brake Assist) and hill start assist are temporarily
unavailable. The self-diagnosis might not be finished, for example.
In addition, the ä, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Carefully drive a suitable distance making slight steering
movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h).
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ABS, ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are temporarily unavailable.
The on-board voltage may be insufficient, for example. In addition,
the ä, å and ! warning lamps light up in the instrument
cluster.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Drive on carefully.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
189
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
190
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Display messages
$(USA only)
J(Canada only)
ABS and ESC
Inoperative See
Operator's Manual
$(USA only)
J(Canada only)
EBD, ABS, and ESC
Inoperative See
Operator's Manual
#
Check Brake Pad
Wear
$(USA only)
J(Canada only)
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 190
Version: 3.0.3.6
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ABS, ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are unavailable due to a
malfunction. In addition, the ä, å and ! warning lamps
light up in the instrument cluster.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS and hill
start assist are unavailable due to a malfunction. In addition, the
ä, å and ! warning lamps in the instrument cluster light
up and a warning tone sounds.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
You are driving with the parking brake engaged. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Release the parking brake.
Release Park. Brake
$(USA only)
J(Canada only)
Check Brake Fluid
Level
G Risk of accident
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
Additionally, the red $ (USA only)/ J (Canada only)
warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster and a warning
tone sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Engage the parking brake.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not add brake fluid. This will not rectify the malfunction.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 191
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
G Warning
Driving with the message Check Brake Fluid Level displayed can result in an accident. Have
your brake system checked immediately.
Do not add brake fluid before checking the brake system. Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can
result in spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts and the brake fluid catching fire. You can be
seriously burned.
Lights
i Display messages about LEDs:
This display message will only appear if all LEDs have failed.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Check Left
Cornering Light
or
Check Right
Cornering Light
The left or right-hand low-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
Check Left Low Beam
(Y page 111).
or
or
Check Right Low
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Beam
b
b
Check Rear Left
Turn Signal
or
Check Rear Right
Turn Signal
b
Check Front Left
Turn Signal
or
Check Front Right
Turn Signal
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
191
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 192
Version: 3.0.3.6
192
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The turn signal in the left-hand and/or right-hand exterior mirror
is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Check Left Mirror
Turn Signal
or
Check Right Mirror
Turn Signal
b
Check Center Brake
Lamp
b
Check Left Brake
Lamp
or
Check Right Brake
Lamp
b
Check Left Tail
and Brake Lamps
or
Check Right Tail
and Brake Lamps
b
Check Left Tail
Lamp
or
Check Right Tail
Lamp
b
Check Left High
Beam
or
Check Right High
Beam
The high-mounted brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right brake/tail lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand tail lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand high beam is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 193
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand license plate lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Check Left License
Plate Lamp
or
Check Right
License Plate Lamp
The left-hand or right-hand front fog lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
Check Left Fog Lamp
(Y page 111).
or
or
Check Front Fog
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Lamp
b
b
Check Rear Left
Fog Lamp
or
Check Rear Right
Fog Lamp
b
Check Front Left
Parking Lamp
or
Check Front Right
Parking Lamp
b
Check Left Reverse
Lamp
or
Check Right
Reverse Lamp
b
Check Front Left
Sidemarker Lamp
or
Check Front Right
Sidemarker Lamp
The left-hand or right-hand rear fog lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The front left or front right standing lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand backup lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The front left or right side marker lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
193
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 194
Version: 3.0.3.6
194
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The rear left or right side marker lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Check Rear
Sidemarker
or
Check Rear
Sidemarker
Left
Lamp
Right
Lamp
b
Check Left Daytime
Running Light
or
Check Right
Daytime Running
Light
b
Active Headlamps
Inoperative
b
Malfunction See
Operator's Manual
b
Auto Lamp Function
Inoperative
b
Switch Off Lights
The left or right-hand daytime running light is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 111).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The active light function is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The exterior lighting is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The light sensor is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to c.
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The coolant level is too low.
X Add coolant, observing the warning notes when doing so
(Y page 240).
X If coolant needs adding more often than usual, have the engine
coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Check Coolant
Level See
Operator's Manual
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 195
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
G Warning
Do not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts. Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which may burn
if it comes into contact with hot engine parts. You could be seriously burned.
! The coolant level is too low. Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the cooling
system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.
The display messages and the corresponding symbol that indicate that the coolant level is
too low must not be ignored.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The coolant is too hot.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Make sure that the air supply to the radiator is not blocked, e.g.
by snow, slush or ice.
X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the
engine. There is otherwise a risk of engine damage.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
Coolant Level Low
Stop Vehicle Turn
Engine Off
The poly-V-belt may have torn.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Open the hood.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the
engine. There is otherwise a risk of engine damage.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Warning
Driving when your engine is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the
engine compartment to catch fire. You could be seriously burned.
Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns which can occur just by opening the
engine hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it.
Stop the vehicle in a safe location away from other traffic. Turn off the engine, get out of the
vehicle and do not stand near the vehicle until the engine has cooled down.
Z
195
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
196
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 196
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
! If the coolant temperature exceeds 248 ‡(120 †) do not continue driving. The engine will
otherwise be damaged.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The engine fan is faulty.
X At coolant temperatures below 248 ‡ (120 †), continue driving
to the next qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid subjecting the engine to heavy loads, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain, and stop-start driving.
#
The battery is not being charged.
Possible causes are:
Ra
faulty alternator
torn poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Open the hood.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
Ra
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
4
Check Engine Oil
At Next
RefuelingCheck
Engine Oil at Next
Refueling
The engine oil level has dropped to a critical level.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the oil level (Y page 239).
X If necessary, add the engine oil (Y page 240).
X Have the engine checked for leaks if engine oil has to be added
more often than usual.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any qualified specialist workshop
or on the Internet at http://www.mbusa.com (USA only).
! The oil level is too low. Avoid long journeys with too little engine oil. There is a risk of
engine damage.
The display messages and the corresponding symbol that indicate that the oil level is too
low must not be ignored.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 197
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
C
There is only a small amount of fuel in the fuel tank.
X Refuel at the nearest gas station.
8
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest gas station.
Fuel Level Low
8
Gas Cap Loose
The fuel system pressure is too low. The fuel filler cap is not closed
correctly or the fuel system is leaking.
X Check that the fuel filler cap is correctly closed.
X If the fuel filler cap is not correctly closed: close the fuel filler
cap.
X If the fuel filler cap is closed: visit a qualified specialist
workshop.
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Cruise Control
Inoperative
Cruise control is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise Control
--- mph
A condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You attempted to save a speed of less than 20 mph (30 km/h).
X If the situation allows, drive faster than 20 mph (30 km/h) and
save the speed.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control
(Y page 156).
Tires
G Warning
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You may
lose control of the vehicle. Continued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat build-up
and possibly a fire.
G Warning
Follow recommended tire inflation pressures.
Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely affect
handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from being overheated.
Z
197
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
198
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 198
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can adversely affect handling and ride comfort, wear
unevenly, increase stopping distance, and result in sudden deflation (blowout) because they are
more likely to become punctured or damaged by road debris, potholes etc.
Display messages
Check
Tire Pressure Soon
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The tire pressure loss warning system has detected a significant
loss in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Check the tires and, if necessary, change the wheel
(Y page 286).
X Check the tire pressures and, if necessary, set to the correct
tire pressure.
X Restart the tire pressure loss warning system when the tire
pressure is correct (Y page 275).
Check Tire Pressure A display message from the tire pressure loss warning system was
shown and the system has not been restarted since.
Then Restart Run
Flat Indicator
X Set the correct tire pressure in all four tires.
X Restart the tire pressure loss warning system (Y page 275).
Run Flat Indicator
Inoperative
The tire pressure loss warning system is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Tire pressures
will be displayed
after driving a
few minutes
The tire pressure monitor is measuring the tire pressure.
X Drive on.
The tire pressures appear in the multifunction display after you
have been driving for a few minutes.
Tire Press. Monitor The TPMS is faulty.
Inoperative
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Tire Pressure
Monitor
Inoperative No
Wheel Sensors
The wheels mounted do not have a suitable tire pressure sensor.
The tire pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Mount wheels with suitable tire pressure sensors.
The TPMS is activated automatically after driving for a few
minutes.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 199
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
Display messages
Check
Tires
Caution
Tire Malfunction
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped significantly.
The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Correct the tire pressure (Y page 277).
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 286).
G Risk of accident
The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 286).
Correct
Tire Pressure
The tire pressure is insufficient in at least one of the tires or the
tire pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tire pressures at the next opportunity. If necessary,
correct the tire pressure (Y page 277).
X Restart the tire pressure monitor (Y page 279).
Tire Press.
Sensor(s)Missing
There is no signal from the tire pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tire is not displayed in the
multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tire pressure sensor replaced at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Tire Press. Monitor No signals are being received from the tire pressure sensors due
to radio interference. The tire pressure monitor is temporarily
Currently
malfunctioning.
Unavailable
X Drive on.
The TPMS restarts automatically as soon as the problem has
been solved.
h
Tire Press.
Warning Caution
Tire Malfunction
G Risk of accident
The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped suddenly.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 286).
Z
199
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
200
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Display messages
h
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 200
Version: 3.0.3.6
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
Check Tire Pressure The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped significantly.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 286).
X Check the tire pressure. If necessary, correct the tire pressure
(Y page 277).
h
Correct Tire
Pressure
The tire pressure is insufficient in at least one of the tires or the
tire pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tire pressures at the next opportunity. If necessary,
correct the tire pressure (Y page 277).
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Shift to 'P' or 'N' You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in
position R or D.
to Start Engine
X Shift the transmission to position P or N.
P
Shift to 'P'
You turned off the engine with the Start/Stop button and opened
the driver's door while the transmission was in position N.
or
You have attempted to turn off the engine with the Start/Stop
button while the transmission was in position R or D.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
A
Wagon: the tailgate is open.
X Close the tailgate.
N
The trunk lid is open.
X Close the trunk lid.
M
G Risk of accident
The hood is open.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Engage the parking brake.
X Close the hood.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 201
Version: 3.0.3.6
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
C
At least one door is open.
X Close all doors.
_
Rear Lt. Backrest
Not Latched
or
Rear Rt. Backrest
Not Latched
D
Power Steering
Malfunction See
Operator's Manual
No Service
¥
Check Washer Fluid
G Risk of injury
The backrest in the rear is not engaged on the left-hand and/or
right-hand side.
X Push the backrest back until it engages.
G Risk of accident
The power steering assistance is faulty. You will need to use more
force to steer.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
Your vehicle is outside the network provider transmitter/receiver
range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol
appears in the multifunction display.
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
X Add washer fluid (Y page 241).
SmartKey
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
You have put the wrong SmartKey in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct SmartKey.
Key Does Not
Belong to Vehicle
+
Take Your Key from
Ignition
The SmartKey is in the ignition lock.
X Remove the SmartKey.
Z
201
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 202
Version: 3.0.3.6
202
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The SmartKey needs to be replaced.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Obtain a new key
+
Replace Key Battery
+
Don't Forget Your
Key
+
Key Not Detected
(red display message)
The batteries of the KEYLESS-GO key are discharged.
X Change the batteries (Y page 74).
The display message is displayed for a maximum of 60 seconds
and is just a reminder.
You have opened the driver's door with the engine switched off.
The KEYLESS-GO key is not in the ignition lock.
X Take the KEYLESS-GO key with you when leaving the vehicle.
The KEYLESS-GO key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle
centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Engage the parking brake.
X Locate the KEYLESS-GO key.
The KEYLESS-GO key is not detected while the engine is running
because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Engage the parking brake.
X Operate the vehicle with the KEYLESS-GO key in the ignition
lock if necessary.
+
Key Not Detected
(white display
message)
The KEYLESS-GO key cannot be detected at present.
X Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
If the KEYLESS-GO key is still not detected:
X
Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
X Operate the vehicle with the KEYLESS-GO key in the ignition
lock if necessary.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 203
Version: 3.0.3.6
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The KEYLESS-GO key has been detected inside the vehicle during
locking.
X Remove the KEYLESS-GO key from the vehicle.
Key Detected in
Vehicle
+
Remove 'Start'
Button and Insert
Key
+
Close Doors to
Lock Vehicle
KEYLESS-GO is temporarily malfunctioning or is defective. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock and turn it to the
desired position.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors and lock the vehicle again.
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Brakes
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
$ (USA only)
You are driving with the parking brake engaged.
J (Canada only)
X Release the parking brake.
The warning lamp goes out and the warning tone ceases.
The red brake system
warning lamp comes on
while the vehicle is
moving. A warning tone
also sounds.
$ (USA only)
G Risk of accident
J (Canada only)
There is insufficient brake fluid in the fluid reservoir.
The red brake system
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
warning lamp comes on
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
while the engine is
under any circumstances.
running. A warning tone
X Engage the parking brake.
also sounds.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
Do not add brake fluid. This will not rectify the problem.
Z
203
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
204
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 204
Version: 3.0.3.6
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
G Warning
Driving with the brake warning lamp illuminated can result in an accident. Have your brake system
checked immediately if the brake warning lamp stays on. Do not add brake fluid before checking
the brake system.
Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts and the
brake fluid catching fire. You can be seriously burned.
Seat belts
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
7
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger
to fasten their seat belts.
After starting the
engine, the red seat
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50).
belt warning lamp lights
up for 6 seconds.
7
G Risk of injury
After starting the
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
engine, the red seat
belt warning lamp lights X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50).
The warning tone ceases.
up. In addition, a
warning tone sounds
for up to 6 seconds.
7
G Risk of injury
The red seat belt
The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
warning lamp lights up
after the engine starts, X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50).
The warning lamp goes out.
as soon as the driver's
or the front-passenger
G Risk of injury
door is closed.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 205
Version: 3.0.3.6
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
7
The red seat belt
warning lamp flashes
and an intermittent
audible warning
sounds.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of injury
The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt. In
addition, you are driving faster than 15 mph (25 km/h) or you have
briefly driven faster than 15 mph (25 km/h).
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 50).
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent audible warning
ceases.
G Risk of injury
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. In addition, you are
driving faster than 15 mph (25 km/h) or you have briefly driven
faster than 15 mph (25 km/h).
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent audible warning
ceases.
Z
205
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
206
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 206
Version: 3.0.3.6
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Safety systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
G Risk of accident
The yellow ABS warning ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) is deactivated due to a malfunction.
lamp is lit while the
Therefore, ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist),
engine is running.
EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution) and hill start assist are
also deactivated.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other
systems, such as the navigation system or the automatic
transmission, will not be available.
!
G Risk of accident
The yellow ABS warning
ABS is temporarily unavailable. ESP®, BAS and EBD, for example,
lamp is lit while the
are therefore not available either.
engine is running.
Self diagnosis is not yet complete.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Carefully drive a suitable distance making slight steering
movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h).
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
X
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 207
Version: 3.0.3.6
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
äå!
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps and the yellow
ABS warning lamp are
lit while the engine is
running. A warning tone
also sounds.
äå!
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps and the yellow
ABS warning lamp are
lit while the engine is
running.
ä
The yellow ESP®
warning lamp flashes
while the vehicle is in
motion.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
EBD is faulty. Therefore, ABS, BAS and hill start assist are not
available either, due to a malfunction.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ABS and ESP® are faulty. Therefore, BAS and hill start assist are
not available either, due to a malfunction.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of
skidding or at least one wheel has started to spin.
Cruise control is deactivated.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when
pulling away.
X Release the accelerator pedal while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
Exceptions: (Y page 63).
Z
207
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 208
Version: 3.0.3.6
208
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ä
ESP®
The yellow
warning lamp flashes
while the vehicle is in
motion.
At least one wheel is spinning and ETS (Electronic Traction
System) is deactivated to prevent the brakes on the drive wheels
from overheating.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
ETS switches back on again as soon as the brakes have cooled
down.
The display message disappears and the ä warning lamp goes
out.
å
G Risk of accident
The yellow ESP® OFF
ESP® is deactivated. ESP® will not stabilize the vehicle if it starts
warning lamp is lit while to skid or if a wheel starts to spin.
the engine is running.
X Reactivate ESP®.
Exceptions: (Y page 63).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X
Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
M (C 63 AMG only)
G Risk of accident
The yellow SPORT
SPORT handling mode is activated. ESP® only stabilizes the vehicle
handling mode warning
in extreme situations. ESP® intervention may not be able to
lamp is lit while the
provide sufficient assistance in such situations, and the vehicle
engine is running.
may start to skid.
X
Reactivate ESP®.
Exceptions: (Y page 63).
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X
Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 209
Version: 3.0.3.6
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
äå
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
6
The red SRS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ESP®, BAS and hill start assist are unavailable, due to a
malfunction. ESP® will not stabilize the vehicle if it starts to skid
or if a wheel starts to spin.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
The restraint systems are malfunctioning. The air bags or ETDs
may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an
accident, not be triggered at all.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
G Warning
In the event a malfunction of the SRS is indicated as outlined above, the SRS may not be
operational.
For your safety, we strongly recommend that you contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
immediately to have the system checked. Otherwise the SRS may not be activated when needed
in an accident, which could result in serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy unexpectedly and
unnecessarily which could also result in injury.
Z
209
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
210
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 210
Version: 3.0.3.6
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
The yellow Check
Engine warning lamp
lights up while the
engine is running.
There may be a malfunction, for example:
Rin
the engine management
the fuel injection system
Rin the exhaust system
Rin the ignition system
Rthe fuel system
The emission limit values may have been exceeded and the engine
may be breaking in emergency mode.
X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Rin
i In some states, you are required by law to visit a qualified
specialist workshop as soon as the Check Engine warning lamp
lights up. If necessary, check whether this is the case in the
state you are in.
8
The fuel system pressure is too low. The fuel filler cap is not closed
The yellow reserve fuel correctly or the fuel system is leaking.
warning lamp flashes
X Check that the fuel filler cap is correctly closed.
while the engine is
X If the fuel filler cap is not correctly closed: close the fuel filler
running.
cap.
X If the fuel filler cap is closed: visit a qualified specialist
workshop.
8
The amount of fuel in the tank has dropped into the reserve range.
The yellow reserve fuel X Refuel at the nearest gas station.
warning lamp lights up
while the engine is
running.
?
The red coolant
warning lamp lights up
while the engine is
running and the coolant
temperature gauge is
at the start of the scale.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is
faulty.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a
risk of engine damage if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue
driving under any circumstances.
X Engage the parking brake.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 211
Version: 3.0.3.6
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The red coolant
warning lamp comes on
while the engine is
running.
The coolant level is too low.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the radiator may be
blocked or the electric radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Allow the engine and coolant to cool.
X Check the coolant level and add the coolant (Y page 240).
Observe the warning notes.
X If the coolant needs adding more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the radiator is not blocked, e.g.
by snow, slush or ice.
X At coolant temperatures below 248 ‡ (120 †), continue driving
to the next qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid subjecting the engine to heavy loads, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain, and stop-start driving.
?
The red coolant
warning lamp comes on
while the engine is
running. A warning tone
also sounds.
The coolant has exceeded a temperature of 248 ‡ (120 †). The
airflow to the radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be
too low.
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Allow the engine and coolant to cool.
G Warning
Driving when your engine is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into the
engine compartment to catch fire. You could be seriously burned.
Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns which can occur just by opening the
engine hood. Stay away from the engine if you see or hear steam coming from it.
Stop the vehicle in a safe location away from other traffic. Turn off the engine, get out of the
vehicle and do not stand near the vehicle until the engine has cooled down.
! If the coolant temperature exceeds 248 ‡(120 †) do not continue driving. The engine will
otherwise be damaged.
Z
211
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
On-board computer and displays
212
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 212
Version: 3.0.3.6
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Tires
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
G Risk of accident
USA only:
The tire pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at
The yellow combination least one of the tires.
low tire pressure
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
warning lamp/TPMS
maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
malfunction warning
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
lamp is lit.
display.
X Check the tire pressure. If necessary, correct the tire pressure
(Y page 277).
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 286).
h
The tire pressure monitor is faulty.
USA only:
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
The yellow combination
low tire pressure
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
warning lamp/TPMS
malfunction warning
lamp flashes for sixty
seconds and then
remains lit.
G Warning
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked every other week when cold and
inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the Tire and
Loading Information placard on the driver's door B-pillar or, if available, the tire inflation pressure
label on the inside of the fuel filler flap. If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size
indicated on the Tire and Loading Information placard or, if available, the tire inflation pressure
label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring
system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure warning lamp when one or more of your tires
are significantly underinflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure warning lamp illuminates,
you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure.
Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling
and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance,
and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if underinflation has
not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure warning lamp.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the
system is not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire
pressure warning lamp. When the system detects a malfunction, the warning lamp will flash for
approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 213
Version: 3.0.3.6
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction
indicator is lit, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of incompatible
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning
properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction warning lamp after replacing one or more tires or
wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the
TPMS to continue to function properly.
Z
213
On-board computer and displays
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
214
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 214
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 215
Version: 3.0.3.6
215
Vehicle equipment ............................
Loading guidelines ............................
Stowage compartments ...................
Stowage areas ..................................
Features .............................................
216
216
216
217
220
Loading, stowing and features
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
216
Stowage compartments
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
Loading, stowing and features
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 216
Version: 3.0.3.6
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
Loading guidelines
G Warning!
Always fasten items being carried as securely
as possible using fastening materials
appropriate for the weight and size of the
load.
In an accident, during hard braking or sudden
maneuvers, loose items will be thrown around
inside the vehicle. This can cause injury to
vehicle occupants unless the items are
securely fastened in the vehicle.
To help avoid personal injury during a collision
or sudden maneuver, exercise care when
transporting cargo. Do not pile luggage or
cargo higher than the seat backrests.
The trunk is the preferred place to carry
objects. Do not place anything on the rearwindow shelf.
Never drive a vehicle with the trunk open.
Deadly carbon monoxide (CO) gases may
enter vehicle interior resulting in
unconsciousness and death.
The handling characteristics of a laden
vehicle are dependent on the distribution of
the load within the vehicle. For this reason,
you should observe the following notes when
transporting a load:
RWhen transporting a load, never exceed the
maximum permissible gross vehicle weight
or the permissible axle loads for the vehicle
(including occupants). The values are
stated on the vehicle identification plate on
the B-pillar on the driver's side.
RPosition heavy loads as far forwards as
possible and as low down in the trunk as
possible.
RThe load must not protrude above the
upper edge of the seat backrests.
Ralways place the load against the rear or
front seat backrests. Make sure that the
seat backrests are securely locked into
place.
RAlways place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
RSecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant tie down. Pad sharp edges
for protection.
Stowage compartments
Important safety notes
G Warning!
To help avoid personal injury during a collision
or sudden maneuver, exercise care when
storing objects in the vehicle. Put luggage or
cargo in the trunk if possible.
Do not pile luggage or cargo higher than the
seat backrests.
Keep compartment lids closed. This will help
to prevent stored objects from being thrown
about and injuring vehicle occupants during
Rbraking
Rvehicle
Ran
maneuvers
accident
Stowage compartments in the front
Glove box
i Depending on the vehicle equipment,
there is an AUX-IN connection or a Media
Interface installed in the glove box. Media
Interface is a universal interface for mobile
audio equipment, e.g. for an iPod® or USB
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 217
Version: 3.0.3.6
Stowage areas
217
devices; see separate COMAND operating
instructions.
(Y page 127).
X
X
To open: pull handle : and open glove box
flap ;.
X To close: fold glove box flap ; upwards
until it engages.
The glove box can only be locked and
unlocked using the mechanical key.
X
To lock: insert the mechanical key into the
lock and turn it 90° clockwise to position
2.
X To unlock: insert the mechanical key into
the lock and turn it 90° counter-clockwise
to position 1.
Stowage compartment under the
armrest
i A small and a large stowage compartment
are located under the armrest. The small
stowage compartment can be removed for
emptying.
To open: press left-hand button ; or righthand button :.
The stowage compartment opens.
Stowage compartments in the rear
Stowage pockets
G Warning!
Storage bags are intended for storing lightweight items only.
Heavy objects, objects with sharp edges or
fragile objects may not be transported in the
storage bag. In an accident, during hard
braking, or sudden maneuvers, they could be
thrown around inside the vehicle and cause
injury to vehicle occupants.
Storage bags cannot protect transported
goods in the event of an accident.
Storage bags are located in the rear
compartment on the driver's and frontpassenger seat backrests.
Stowage areas
Parcel nets
G Warning
Parcel nets are intended for storing lightweight items only, such as road maps, mail,
etc.
Heavy objects, objects with sharp edges, or
fragile objects may not be transported in the
parcel nets. In an accident, during hard
Z
Loading, stowing and features
i The glove box can be ventilated
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Stowage areas
218
Loading, stowing and features
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 218
Version: 3.0.3.6
braking, or sudden maneuvers, they could be
thrown around inside the vehicle and cause
injury to vehicle occupants.
Parcel nets cannot protect transported goods
in the event of an accident.
Parcel nets are located in the front-passenger
footwell and on the left-hand side of the trunk.
X
Pull right-hand or left-hand rear seat
backrest release handle :.
The corresponding rear seat backrest is
released.
X Fully insert the rear seat backrest head
restraints.
Rear bench seat through-loading
feature
Important safety notes
G Warning!
When expanding the cargo volume, always
fold the seat backrests fully forward.
Unless you are transporting cargo, the seat
backrests must remain properly locked in the
upright position.
In an accident, during hard braking or sudden
maneuvers, loose items will be thrown around
inside the vehicle. This can cause injury to
vehicle occupants unless the items are
securely fastened in the vehicle.
Always use the cargo tie-down rings.
X
Fold rear seat backrest ; forwards.
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
Folding the rear seat backrest back
The left-hand and right-hand rear seat
backrests can be folded down separately to
increase the trunk capacity.
Folding the rear seat backrest forward
X
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped when folding the rear seat
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be
damaged.
X
X
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Open the trunk.
Fold rear seat backrest : back until it
engages.
G Warning!
Always lock the seat backrest in its upright
position when the rear seat bench is
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 219
Version: 3.0.3.6
Stowage areas
occupied, or the extended cargo volume is not
in use.
Check for secure locking by pushing and
pulling on the seat backrest.
In an accident, during hard braking or sudden
maneuvers, loose items will be thrown around
inside the vehicle. This can cause injury to
vehicle occupants unless the items are
securely fastened in the vehicle.
To help avoid personal injury during a collision
or sudden maneuver, exercise care when
transporting cargo.
i You should always engage the rear seat
backrests if you do not need the throughloading feature. This will prevent
unauthorized access to the trunk from the
vehicle interior.
X
Adjust the head restraints if necessary
(Y page 96).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
Vehicles with through-loading feature on the rear
bench seat
: cargo tie down rings
Bag hooks
! The bag hook can bear a maximum load
of 6.6 lbs (3 kg). Do not use it to secure a
load.
Securing cargos
Lashing eyelets
Observe the following notes on securing
loads:
Rsecure
the load using the cargo tie down
rings.
not use elastic straps or nets to secure
a load, as these are only intended as an
anti-slip protection for light loads.
Rdo not route tie downs across sharp edges
or corners.
Rpad sharp edges for protection.
There are four cargo tie down rings in the
trunk.
Rdo
: Bag hook
Stowage well under the trunk floor
The TIREFIT kit, the vehicle tool kit, etc. are
located in the stowage compartment.
Z
219
Loading, stowing and features
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 220
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
220
X
To open: pull handle : upwards.
Depending on the vehicle equipment,
ensure that when the roof carrier is
installed you can:
Loading, stowing and features
Rraise
the tilt/sliding sunroof fully
the panorama roof with power tilt/
sliding panel fully
Ropen the trunk lid fully
Ropen
! To avoid damaging or scratching the
covers, do not use metallic or hard objects
to open them.
X
Hook handle : into rain trough ;.
Fastening the roof carrier
! Unhook the handle before again before
closing the trunk lid and clip it in securely
to prevent the handle flap from protruding.
Otherwise, you could damage the handle.
Roof carrier
Important safety notes
G Warning!
Only use roof racks approved by MercedesBenz for your vehicle model to avoid damage
to the vehicle.
Follow the manufacturer's installation
instructions. Otherwise, an improperly
attached roof rack system or its load could
become detached from the vehicle.
Do not exceed the maximum roof load of
220 lb (100 kg).
Take into consideration that when the roof
rack is loaded, the handling characteristics
are different from those when operating the
vehicle without the roof rack loaded.
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use roof carriers that have been tested
and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
This helps to prevent damage to the
vehicle.
Position the cargo on the roof rack in such
a way that the vehicle will not sustain
damage even when it is in motion.
X
Open covers : carefully in the direction of
the arrow.
X Fold covers : upwards.
X Only secure the roof carrier to the
anchorage points under covers :.
X Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Features
Cup holder
Points to observe before use
G Warning
In order to help prevent spilling liquids on
vehicle occupants and/or vehicle equipment,
only use containers that fit into the cup
holder. Use lids on open containers and do
not fill containers to a height where the
contents, especially hot liquids, could spill
during braking, vehicle maneuvers, or in an
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 221
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
accident. Liquids spilled on vehicle occupants
may cause serious personal injury. Liquids
spilled on vehicle equipment may cause
damage not covered by the Mercedes-Benz
Limited Warranty.
When not in use, keep the cup holder closed.
An open cup holder may cause injury to you
or others when contacted during braking,
vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident.
Keep in mind that objects placed in the cup
holder may come loose during braking,
vehicle maneuvers, or in an accident and be
thrown around in the vehicle interior. Objects
thrown around in the vehicle interior may
cause an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
Cup holder in the center console
X
To open: raise the armrest cover.
Press release catch :.
Cup holder ; folds out forwards.
X Swing the armrest cover back down, if
necessary.
X To close: raise the armrest cover.
X Swing cup holder ; back until it engages.
X Swing the armrest cover back down, if
necessary.
X
Sun visors
Overview of the sun visor
G Warning
Cup holder in the rear seat armrest
Do not use the vanity mirror while driving.
Keep the vanity mirrors in the sun visors
closed while the vehicle is in motion.
Reflected glare can endanger you and others.
! Do not sit or lean your bodyweight on the
armrests when they are folded out as you
could damage them.
! Only fold the armrests up when the cup
holder is closed. The cup holder may
otherwise be damaged.
: Mirror light
; Bracket
= Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
Z
221
Loading, stowing and features
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Features
222
? Vanity mirror
A Mirror cover
Loading, stowing and features
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 222
Version: 3.0.3.6
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover
A has been folded up.
Glare from the side
X
Fold down the sun visor.
Pull the sun visor out of retainer ;.
X Swing the sun visor to the side.
X
! Always guide the roller sunblind by hand.
Do not let it snap back suddenly as this
would damage the automatic roller
mechanism.
! Do not drive the vehicle with the roller
sunblind hooked in and the side windows
opened simultaneously. The roller sunblind
can jump out of the retainers and spring
back suddenly when driving at high speeds,
e.g. when driving on the freeway. This could
damage the inertia reel. Therefore, either
close the side window or retract the roller
sunblind before driving at high speeds.
Rear window roller sunblind (Sedan)
To extend/retract the roller sunblind
G Warning
X
Pull or push the sun visor in the direction of
the arrow.
Roller sunblinds for the rear side
windows
X
To extend: pull the roller sunblind out by
tab : and hook it onto retainers ; at the
top of the window.
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the
SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle.
Do not leave children unattended in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised
access to a vehicle could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury. The children
could:
Rinjure
themselves on parts of the vehicle
seriously or fatally injured through
excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold
Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with
vehicle equipment that can be operated
even if the SmartKey is removed from the
ignition lock or removed from the vehicle,
such as seat adjustment, steering wheel
adjustment, or the memory function
If children open a door, they could injure other
persons or get out of the vehicle and injure
themselves or be injured by following traffic.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. The child restraint system's
metal parts, for example, could become very
Rbe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 223
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
223
hot, and the child could be burned on these
parts.
When operating the rear window sunshade
make sure there is no danger of anyone being
harmed by the extending or retracting
procedure.
The extending or retracting procedure can be
immediately halted by briefly pressing rear
window sunshade switch. To reverse direction
of movement, press rear window sunshade
switch again.
! Make sure that the roller sunblind can
move freely. Otherwise, the roller sunblind
or other objects could be damaged.
X
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X To remove the insert: hold insert = by
the ribbing at the sides and lift it up and
out ;.
X To refit the insert: press insert = into the
holder until it engages.
X To close: press cover : briefly at the
front.
The cover moves back.
Ashtray in the rear compartment
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To extend or retract: briefly press
button :.
The roller sunblind fully extends or fully
retracts.
X
Ashtray
Ashtray in the cockpit
i There is a stowage space under the
ashtray.
! The stowage space under the ashtray is
To open: pull cover ; out by its top edge.
To remove the insert: press release
button = and lift the insert up and out.
X To re-insert the insert: replace insert :
from above.
X Press insert : into the holder until it
engages.
X
not heat resistant. Before placing lit
cigarettes in the ashtray, make sure that
the ashtray is properly engaged. Otherwise,
the stowage space could be damaged.
Z
Loading, stowing and features
G Warning!
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
224
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 224
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
Cigarette lighter
Loading, stowing and features
G Warning
When leaving the vehicle, always remove the
SmartKey from the ignition lock. Always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle.
Do not leave children unattended in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. A child's unsupervised
access to a vehicle could result in an accident
and/or serious personal injury. The children
could:
Rinjure
themselves on parts of the vehicle
Rbe seriously or fatally injured through
excessive exposure to extreme heat or cold
Rinjure themselves or cause an accident with
vehicle equipment that can be operated
even if the SmartKey is removed from the
ignition lock or removed from the vehicle,
such as seat adjustment, steering wheel
adjustment, or the memory function
If children open a door, they could injure other
persons or get out of the vehicle and injure
themselves or be injured by following traffic.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. The child restraint system's
metal parts, for example, could become very
hot, and the child could be burned on these
parts.
G Warning
Never touch the heating element or sides of
the lighter; they are extremely hot. Hold the
knob only.
Make sure any children traveling with you do
not injure themselves or start a fire with the
hot cigarette lighter.
Center console, front
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Slide cover : forwards until it engages.
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out
automatically when the heating element is
red-hot.
12 V sockets
Points to observe before use
! If you are using all sockets in the vehicle,
make sure that you do not exceed the
maximum current draw of 55 A. Otherwise,
you will overload the fuses.
The socket can be used for accessories with
a maximum power consumption of 180 W,
e.g. lamps or chargers for mobile phones.
If you use the socket for long periods when
the engine is switched off, the battery may
discharge.
Dashboard socket
The socket is installed in vehicles with audio
equipment or COMAND.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 225
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
X
Open the glove box (Y page 216).
X Lift up the cover of socket :.
An additional socket is installed in the center
console on vehicles without an ashtray with
cigarette lighter.
X
X
Pull cover ; out by its top edge.
Lift up the cover of socket :.
115 V socket
G Warning!
X
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X To close: press cover : briefly at the
front.
The cover moves back.
Socket in the rear compartment
A socket is installed in the center console in
the rear compartment in vehicles with an
ashtray and a cigarette lighter.
The 115V AC socket operates at high voltage.
Use the 115V AC socket in the vehicle with
the same caution and prudence that you
exercise when using power outlets at home.
Keep any fluids away from the 115V AC
socket. Do not clean the socket with fluids or
tapered objects. Keep the 115V AC socket
cover in the closed position, when not in use.
Otherwise, you could suffer an electric shock
and be seriously or even fatally injured.
G Warning!
A device that you connect must have a
suitable plug that complies with U.S.
standards. Never pull on the cable to unplug
a plug from the 115V AC socket. Do not use
a damaged connection cable. The 115V AC
socket may not be connected to another
115V AC power source. Do not use converters
to a grounding plug with the 115V AC socket.
This could cause serious personal injury to
you and/or others.
G Warning!
If the 115V AC socket is damaged or torn out
of the trim, do not use or touch the 115V AC
socket. Using a 115V AC socket that is
damaged or torn out of the trim could cause
serious personal injury to you and/or others.
Z
225
Loading, stowing and features
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
226
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 226
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
Possible causes of malfunction:
Loading, stowing and features
Rthe
The 115 V AC power socket : provides an
alternating voltage of 115 V, so that small
electronic devices can be connected. These
devices, such as games consoles, chargers
and laptops, should not consume more than
a maximum of 150 W altogether.
Requirements for operation of these devices:
R12
V power sockets in the footwell of the
second row of seats and in the stowage
compartment must be functioning
correctly (Y page 224).
Rthe plug of the electronic device is plugged
into the 115 V power socket :.
Rthe on-board voltage is within a permissible
voltage range.
Rthe maximum wattage of the device to be
connected must not exceed 150 W.
X Open flap =.
X Insert the plug of the electrical device into
the 115 V power socket :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up.
If indicator lamp ; does not light up, please
read the chapter on malfunctions.
X To turn off: disconnect the plug from the
115 V power socket :.
Ensure that you do not pull on the cord.
X Close flap =.
on-board voltage of the vehicle is not
within the permissible voltage range.
Rthe temperature of the DC/AC converter is
momentarily too high.
Rsome small electronic devices have a
constant nominal power of less than
150 W, but a very high inrush current.
These devices will not work. If you connect
such a device, the 115 V power socket :
will not supply it with power.
If indicator lamp ; still does not light up,
consult a specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
mbrace25
Important safety notes
! A license agreement must exist in order
to activate the mbrace service. Make sure
that your system is activated and ready for
use, and press the ï MB info call button
to register. If you cannot carry out any of
the steps mentioned, the system may not
be activated.
If you have any questions concerning
activation, please contact one of the
following service hotlines:
RUSA:
Response Center under
866-990-9007
RCanada: Customer Service under
1-888-923-8367
Shortly after successfully registering with the
mbrace service, a user ID and password will
be sent to you by post. You can use this
password to log in to the mbrace section
under "Owners Online" at http://
www.mbusa.com26.
The mbrace system is available if:
Rit
has been activated and is operational.
Activation requires an available cellular
25 The
system is called TELEAID in Canada.
only.
26 USA
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 227
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
phone network, a valid SIM card and a
service subscription to a surveillance
service provider.
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged.
Rthe corresponding cellular phone network
is available for transmitting data to the
customer center.
i Determining the location of the vehicle on
a map is only possible if there is sufficient
GPS reception and the vehicle position can
be forwarded to the customer center.
The mbrace system
The mbrace system provides three different
services:
Rautomatic
and manual emergency call
Assistance call
RMB info call
To control the volume during an mbrace call,
proceed as follows:
RRoadside
X
Press the W or X button on the
multifunction steering wheel.
or
X
Use the volume controller of the audio
system.
You can find information and a description of
all available features under "Owners Online"
at http://www.mbusa.com27
System self-test
After you have switched on the ignition, the
system carries out a self-diagnosis.
G Warning
A malfunction in the system has been
detected if any or all of the following
conditions occur:
RThe
indicator lamp in the SOS button does
not come on during the system self-test.
RThe indicator lamp in Roadside Assistance
button F does not come on during the
system self-test.
RThe indicator lamp in Information button
ï does not come on during the system
self-test.
RThe indicator lamp in the SOS button,
Roadside Assistance button F, or
Information button ï remains
illuminated constantly in red after the
system self-test.
RThe message Tele Aid Inoperative or
Tele Aid Not Activated appears in the
multifunction display after the system selftest.
If a malfunction is indicated as outlined above,
the system may not operate as expected. In
case of an emergency, help will have to be
summoned by other means.
Have the system checked at the nearest
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or contact
the following service hotlines:
RUSA:
Response Center under the number
866-990-9007
RCanada: Customer Service under
1-888-923-8367.
Emergency call
Important safety notes
! A license agreement must exist in order
to activate the mbrace service. Make sure
that your system is activated and ready for
use, and press the ï MB info call button
to register. If you cannot carry out any of
the steps mentioned, the system may not
be activated.
27 USA
227
only.
Z
Loading, stowing and features
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
228
Features
If you have any questions concerning
activation, please contact one of the
following service hotlines:
RUSA:
Loading, stowing and features
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 228
Version: 3.0.3.6
Response Center under
866-990-9007
RCanada: Customer Service under
1-888-923-8367
An emergency call is dialed automatically if
an air bag or Emergency Tensioning Device is
triggered.
established, then the mbrace system could
not initiate an emergency call (e.g. the
relevant cellular phone network is not
available).
The message Call Failed appears in the
multifunction display for approximately
10 seconds.
Should this occur, assistance must be
summoned by other means.
Making an emergency call
i An automatically dialed mbrace
emergency call cannot be canceled.
An emergency call can also be dialed
manually.
Once the emergency call is in progress, the
indicator lamp in the SOS button flashes. The
Connecting Call message appears in the
multifunction display.
COMAND is muted.
Once a connection has been established, the
Call Connected message appears in the
multifunction display.
All important information on the emergency
is compiled, for example:
Rcurrent
location of the vehicle (as
determined by the GPS system)
Rvehicle model
Rvehicle color
Rvehicle identification number
A voice connection between the Response
Center and the occupants of the vehicle will
be established automatically soon after the
emergency call has been initiated. If the
vehicle occupants are responsive, the
Response Center attempts to get more
information on the emergency.
i If no vehicle occupant answers, an
ambulance is immediately sent to the
vehicle.
G Warning
If the indicator lamp in the SOS button is
flashing continuously and there was no voice
connection to the Response Center
X
To initiate an emergency call
manually: press cover : briefly to open.
X Press SOS button ; briefly.
The indicator lamp in SOS button ;
flashes until the emergency call is ended.
X Wait for the voice connection with the
Response Center.
X After the emergency call is ended, close
cover :.
G Warning
If you feel at any way in jeopardy when in the
vehicle (e.g. smoke or fire in the vehicle,
vehicle in a dangerous road location), please
do not wait for voice contact after you have
pressed the SOS button. Carefully leave the
vehicle and move to a safe location. The
Response Center will automatically contact
local emergency officials with the vehicle's
approximate location if they receive an
automatic SOS signal and cannot make voice
contact with the vehicle occupants.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 229
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
Roadside Assistance call button
Mercedes-Benz technician or organizes for
your vehicle to be transported to the nearest
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. You may
be charged for services such as repair work
and/or towing. Further details are available
in your mbrace manual.
i If the indicator lamp in MB info call
X
Press and hold Roadside Assistance
button : for more than two seconds.
A call to a Mercedes-Benz Roadside
Assistance Representative is initiated. The
indicator lamp in Roadside Assistance
button : flashes while the call is active.
The Connecting Call message appears in
the multifunction display and the audio
system or COMAND is muted.
If a connection can be established, the Call
Connected message appears in the
multifunction display.
If a mobile phone network is available and
there is sufficient GPS reception, the mbrace
system transmits data to the Response
Center, for example:
Rcurrent
location of the vehicle
Rvehicle identification number
Rvehicle model
Rvehicle color
button : flashes continuously and it was
not possible to establish a voice
connection to the Response Center, then
the mbrace system has failed to initiate a
Roadside Assistance call (e.g. the
corresponding cellular phone network is
not available). The Call Failed message
appears in the multifunction display.
X
To end a call: press the ~ button on the
multifunction steering wheel.
or
X
Press the corresponding button for ending
a phone call on the audio system or on
COMAND.
i Sign and Drive services28: you are not
charged for services such as jump-starting,
providing a few gallons of fuel for a fuel tank
that has been run dry or changing a flat tire
with the vehicle's own spare tire.
MB Info call button
i The audio system or COMAND display
shows that an mbrace call is active. You can
switch to the navigation menu by pressing
the NAVI button on COMAND during the
call. Spoken commands are not available.
A voice connection is established between
the Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance
Representative and the vehicle occupants.
X Describe the type of assistance needed.
The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance
Representative either sends a qualified
28 USA
only.
Z
229
Loading, stowing and features
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Features
230
X
Loading, stowing and features
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 230
Version: 3.0.3.6
Press and hold MB info call button : for
more than two seconds.
A call to the Response Center is initiated.
MB info call button indicator lamp :
flashes while the connection is being
established. The Connecting Call
message appears in the multifunction
display and COMAND is muted.
If a connection can be established, the Call
Connected message appears in the
multifunction display.
If a mobile phone network is available and
there is sufficient GPS reception, the mbrace
system transmits data to the Response
Center, for example:
Rcurrent
location of the vehicle
identification number
Rvehicle model
Rvehicle color
Rvehicle
i The audio system or COMAND display
shows that an mbrace call is active. You can
switch to the navigation menu by pressing
the NAVI button on COMAND during the
call. Spoken commands are not available.
A voice connection between the Response
Center and the vehicle occupants is
established. You can obtain information on
how to operate your vehicle's systems, on the
location of the nearest authorized MercedesBenz Center, and on further products and
services offered by Mercedes-Benz USA.
Further details on the mbrace system can be
found under http://www.mbusa.com29.
Log in under "Owners Online".
i If the indicator lamp in MB info call
button : flashes continuously and no
voice connection to the Response Center
has been established, then the mbrace
system has failed to initiate an MB info call
(e.g. the corresponding mobile phone
network is not available). The Call
Failed message appears in the
multifunction display.
29 USA
only.
X
To end a call: press the ~ button on the
multifunction steering wheel.
or
X
Press the corresponding button for ending
a phone call on the audio system or on
COMAND.
Call priority
An emergency call can still be initiated even
if a service call is currently active, e.g. a
Roadside Assistance call or an MB info call.
In this case, an emergency call will take
priority and override all other active calls.
The indicator lamp of the respective button
flashes until the call is ended. An emergency
call can only be terminated by the Response
Center. All other calls can be ended by
pressing the ~ button on the
multifunction steering wheel or the
corresponding button for ending a telephone
call on the audio system or on COMAND.
i When an mbrace call has been initiated,
the audio system or COMAND is muted.
The mobile phone is no longer connected
to COMAND. If you must use your mobile
phone, we recommend that you do this only
when the vehicle is stationary and in a safe
location.
Downloading destinations in COMAND
Destination Download gives you access to a
database with over 10 million points of
interest (POIs) which can be downloaded to
the navigation system of your vehicle. If you
know the destination, you can download the
address or obtain the location of points of
interest (POIs) or important destinations in
the surrounding area.
You are prompted to confirm route guidance
to the entered address.
The system calculates the route and
subsequently starts the route guidance with
the address entered.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 231
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
command for vehicle remote unlocking has
been received.
If you pull the trunk handle for more than
20 seconds before receiving authorization
for remote unlocking, you must wait 15
minutes before you can pull on the handle
of the trunk lid again.
i If you select No, the address can be stored
in the address book.
i The Destination Download function is
available if the corresponding cellular
phone network is available and data
transfer is possible.
Search & Send
"Search & Send" is a destination entry
service. You can find further information on
"Search & Send" in the separate COMAND
operating instructions.
Vehicle remote opening
If you have unintentionally locked your
vehicle (e.g. the SmartKey is inside the
vehicle) and a replacement key is not
available:
X Contact the following service hotlines:
RUSA: Response Center under the
number 866-990-9007
RCanada: Customer Service under
1-888-923-8367
You will be asked for your password.
X Return to your vehicle at the time arranged
with the Response Center.
X Pull the trunk handle for at least 20
seconds until the indicator lamp in the SOS
button (Y page 227) flashes.
The Connecting Call message appears in
the multifunction display.
Alternatively, the vehicle can also be opened
via the Internet in the "Owners Online"
section using your ID number and
password30.
i Vehicle remote unlocking is only possible
if the corresponding cellular phone
network is accessible.
The SOS button flashes and the
Connecting Call message appears in the
multifunction display to confirm that the
30 USA
Remote vehicle locking in an
emergency
If you forget to lock your vehicle but are no
longer in the vicinity of the vehicle, it can be
locked for you by the Response Center.
The vehicle can be locked remotely up to four
days after the ignition was last switched off.
X Contact the following service hotlines:
RUSA: Response Center under
866-990-9007
RCanada: Customer Service under
1-888-923-8367
You will be asked for your PIN.
The next time you are in your vehicle and
switch on the ignition, the Tele Aid Doors
locked by remote control message
appears in the multifunction display.
i The vehicle remote locking feature is
available when the relevant mobile phone
network is available and data connection is
possible.
Stolen Vehicle Recovery Services
If your vehicle has been stolen:
X
Contact the police.
The police will issue an incident report. This
report has a number.
X This number will be forwarded to the
Response Center together with your PIN.
The Response Center will then attempt to
covertly contact the mbrace system. The
Response Center contacts you and the
local law enforcement authority if the
vehicle is located. However, only the law
only.
Z
231
Loading, stowing and features
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
232
Features
enforcement authority is informed of the
location of the vehicle.
i If the anti-theft alarm system remains
Loading, stowing and features
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 232
Version: 3.0.3.6
activated for longer than thirty seconds,
mbrace is automatically connected to the
Customer Assistance Center.
Garage door opener
Important safety notes
Up to three different door and gate systems
can be operated using the remote control
integrated in the overhead control panel.
i Certain garage door openers are not
compatible with the integrated remote
control. If you experience difficulties with
the programming of the integrated remote
control, contact an authorized MercedesBenz Center or call the following telephone
assistance service:
RUSA:
Mercedes-Benz Customer
Assistance Center on
1-800-FOR-MERCedes
RCanada: Customer Service
on1-800-387-0100
G Warning
Before programming the integrated remote
control to a garage door opener or gate
operator, make sure people and objects are
out of the way of the device to prevent
potential harm or damage. When
programming a garage door opener, the door
moves up or down. When programming a gate
operator, the gate opens or closes.
Do not use the integrated remote control with
any garage door opener that lacks safety stop
and reverse features as required by U.S.
federal safety standards (this includes any
garage door opener model manufactured
before April 1, 1982). A garage door that
cannot detect an object - signaling the door
to stop and reverse - does not meet current
U.S. federal safety standards.
When programming a garage door opener,
park vehicle outside the garage.
Do not run the engine while programming the
integrated remote control. Inhalation of
exhaust gas is hazardous to your health. All
exhaust gas contains carbon monoxide (CO),
and inhaling it can cause unconsciousness
and possible death. All exhaust gas contains
carbon monoxide (CO), and inhaling it can
cause unconsciousness and possible death.
i USA only:
This device complies with part 15 of the
FCC rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions:
1. The device must not cause harmful
interference.
2. The device must withstand any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Unauthorized modification of this device
could void the device's operating permit.
i Canada only:
This device complies with the RSS-210
requirements of Industry Canada.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1. The device must not cause harmful
interference.
2. The device must accept any interference
received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
Unauthorized modification of this device
could void the user's authority to legally
operate the device.
Programming the remote control
Programming
G Warning!
Only press the transmitter button on the
integrated remote control if there are no
persons or objects present within the sweep
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 233
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
i The distance between garage door
remote control A and the integrated
garage door opener depends on the system
of the garage door drive. You might require
several attempts. You should test every
position for at least 20 seconds before
trying another position.
X
Remote control in the rear-view mirror
Garage door remote control A is not part of
the garage door opener.
i To achieve the best result, insert new
batteries in garage door remote control
A of your garage door drive before
programming.
X
Erase the memory of the integrated remote
control (Y page 235) before programming
it for the first time.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Press and hold one of transmitter
buttons ; to ? on the integrated remote
control.
After a short time, indicator lamp : will
start flashing. It flashes about once per
second.
i Indicator lamp : flashes immediately
the first time that the transmitter button is
programmed. If this transmitter button has
already been programmed, indicator
lamp : will only start flashing at a rate of
once per second after 20 seconds have
elapsed.
X
X
Keep the transmitter button depressed.
Point transmitter button B of garage door
remote control A towards the transmitter
buttons on the rear-view mirror from a
distance of 2 to 12 inches (5 to 20 cm).
Keep transmitter button B on garage door
remote control A pressed until indicator
lamp : starts to flash rapidly.
The programming has been successful if
indicator lamp : flashes rapidly.
X Release transmitter buttons ;, = or ?
on the integrated remote control or
transmitter button on the garage door
remote control B.
If indicator lamp : goes out after
approximately 20 seconds and has not
flashed rapidly:
X
Release transmitter buttons ;, = or ?
on the integrated remote control or
transmitter button on the garage door
remote control B.
X Repeat the procedure for the other
transmitter buttons. When doing so, vary
the distance between the garage door's
remote control and the transmitter buttons
in the rear-view mirror.
i If the garage door system works with a
rolling code, you must synchronize the
remote control integrated into the rearview mirror with the garage door system
receiver after programming.
You will find further information in the
garage door opening system's operating
instructions, e.g. the sections on
"Synchronizing the transmitter" or
"Registering a new transmitter". You can
also call the hotline mentioned above.
Notes on programming the remote
control
Canadian radio frequency laws require
transmitter signals to "time-out" (or quit) after
several seconds of transmission. This may
Z
Loading, stowing and features
of the garage door. People could otherwise be
injured by the movement of the door.
233
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Loading, stowing and features
234
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 234
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
not be long enough for the integrated signal
transmitter to pick up the signal during
programming. Similar to this Canadian law,
some U.S. gate operators are designed to
"time-out" in the same manner.
If you live in Canada or have difficulties
programming the garage door opener
(regardless of where you live) when using the
programming steps (see above), proceed as
follows:
X Press transmitter button (;, = or ?) and
hold it down during the following steps until
the setup has been completed
successfully.
X At the same time, press transmitter button
B of the garage door remote control for
two seconds, then release it for two
seconds, then press it again for two
seconds.
X Repeat this sequence on transmitter
button B of the garage door remote
control until the frequency signal has been
learned.
X If the setup procedure is successful,
indicator lamp : flashes once slowly and
goes out after a few seconds.
X Continue with the other programming
steps (see above).
Problems when programming
If you have problems when programming the
integrated remote control, please note the
following:
Rcheck
the transmitter frequency of garage
door remote control A (which can usually
be found on the rear of the remote control).
The integrated remote control is
compatible with equipment that operates
in the frequency range 280 to 390 MHz.
Rreplace the batteries in garage door remote
control A. This increases the likelihood of
garage door remote control A sending a
strong and precise signal to the integrated
remote control on the rear-view mirror.
RWhen
aiming the garage door remote
control at the transmitter buttons on the
rear-view mirror, hold garage door remote
control A at differing distances and angles
from the transmitter button that you are
programming. Try different angles from a
distance of 2 to 12 inches (5 to 30 cm) or
the same angle from differing distances.
RIf there is another garage door remote
control for the same device, perform the
programming steps again using the remote
control. Before performing these steps,
make sure that new batteries have been
installed in the garage door remote control.
RAlign the antenna cable of the garage door
opener unit. This can improve signal
reception/transmission.
Opening or closing the garage door
Once programmed, the integrated remote
control will assume the function of the garage
door system's remote control. Please also
read the operating instructions for the garage
door system.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Press transmitter button ;, = or ? in the
overhead control panel that you have
programmed to operate the garage door.
Garage door system with fixed code:
indicator lamp : lights up continuously.
Garage door system with rolling code:
indicator lamp : flashes briefly and then
lights up for approximately two seconds.
This is repeated for up to 20 seconds.
i The transmitter will transmit a signal for
as long as the transmitter button is being
pressed. The transmission will be halted
after a maximum of 20 seconds and
indicator lamp : will flash. Press the
transmitter button again, if necessary.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 235
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
235
Clearing the remote control memory
X
Loading, stowing and features
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Press and hold transmitter buttons ;
and ? for approximately 20 seconds until
indicator lamp : flashes rapidly.
The memory is cleared.
i You should clear the remote control
memory before selling the vehicle.
Compass
Zone map for North America
To obtain correct direction display in rearview mirror :, the compass must be
calibrated and the magnetic field zone set.
X To call up the compass: briefly press
button =.
The compass indicates the direction in
which the vehicle is currently driving: N, NE,
E, SE, S, SW, W or NW.
X To calibrate the compass: determine
your position using the following the zone
maps.
Zone map for South America
X
Press and hold button = for approximately
three seconds.
The currently selected zone appears in
compass display ;.
X To select the zone: press button =
repeatedly until the desired zone is
selected.
The zone has been selected when compass
display ; shows the point of the compass.
This takes a few seconds.
X To calibrate the compass: make sure that
there is sufficient space for you to drive in
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
236
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 236
Version: 3.0.3.6
Features
Loading, stowing and features
a circle without impeding the remaining
traffic.
In order to calibrate the compass correctly,
observe the following points:
Rcalibrate
the compass in the open and not
in the vicinity of steel structures or highvoltage power lines
Rswitch off electrical consumers such as
climate control, the windscreen wipers or
the rear window heating
Rclose all doors and the trunk lid
X Switch on the ignition.
X Press and hold button = for approximately
six seconds until the C symbol appears in
compass display ;.
X Drive a full circle at approximately 3 mph
(5 km/h) to 6 mph (10 km/h).
Once the calibration has been successfully
completed, the current heading appears in
compass display ;.
Floormat on the driver's side
G Warning!
Whenever you are using a floormat, make sure
there is enough clearance and that the
floormat is securely fastened.
The floormat should always be securely
fastened using the fastening equipment.
Before driving off, check that the floormat is
securely in place and adjust it if necessary. A
loose floormat could slip and hinder proper
functioning of the pedals.
Do not place several floormats on top of each
other as this may impair pedal movement.
X
Slide seat backwards.
To install: place the floormat in position.
X Press floormat eyelets : onto retainer
pins ;.
X
X
To remove: pull the floormats off
retainers ;.
X Remove the floormat.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 237
Version: 3.0.3.6
237
Vehicle equipment ............................
Engine compartment ........................
Maintenance ......................................
Care ....................................................
238
238
242
243
Maintenance and care
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
238
Engine compartment
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
Maintenance and care
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 238
Version: 3.0.3.6
Engine compartment
Hood
Opening the hood
G Warning
Do not pull the release lever while the vehicle
is in motion. Otherwise, the hood could be
forced open by passing air flow.
This could cause the hood to come loose and
injure you and/or others.
G Warning
Do not open the hood when the engine is
overheated. You could be seriously injured.
Observe the coolant temperature gauge to
determine whether the engine may be
overheated. If you see flames or smoke
coming from the engine compartment, move
away from the vehicle. Wait until the engine
has cooled. If necessary, call the fire
department.
G Warning
There is a risk of injury if the hood is open,
even if the engine is not running.
Some engine components can become very
hot.
To avoid the risk of burns, only touch those
components described in the Operator's
Manual and observe the relevant safety notes.
G Warning
To help prevent personal injury, stay clear of
moving parts when the hood is open and the
engine is running.
The radiator fan may continue to run for
approximately 30 seconds or may even
restart after the engine has been turned off.
Stay clear of fan blades.
G Warning
The engine is equipped with a transistorized
ignition system. Because of the high voltage,
it is dangerous to touch any components
(ignition coils, spark plug sockets, diagnostic
socket) of the ignition system:
Rwith
the engine running
starting the engine
Rwhen the ignition is switched on and the
engine is turned manually
Rwhile
X
Make sure that the windshield wipers are
switched off.
G Warning
The windshield wipers and wiper linkage
could be set in motion.
When the hood is open, you or others could
be injured by the wiper linkage.
Make sure that the windshield wipers are
switched off. Remove the SmartKey or make
sure that no ignition position has been
selected with KEYLESS-GO. All indicator
lamps must be off in the instrument cluster.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 239
Version: 3.0.3.6
Engine compartment
Pull release lever : on the hood.
The hood is released.
! Make sure that the windshield wipers are
not folded away from the windshield. You
could otherwise damage the windshield
wipers or the hood.
Engine oil
Notes on the oil level
Depending on the driving style, the vehicle
consumes up to 0.9 US qt (0.8 l) of oil over a
distance of 600 miles (1000 km). The oil
consumption may be higher than this when
the vehicle is new or if you frequently drive at
high engine speeds.
When checking the oil level:
Rpark
the vehicle on a level surface.
engine should be switched off for at
least five minutes if the engine is at normal
operating temperature.
Rthe engine should be switched off for at
least 30 minutes if it is not at normal
operating temperature (i.e. if you only start
the engine briefly).
Rthe
X
Reach into the gap, pull hood catch
handle ; up and lift the hood.
Closing the hood
Checking the oil level using the oil
dipstick
G Warning
When closing the hood, use extreme caution
not to catch hands or fingers. Be careful that
you do not close the hood on anyone.
Make sure the hood is securely engaged
before driving off. Do not continue driving if
the hood can no longer engage after an
accident, for example. The hood could
otherwise come loose while the vehicle is in
motion and injure you and/or others.
X
Lower the hood and let it fall from a height
of approximately 8 inches (20 cm).
X Check that the hood has engaged properly.
If the hood can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Open it again and close
it with a little more force.
X
Pull oil dipstick : out of the dipstick guide
tube.
X Wipe off oil dipstick :.
X Slowly insert oil dipstick : into the
dipstick guide tube to the stop, and take it
out again.
The oil level is correct if the level is between
MIN mark = and MAX mark ;.
X Add oil if necessary.
Z
Maintenance and care
X
239
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
240
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 240
Version: 3.0.3.6
Engine compartment
Adding engine oil
H Environmental note
When adding oil, take care not to spill any. If
oil enters the soil or waterways, it is harmful
to the environment.
Maintenance and care
! Only use engine oils and oil filters which
have been approved for vehicles with a
service system. A list of the engine oils and
oil filters that have been tested and
approved according to the Mercedes-Benz
specifications for service products can be
found on the Internet at http://
www.mbusa.com (USA only). Further
information on tested and approved engine
oils and oil filters can be obtained from any
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
The following causes engine failure or
damage to the exhaust system:
Rusing
engine oils and oil filters that are
not specifically approved for the service
system
Rreplacing the engine oil and oil filter later
than the specified replacement interval
required by the service system
Rusing engine oil additives
Engine oil cap (AMG vehicles)
X
Turn cap : counter-clockwise and remove
it.
X Add the amount of oil required.
Fill carefully to the maximum mark on the oil
dipstick.
i The difference in quantity between the
MIN mark and the MAX mark on the
dipstick is (depending on the engine)
approximately 1.6 to 2.1 US qt. (1.5 to 2 l).
! Do not add too much oil. If the oil level is
above the MAX mark on the dipstick, too
much oil has been added. This can lead to
damage to the engine or the catalytic
converter. Have excess oil siphoned off.
Further information on engine oil
(Y page 308).
X Replace cap : on the filler neck and
tighten clockwise.
Ensure that the cap locks into place
securely.
Checking and adding other service
products
Example: engine oil cap
Checking the coolant level
Only check the coolant level when the vehicle
is on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down.
X Turn the SmartKey to position
2(Y page 131) in the ignition lock.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 241
Version: 3.0.3.6
Engine compartment
G Warning
In order to avoid any potentially serious burns:
Ruse
extreme caution when opening the
hood if there are any signs of steam or
coolant leaking from the cooling system, or
if the coolant temperature display indicates
that the coolant is overheated.
Rdo not remove the pressure cap on the
coolant reservoir if the coolant temperature
is above 158 ‡ (70 †). Allow the engine to
cool down before removing the cap. The
coolant reservoir contains hot fluid and is
under pressure.
Rusing a rag, slowly turn the cap
approximately 1/2 turn to relieve excess
pressure. If opened immediately, scalding
hot fluid and steam will be blown out under
pressure.
Rdo not spill antifreeze on hot engine parts.
Antifreeze contains ethylene glycol which
may burn if it comes into contact with hot
engine parts.
X
Slowly turn cap : half a turn counterclockwise and allow excess pressure to
escape.
X Turn cap : further counter-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar
= in the filler neck when cold, there is
enough coolant in coolant expansion
tank ;.
If the coolant is approximately 0.6 in
(1.5 cm) higher when warm, there is
enough coolant in coolant expansion
tank ;.
X If necessary, add coolant which has been
tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
For further information on coolant, see
(Y page 310).
Windshield washer system/headlamp
cleaning system
The washer fluid reservoir is used for both the
windshield washer system and the headlamp
cleaning system.
G Warning
Washer solvent/antifreeze is highly
flammable. Do not spill washer solvent/
antifreeze on hot engine parts, because it may
ignite and burn. You could be seriously
burned.
! At temperatures below freezing, always
fill the washer fluid container with a mix of
windshield washer concentrate and
antifreeze additive. There is otherwise a
risk of damaging the windshield washer
system/headlamp cleaning system.
! Only use washer fluid concentrate which
is suitable for plastic lenses. Unsuitable
washer fluid concentrate could damage the
plastic lenses of the headlamps.
! Do not add distilled or de-ionized water to
the washer fluid container. Otherwise, the
Z
Maintenance and care
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button twice (Y page 132).
X Check the coolant temperature display in
the instrument cluster.
The coolant temperature must be below
158 ‡ (70 †).
241
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Maintenance
242
fluid level measuring gauge could be
damaged.
i Add windshield washer concentrate, e.g.
MB SummerFit, to the washer fluid all year
round.
Maintenance and care
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 242
Version: 3.0.3.6
Example: washer fluid reservoir
X
Mix the windshield washer fluid in a
container beforehand.
X At temperatures above freezing: fill the
washer fluid reservoir with a mix of water
and windshield washer concentrate (e.g.
MB SummerFit).
X At temperatures below freezing: fill the
washer fluid reservoir with a mix of water
and MB SummerFit windshield washer
concentrate. For information on the mixing
ratio, see (Y page 310) or use the premixed
windshield washer solution with antifreeze
available in specialist stores.
X
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
Add the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
X
Brake fluid level
! If you discover that the brake fluid level in
the brake fluid reservoir has fallen to the
MIN mark or below, check the brake
system for leaks immediately. Also check
the brake lining thickness. Contact a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
immediately.
Do not top up the brake fluid. This will not
rectify the malfunction.
Only check the brake fluid level when the
vehicle is stationary and on a level surface.
The brake fluid level is correct if it is between
MIN marking ; and MAX marking : on the
brake fluid reservoir.
Maintenance
Service interval display
Service messages
Information about the type of service and
service intervals (see separate Service
Booklet)
You can obtain more information at an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or at
www.mbusa.com (USA only).
The service interval display informs you of the
next service due date.
If a service is overdue, you will also hear a
warning tone.
The multifunction display shows a service
message for a few seconds, e.g.
Next Service A in .. mls
Service A due
Service A Exceeded By .. mls
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major
service. A number or another letter may be
displayed after the letter. This figure indicates
any necessary additional maintenance work
to be performed.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 243
Version: 3.0.3.6
Care
You can obtain further information at an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
The service interval display does not take into
account any periods of time during which the
battery is disconnected.
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
X
Before disconnecting the battery, call up
the service due date in the multifunction
display and note it down.
or
X
Subtract the battery disconnection periods
from the service date shown on the display
after reconnecting the battery.
Hiding the service message
X
Press % or a on the steering wheel.
Displaying the service message
X
Switch on the ignition.
Press = or ; to select the Service
menu on the steering wheel.
X Press 9 or : to select the ASSYST
PLUS submenu and press a to confirm.
The service due date appears in the
multifunction display.
X
Points to remember
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, will reset
the service interval display after the
necessary service work has been carried out.
You can obtain more information, e.g. on
maintenance work, at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center or directly at
Mercedes-Benz.
! If the service interval indicator has been
inadvertently reset, this setting can be
corrected at an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
Have the service work carried out as
described in the Service Booklet. There
may otherwise be increased wear, resulting
243
in damage to the vehicle or to the major
assemblies.
Care
Notes on care
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining the quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents
recommended and approved by MercedesBenz.
G Warning
Many cleaning products can be hazardous.
Some are poisonous, others are flammable.
Always follow the instructions on the
particular container. Always open your
vehicle's doors or windows when cleaning the
inside.
Never use fluids or solvents that are not
designed for cleaning your vehicle.
Always lock away cleaning products and keep
them out of reach of children.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any
of the following:
Rdry,
rough or hard cloths
cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective
films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice
scraper. You could otherwise scratch or
damage the surfaces and protective film.
Rabrasive
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible
manner.
! Do not park the vehicle for an extended
period right after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
Z
Maintenance and care
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
244
Care
brake pads/linings. Generally, park the
vehicle at operating temperature after
cleaning.
Exterior care
Automatic car wash
G Warning!
Maintenance and care
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 244
Version: 3.0.3.6
Braking efficiency is reduced after washing
the vehicle. This could cause an accident. For
this reason, you must drive particularly
carefully after washing the vehicle until the
brakes have dried.
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
! Never clean your vehicle in a Touchless
Automatic Car Wash as these use special
cleaning agents. These cleaning agents can
damage the paintwork or plastic parts.
If the vehicle is very dirty, pre-wash it before
cleaning it in an automatic car wash.
! In car washes with a towing mechanism,
make sure that the automatic transmission
is in transmission position N, otherwise the
vehicle could be damaged.
! Make sure that the side windows are
completely closed, that the ventilation/
heating is switched off and that the
windshield wiper switch is set to 0.
Otherwise, the rain/light sensor could be
activated, triggering unintended wiper
movements. This can cause damage to the
vehicle.
Also, clean the insides of the wheels when
washing the underbody of the vehicle.
X Do not use hot water and do not wash the
vehicle in direct sunlight.
X Use a soft car sponge for cleaning.
X Use a gentle cleaning agent, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz approved car shampoo.
X Wash down the vehicle with a gentle water
jet.
X Do not point the water jet directly at the air
inlets.
X Use plenty of water and rinse the sponge
frequently.
X Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry
it thoroughly with a chamois.
X Do not allow the cleaning agent to dry on
the paintwork.
Power washers
G Warning!
Do not use power washers with circular-jet
nozzles (dirt grinders) to clean your vehicle, in
particular the tires. You could otherwise
damage the tires and cause an accident.
! Keep the distance between the vehicle
and the nozzle of the power washer at
11.8 in (30 cm). Information about the
correct distance is available from the
equipment manufacturer.
Move the power washer nozzle around
when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtires
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off
wax from the windshield and the wiper
blades. This will prevent smears and reduce
wiping noises caused by residue on the
windshield.
Rdoor
joint
Washing by hand
Rseals
Carefully remove all deposits of road salt as
soon as possible when driving in winter.
Rventilation
Relectrical
components
Rbattery
Rconnectors
Rlights
Rtrim
elements
slots
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 245
Version: 3.0.3.6
Care
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
Cleaning the wheels
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park the vehicle for an extended
period right after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after
cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and
brake pads, thus drying them. The vehicle
can then be parked up.
Cleaning the paintwork
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected
by corrosion and damage caused by
inadequate care cannot always be completely
repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified
specialist workshop immediately, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
X Remove impurities immediately, where
possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse
off the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resin,
oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently
with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or
lighter fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
If water no longer forms "beads" on the
painted surface, paint care products should
be used that have been approved and
recommended by Mercedes-Benz. This is the
case approximately every three to five
months, depending on climatic conditions
and the care product used.
If dirt has entered the paint surface or the
paintwork has become dull, a paint cleaner
should be used that has been approved and
recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
Never use such care products in direct
sunlight or on a hot hood.
X Use a suitable touch-up stick, e.g. MB
Touch Up stick, for quick, temporary repair
of damaged paintwork.
Matte finish care
If your vehicle has a clear matte finish,
observe the following instructions in order to
avoid damage to the paintwork due to
incorrect care.
! Never polish the vehicle. Polishing causes
the finish to shine.
! Do not use paintwork cleaner, grinding or
polishing products or gloss preservers such
as wax. These products are only suitable for
high-gloss surfaces. Using them on
vehicles with matte paintwork can cause
severe damage to the surface (shiny,
mottled patches).
Always have paintwork repairs performed
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
i Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of recommended and
approved Mercedes-Benz care products.
Rfilms
Rmagnetic
plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Z
245
Maintenance and care
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 246
Version: 3.0.3.6
Care
246
Cleaning the windows
! Only fold the windshield wipers away from
the windshield when vertical. Otherwise,
you will damage the hood.
G Warning
Maintenance and care
Switch off the windshield wipers and remove
the SmartKey from the ignition lock before
cleaning the windshield or the wiper blades.
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button repeatedly until all
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster have
gone off. The windshield wipers could
otherwise move and injure you.
! Only fold the windshield wipers away from
the windshield when vertical. Otherwise,
you will damage the hood.
X
Clean the inside and outside of the
windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning
agent that is recommended and approved
by Mercedes-Benz.
! Do not pull the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and
do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the
graphite coating could be damaged. This
could cause wiper noise.
X
Fold the wiper arms away from the
windshield.
X Carefully clean the wiper blades with a
damp cloth.
X Fold the windshield wipers back again
before switching on the ignition.
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
back. The windshield could be damaged if
the wiper arm smacks against it suddenly.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing
solvents to clean the inside of the windows.
Do not use hard objects to clean the insides
of the windows, e.g. an ice scraper or ring.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
windows.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windshield and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain
circumstances prevent water from draining
away. This can lead to corrosion damage
and damage to electronic components.
Cleaning the wiper blades
G Warning
Switch off the windshield wipers and remove
the SmartKey from the ignition lock before
cleaning the windshield or the wiper blades.
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button repeatedly until all
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster have
gone off. The windshield wipers could
otherwise move and injure you.
Cleans the headlamps
X
Clean the plastic lamp lenses on the
headlamps using a wet sponge and a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car
shampoo or cleaning cloths.
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths which are suitable for plastic
headlamp lenses. Unsuitable cleaning
agents or cleaning cloths could scratch or
damage the plastic headlamp lenses.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 247
Version: 3.0.3.6
Care
Cleaning the sensors
247
Cleaning the exhaust tail pipes
Impurities combined with the effects of road
grit and corrosive environmental factors may
cause flash rust to form on the surface. You
can restore the original shine of the exhaust
tail pipe by cleaning it regularly, especially in
winter and after washing.
! Do not clean the exhaust tail pipes with
X
X
Clean the exhaust tail pipes with a chrome
care product tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
Interior care
Clean sensors : of the driving systems
with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
! When cleaning the sensors with a power
washer, maintain a distance between the
vehicle and the nozzle of the power washer
of at least 11.8 in (30 cm). Information
about the correct distance is available from
the equipment manufacturer.
Cleaning the rear view camera
Cleaning the display
X
Before cleaning the display, make sure that
it is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a
commercially-available microfiber cloth
and TFT/LCD display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry
microfiber cloth.
! For cleaning, do not use any of the
following:
Ralcohol-based
thinner or gasoline
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household
cleaning agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface
when cleaning. This could lead to
irreparable damage to the display.
Rabrasive
X
Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean
camera lens :.
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the rear view camera with a power
washer.
Cleaning the plastic trim
G Warning!
When cleaning the steering wheel boss and
dashboard, do not use cockpit sprays or
cleaning agents containing solvents. Cleaning
agents containing solvents cause the surface
to become porous, and as a result, plastic
Z
Maintenance and care
alkaline-based cleaning agents, such as
wheel cleaner.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Care
248
parts may break away and be thrown around
the interior when an air bag is deployed, which
may result in severe injuries.
! Do not affix the following to plastic
surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rscented
oil bottles or similar items
You can otherwise damage the plastic.
Maintenance and care
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 248
Version: 3.0.3.6
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent
or sunscreen to come into contact with the
plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality
look of the surfaces.
X
Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfiber cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change color temporarily.
Wait until the surface is dry again.
Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or
selector lever
X
Wash thoroughly with a damp cloth or use
a leather care agent that has been
recommended and approved by MercedesBenz.
Cleaning real wood and trim strips
X
Wipe the wooden trim and trim strips with
a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfiber
cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners,
polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk
of damaging the surface.
! Do not use chrome polish for trim strips.
The trim strips have a chrome look but are
mostly made of anodized aluminum and
can lose their shine if chrome polish is
used. Use a damp, lint-free cloth instead
when cleaning the trim strips.
Chrome polish can be used to remove very
heavy soiling from trim strips which you are
sure are made of chrome. If you are unsure
as to whether a trim strip is chrome-plated
or not, consult an authorized MercedesBenz Center.
Cleaning the seat covers
! Do not use microfiber cloths to clean
genuine leather, artificial leather or
Alcantara® covers. If used often, these can
damage the cover.
! Observe the following when cleaning:
Rclean
genuine leather covers carefully
with a damp cloth and then wipe the
covers down with a dry cloth. Make sure
that the leather does not become
soaked. It may otherwise become rough
and cracked. Only use leather care
agents that have been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. You can
obtain these from a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. an authorized MercedesBenz Center.
Rclean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. dish washing liquid).
Rclean cloth covers with a microfiber cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. dish washing liquid). Rub
carefully and always wipe entire seat
sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
Leave the seat to dry afterwards.
Cleaning results depend on the type of
dirt and how long it has been there.
Rclean Alcantara® covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure you wipe entire seat
sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
i Note that regular care is essential to
ensure that the appearance and comfort of
the covers is retained over time.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 249
Version: 3.0.3.6
Care
249
Cleaning the seat belts
X
Use clean, luke-warm water and soap
solution.
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts
by warming them above 176 ‡ (80 †) or
placing them in direct sunlight.
G Warning
Maintenance and care
Do not bleach or dye seat belts as this may
severely weaken them. In a crash, they may
not be able to provide adequate protection.
Cleaning the roof lining and carpets
X
Roof lining: use soft brushes or dry
shampoo if it is particularly dirty.
X
Carpets: use carpet and textile cleaners
that have been approved and
recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
250
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 250
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 251
Version: 3.0.3.6
251
Vehicle equipment ............................
After an accident ..............................
Where will I find...? ...........................
Flat tire ..............................................
Battery ...............................................
Jump-starting ....................................
Towing and tow-starting ..................
Fuses ..................................................
252
253
253
254
259
262
264
266
Breakdown assistance
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
252
Vehicle equipment
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
Breakdown assistance
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 252
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 253
Version: 3.0.3.6
Where will I find...?
253
After an accident
Fuel is leaking from the
vehicle.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of explosion or fire
The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty.
X Immediately turn the key to position 0(Y page 131)in the ignition
lock and remove it.
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
You are unable to
determine the extent of
the damage.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
You cannot detect any
damage.
X
Start the engine as normal.
The NECK-PRO head
restraints on the
driver's and frontpassenger seats have
been triggered.
Your vehicle has been involved in a rear-end collision.
X Reset the triggered NECK-PRO head restraints (Y page 50).
Where will I find...?
First-aid kit
Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the
first-aid kit is in an open stowage
compartment or behind the side paneling.
X Open the trunk lid.
Breakdown assistance
Problem
X
To open the stowage well: turn rotary
knob : in the direction of the arrow and
fold down cover ;.
X Remove the first-aid kit.
i Check the expiration date on the first-aid
kit at least once a year. Replace the
contents if necessary, and replace missing
contents.
Vehicle tool kit
The vehicle tool kit can be found in the
stowage well under the trunk floor.
i Vehicles without a spare wheel are not
equipped with the tools needed to change
a wheel when they leave the factory, e.g.
jack or lug wrench. Some tools for changing
a wheel are specific to the vehicle. To
obtain tools approved for your vehicle, visit
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 254
Version: 3.0.3.6
Flat tire
254
a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
X
Lift the trunk floor upwards (Y page 219).
X
Turn stowage well ; counter-clockwise
and remove it.
X Remove "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel :.
For further information on changing a wheel
and mounting the spare wheel, see
(Y page 255).
Flat tire
Breakdown assistance
Preparing the vehicle
: Vehicle tool kit tray
; Stowage well
= Spare wheel/"Minispare" emergency
Your vehicle could be equipped with a
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel or the
MOExtended run-flat system(Y page 259).
i Vehicle preparation is not necessary on
vehicles with the MOExtended run-flat
system.
spare wheel
The vehicle tool kit contains:
RFoldable
wheel chock
RFuse allocation chart
RJack
ROne pair of gloves
RLug wrench
RTowing eye
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel
The "Minispare" emergency spare wheel can
be found in the stowage well under the trunk
floor.
X Lift the trunk floor upwards (Y page 219).
X
Stop the vehicle as far away as possible
from traffic on solid, non-slippery and level
ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Firmly depress the parking brake.
X Bring the front wheels into the straightahead position.
X
Vehicles with manual transmission:
engage first or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
move the selector lever to P.
X
X
Switch off the engine.
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the
driver's door.
The on-board electronics have status 0,
which is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 132).
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 255
Version: 3.0.3.6
Flat tire
All occupants must get out of the vehicle.
Make sure that they are not endangered as
they get out of the vehicle.
X Make sure that no one is near the danger
area whilst a wheel is being changed.
Anyone who is not directly assisting in the
wheel change should, for example, stand
behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to
traffic conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
Changing a wheel and mounting the
spare wheel
Preparing the vehicle
G Warning!
The wheel and tire size of the emergency
spare wheel/spare wheel may differ to that of
the damaged wheel. When using an
emergency spare wheel/spare wheel the
handling characteristics of the vehicle may
change.
Adapt your style of driving accordingly.
Never operate the vehicle with more than one
emergency spare wheel/spare wheel that
differs in size.
Only use an emergency spare wheel/spare
wheel of a differing size briefly and do not
switch off ESP®.
When using an emergency spare wheel, you
must not exceed a maximum speed of 50 mph
(80 km/h).
G Warning!
Have the emergency spare wheel/spare
wheel replaced with a new wheel as soon as
possible at a qualified specialist workshop
which has the necessary specialist knowledge
and tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this
purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety
or on safety-related systems must be carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
i Vehicles without an emergency spare
wheel/spare wheel are not equipped with
wheel-changing tools at the factory. For
more information on which tools are
required to perform a wheel change on your
vehicle, e.g. wheel chock, alignment bolt or
lug wrench, consult an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
X
Prepare the vehicle as described
(Y page 254).
X Remove the following items from the
stowage well under the trunk/cargo
compartment floor:
Rthe emergency spare wheel
Rthe vehicle tool kit
Rthe folding wheel chock
Rthe jack
X
Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
Securing the vehicle to prevent it from
rolling away
G Warning
Only jack up the vehicle on level ground or on
slight inclines/declines. The vehicle could
otherwise fall off the jack and injure you or
others.
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock,
it can be found in the vehicle tool kit
(Y page 253).
The folding wheel chock is an additional
securing measure to prevent the vehicle from
rolling away, for example when changing a
wheel.
Z
Breakdown assistance
X
255
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 256
Version: 3.0.3.6
Flat tire
256
Raising the vehicle
G Warning
X
Fold both plates upwards :.
Fold out lower plate ;.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
openings in base plate =.
Breakdown assistance
X
Securing the vehicle on level ground
X
On level ground: place chocks or other
suitable items under the front and rear of
the wheel that is diagonally opposite the
wheel you wish to change.
Securing the vehicle on slight downhill gradients
X
On downhill gradients: place chocks or
other suitable items in front of the wheels
of the front and rear axle.
When jacking up the vehicle, only use the jack
which has been specifically approved by
Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle.
The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up
the vehicle at the jacking points built into both
sides of the vehicle. The jack saddle must be
placed centrally under the jacking point. The
jack must always be vertical when in use,
especially on inclines or declines.
The jack is intended only for lifting the vehicle
briefly for wheel changes. It is not suited for
performing maintenance work under the
vehicle. To help avoid personal injury, use the
jack only to lift the vehicle during a wheel
change.
Never get beneath the vehicle while it is
supported by the jack. Keep hands and feet
away from the area under the lifted vehicle.
Always lower the vehicle onto sufficient
capacity jackstands before working under the
vehicle.
Always firmly engage the parking brake and
block the wheels with wheel chocks or other
sizable objects before raising the vehicle with
the jack. Do not disengage the parking brake
while the vehicle is raised.
Make sure that the ground on which the
vehicle is standing and where you place the
jack is solid, level and not slippery. If
necessary, use a large underlay. On slippery
surfaces, such as tiled floors, you should use
a non-slip underlay, for example a rubber mat.
Do not use wooden blocks or similar objects
as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the jack may
not be able to achieve its load-bearing
capacity if it is not at its full height.
Never start the engine when the vehicle is
raised.
Also observe the notes on the jack.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 257
Version: 3.0.3.6
Flat tire
X
Using lug wrench :, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts
completely.
X
Position jack = at jacking point ;.
The jacking points for the jack are located
behind the wheel housings of the front wheels
and in front of the wheel housings of the rear
wheels (arrows).
X
G Warning
The jack is designed exclusively for jacking up
the vehicle at the jacking points. The jack
saddle must be placed centrally under the
jacking point.
If you do not position the jack correctly in the
jacking point, the vehicle can fall off the jack
and seriously or fatally injure you or others.
! The jack is designed exclusively for
jacking up the vehicle at the jacking points.
Otherwise, your vehicle could be damaged.
Make sure that the base of the jack is
positioned directly under the jacking point.
X Turn crank ? clockwise until jack = sits
completely on jacking point ; and the
base of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn crank ? until the tire is raised a
maximum of 1.2 inches (3 cm) off the
ground.
Removing a wheel
X
Unscrew the wheel bolts.
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or on a
dirty surface. The bolt and wheel hub
threads could otherwise be damaged when
you screw them in.
X
257
Remove the wheel.
Z
Breakdown assistance
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 258
Version: 3.0.3.6
Flat tire
258
Mounting a new wheel
X
Breakdown assistance
G Warning!
Always replace wheel bolts that are damaged
or rusted.
Never apply oil or grease to wheel bolts.
Damaged wheel hub threads should be
repaired immediately. Do not continue to
drive under these circumstances! Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call
Roadside Assistance.
Incorrect wheel bolts or improperly tightened
wheel bolts can cause the wheel to come off.
This could cause an accident. Make sure to
use the correct wheel bolts.
Tighten the wheel bolts until they are
finger-tight.
Lowering the vehicle
X
Turn the crank of the jack counterclockwise until the vehicle is once again
standing firmly on the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
G Warning
Only use genuine Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts.
Other wheel bolts may come loose.
Do not tighten the wheel bolts when the
vehicle is raised. Otherwise, the vehicle could
fall off the jack.
G Warning
Make sure to use the original length wheel
bolts when remounting the original wheel
after it has been repaired.
X
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
! To prevent damage to the paintwork, hold
X
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a
crosswise pattern in the sequence
indicated (: to A). The tightening torque
must be 96 lb-ft (130 Nm).
G Risk of accident
Have the tightening torque checked
immediately after a wheel is changed. The
wheels could come loose if they are not
tightened to a torque of 96 lb-ft (130 Nm).
X
Turn the jack back to its initial position and
store it together with the rest of the vehicle
tool kit in the trunk/cargo compartment.
X
Transport the faulty wheel in the trunk/
cargo compartment.
the wheel securely against the wheel hub
while screwing in the first wheel bolt.
or
X
X
Place the emergency spare wheel on the
wheel hub and push it on.
Depending on the size of the wheel, you
may also be able to secure the faulty wheel
in the spare wheel well. In this case, you
will have to remove the stowage well casing
from the spare wheel well and stow it
securely in the trunk/cargo compartment.
i When you are driving with the collapsible
spare wheel mounted, the tire pressure
loss warning system or the tire pressure
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 259
Version: 3.0.3.6
Battery
monitor cannot function reliably. Only
restart the tire pressure loss warning
system/tire pressure monitor when the
defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with tire pressure monitor: all
mounted wheels must be equipped with
functioning sensors and the defective
wheel should no longer be in the vehicle.
MOExtended run-flat system
The MOExtended run-flat system allows you
to drive on even if there is a complete loss of
pressure in one or more tires.
The MOExtended run-flat system may only be
used in conjunction with the activated tire
pressure loss warning system or with the
activated tire pressure monitor.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode depends on the
cargo in the vehicle. You can drive 50 miles
(80 km) if the vehicle is partially laden and
18 miles (30 km) if it is fully laden.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode is counted from
the moment the tire pressure loss warning
appears in the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
50 mph(80 km/h).
G Warning!
The handling characteristics of your vehicle
deteriorate in run-flat mode, for example:
Rwhen
cornering
Rwhen braking
Rwhen accelerating rapidly
Adapt your driving style accordingly and avoid
sudden changes in direction and sudden
acceleration, as well as driving over obstacles
(i.e. curbs, potholes), and driving off-road.
This is particularly the case when the vehicle
is heavily laden.
The maximum permissible distance that can
be driven in run-flat mode depends to a large
259
extent on the loads placed on the vehicle. It
can be shorter due to high speeds, a heavy
cargo, sudden changes in direction, the road
surface condition, outside temperature, etc.,
or further if you drive carefully and
conservatively.
Do not continue to drive in run-flat mode if:
Ryou
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
Rthe
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tire.
After driving in run-flat mode, you must have
the wheel(s) checked for damage at a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required. The faulty tire
must be replaced in every case.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for this
purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety
or on safety-related systems must be carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rthere
i When replacing one or all tires, make sure
that you only use tires marked
MOExtended and of the specified size for
the vehicle.
Battery
Important safety notes
In order for the battery to achieve the
maximum possible service life, it must always
be sufficiently charged.
! Have the battery checked regularly at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Observe the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or for further information consult a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Have the battery charge checked more
frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for
Z
Breakdown assistance
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
260
Battery
short trips or if you leave it standing idle for
a lengthy period.
To prevent damage from corrosion, only
replace the battery with one that has a central
ventilation cover.
Only replace a battery with a battery that has
been recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
Consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
if you wish to leave your vehicle parked up for
a long period of time.
G Warning
Breakdown assistance
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 260
Version: 3.0.3.6
Comply with safety precautions and take
protective measures when handling batteries.
Risk of explosion
Fire, naked flames and
smoking are prohibited
when handling the battery.
Avoid creating sparks.
Battery acid is caustic.
Avoid contact with the skin,
eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective
clothing, in particular
gloves, an apron and a face
mask.
Immediately rinse acid
splashes off with clean
water. Consult a doctor if
necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
Observe this Operator's
Manual.
H Environmental note
Do not dispose of batteries in the household
rubbish. Dispose of defective batteries in an
environmentally responsible manner. Take
them to an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
or to a special collection point for old
batteries.
G Warning
Failure to follow these instructions can result
in severe injury or death.
Never lean over batteries while connecting.
You might get injured.
Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not
allow this fluid to come in contact with eyes,
skin or clothing. In case it does, immediately
flush affected area with water and seek
medical help if necessary.
A battery will also produce hydrogen gas,
which is flammable and explosive. Keep
flames or sparks away from battery, avoid
improper connection of jumper cables,
smoking etc.
G Warning
Do not place any metal objects on the battery
as this could result in a short circuit.
Use leak-proof batteries only to avoid the risk
of acid burns in the event of an accident.
Take care that you do not become statically
charged, e.g. by wearing synthetic clothing or
rubbing against textiles. For this reason, you
also should not pull or push the battery over
carpets or other synthetic materials.
Never touch the battery first. First, touch the
outside body of the vehicle in order to release
any possible electrostatic charges.
Do not rub the battery with rags or cloths. The
battery could explode if touched due to
electrostatic charge or due to spark
formation.
! Switch off the engine and remove the key
before disconnecting the terminal clamps
from the battery. On vehicles with
KEYLESS-GO, make sure that the ignition is
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 261
Version: 3.0.3.6
Battery
switched off. Check that all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster are off. You
may otherwise destroy electronic
components, such as the alternator.
! Like other batteries, the vehicle battery
may discharge over time if you do not use
the vehicle. In this case, have the battery
disconnected at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. an authorized MercedesBenz Center. You can also charge the
battery with a charger recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Contact an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center for further
information.
The battery, breather hose and cover of the
positive terminal clamp must be installed
securely during operation.
i Remove the key if you park the vehicle
and do not require any electrical
consumers. The vehicle will then use very
little energy, thus conserving battery
power.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you do not
carry out work on batteries yourself, e.g.
removing, charging or replacing. Always have
this work performed at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
i If the power supply has been interrupted,
e.g. if the battery has been reconnected,
you must carry out the following tasks:
the clock (Y page 179).
Rreset the function for automatically
folding the exterior mirrors in/out by
folding the mirrors out once
(Y page 100).
Rset
Charging the battery
G Warning
Never charge a battery while still installed in
the vehicle unless the accessory battery
charge unit approved by Mercedes-Benz is
being used. Gases may escape during
261
charging and cause explosions that may
result in paint damage, corrosion or personal
injury.
An accessory battery charge unit specially
adapted for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and
tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz is
available. It permits the charging of the
battery in its installed position. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for
information and availability.
Charge the battery in accordance with the
separate instructions for the accessory
battery charger.
G Warning!
There is a risk of acid burns during the
charging process due to the gases which
escape from the battery. Do not lean over the
battery during the charging process.
G Warning!
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the
skin, eyes or clothing.
! Only charge the installed battery with a
battery charger which has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. These battery
chargers allow the battery to be charged
while still installed.
! Only use battery chargers with a
maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jumpstarting connection point.
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment (Y page 262).
X Open the hood (Y page 238).
X Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order
as when connecting the donor battery in
the jump-starting procedure
(Y page 262).
Z
Breakdown assistance
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 262
Version: 3.0.3.6
Jump-starting
262
Jump-starting
Breakdown assistance
G Warning
Failure to follow these directions will cause damage to the electronic components, and can lead
to a battery explosion and severe injury or death.
Never lean over batteries while connecting or jump starting. You might get injured.
Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do not allow this fluid to come in contact with eyes, skin or
clothing. In case it does, immediately flush affected area with water, and seek medical help if
necessary.
A battery will also produce hydrogen gas, which is flammable and explosive. Keep flames or
sparks away from battery, avoid improper connection of jumper cables, smoking, etc.
Attempting to jump start a frozen battery can result in it exploding, causing personal injury.
Read all instructions before proceeding.
! Avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may
damage the catalytic converter31 and create a risk of fire.
Do not use a rapid-charging device to start the engine.
Make sure the jumper cables are not damaged.
Make sure the jumper cables are not touching any other metal objects when they are
connected to the battery.
If your vehicle's battery is discharged, the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle
or from a second battery using jumper cables.
Observe the following points:
X The battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible,
jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
X Only jump-start the vehicle when the engine is cold and the catalytic converter system has
cooled down32 .
X Do not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
X Jump-starting may only be performed from batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
If you jump-start using a battery with higher voltage, it may damage the electrical systems
of the vehicle.
X Only use jumper cables which have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps.
X Make sure that the jumper cables cannot come into contact with parts, such as the pulley
or the fan. These parts move when the engine is started and while it is running.
X If the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected
for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the battery a little.
i Jumper cables and further information about jump-starting can be obtained from any
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
X
X
Make sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Apply the parking brake firmly.
31 Only
32 Only
vehicles with a gasoline engine.
vehicles with a gasoline engine.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 263
Version: 3.0.3.6
Jump-starting
263
X
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jumpstarting device.
! Never swap the terminal connections.
X
Slide cover : of positive terminal ; in the direction of the arrow.
Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B
using the jumper cable, beginning with your own battery.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
X Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using
the jumper cable, connecting the jumper cable to donor battery B first.
X Start the engine.
X First remove the jumper cable from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from
positive terminal ; and positive terminal =, each time disconnecting from the battery on
your own vehicle first.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized MercedesBenz Center.
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
Manual transmission: engage neutral.
X Automatic transmission: move the selector lever to P.
X Switch off all electrical consumers (e.g. radio, blower etc.).
X Open the hood (Y page 238).
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
264
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 264
Version: 3.0.3.6
Towing and tow-starting
Towing and tow-starting
! On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use the
SmartKey instead of the Start/Stop
button. Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in
the ignition lock and shift the automatic
transmission to N. Then, turn the SmartKey
back to 0 and leave it in the ignition lock.
Important safety notes
Breakdown assistance
G Warning
If you tow the vehicle, you must use a rigid
towing bar if:
Rthe engine will not run.
Rthere is a malfunction in the brake system.
Rthere is a malfunction in the power supply
or the vehicle's electrical system.
With the engine not running, there is no power
assistance for the brake and steering
systems. You will then need considerably
more force to steer and to brake and the
brake pedal travel will be longer. If necessary,
depress the brake pedal with maximum force.
Before towing away, make sure that the
steering can be moved and is not locked.
If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
weight must not exceed the maximum
permissible gross vehicle weight of your
vehicle.
It is better to have the vehicle transported
than to have it towed.
! Vehicles with automatic transmission
must not be started by tow-starting. This
could otherwise damage the transmission.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
with the front or rear axle raised. This could
otherwise damage the transmission.
The automatic transmission must be in
position N while the vehicle is being towed.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise:
Ryou will not be able to turn the SmartKey to
position 2 in the ignition lock.
will not be able to shift the automatic
transmission to position N.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
manually release the selector lever lock in
position P(Y page 144).
Ryou
i Switch the automatic lock (Y page 181)
off before towing. Otherwise, you could
lock yourself out of the vehicle when
pushing or towing the vehicle.
! You may only tow the vehicle a maximum
distance of 30 miles (50 km). A towing
speed of 30 mph (50 km/h) must not be
exceeded.
For towing distances over 30 miles
(50 km), the vehicle must loaded onto a
transporter.
! Only secure the tow rope or tow bar at the
towing eyes. Otherwise, the vehicle could
be damaged.
! Do not use the towing eye for recovery,
as this could damage the vehicle. If in
doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane.
! Drive slowly and smoothly when towing.
Excessive tractive power could otherwise
damage the vehicles.
! Do not tow with sling-type equipment.
This could damage the vehicle.
Installing/removing the towing eye
Installing the towing eye
X
Remove the towing eye from the vehicle
tool kit (Y page 253).
G Warning
The exhaust tail pipe may be hot. You could
burn yourself if you touch the tail pipe. Be
particularly careful when removing the rear
cover.
The mountings for the removable towing eyes
are located in the bumpers. They are at the
front and at the rear, behind the covers.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 265
Version: 3.0.3.6
Towing and tow-starting
265
X
Switch on the hazard warning flashers
(Y page 109).
X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the
ignition lock and remove the SmartKey.
X When leaving the vehicle, take the
SmartKey or the KEYLESS-GO key with you.
Towing vehicles with both axles on
the ground
G Warning
X
Press the mark on cover : inwards, in the
direction of the arrow.
X
Take cover : off the opening.
Screw in and tighten the towing eye
clockwise to the stop.
X
Removing the towing eye
X
Unscrew and remove the towing eye.
X
Attach cover : to the bumper and press
until it engages.
X Place the towing eye in the vehicle tool kit.
Towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised
Only possible for vehicles without
4MATIC.
When having your vehicle towed with the rear
axle raised, observe the important safety
notes (Y page 264).
! The ignition must be switched off if you
are towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could
otherwise damage the brake system.
With the engine not running, there is no power
assistance for the brake and steering
systems. In this case, it is important to keep
in mind that a considerably higher degree of
effort is necessary to brake and steer the
vehicle. Adapt your driving accordingly.
X
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and hold it down.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to neutral.
or
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to
position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the parking brake.
X Switch on the hazard warning flashers
(Y page 109).
i When towing with the hazard warning
flashers switched on, use the combination
switch as usual to signal in which direction
you are changing. In this case, only the
indicator lamps for the direction of travel
flash. When you reset the combination
switch, the hazard warning flashers start
flashing again.
Z
Breakdown assistance
When having your vehicle towed, observe the
important safety notes (Y page 264).
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Fuses
266
Transporting the vehicle
The towing eye can be used to pull the vehicle
onto a trailer or transporter for transporting
purposes.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to neutral.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Shift the selector lever to N.
As soon as the vehicle has been loaded:
Breakdown assistance
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 266
Version: 3.0.3.6
X
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by
applying the parking brake.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to first gear or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
move the selector lever to P.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the
ignition lock and remove the SmartKey.
X Secure the vehicle.
! Only lash the vehicle down by the wheels
or wheel rims, not by parts of the vehicle
such as axle or steering components.
Otherwise, the vehicle could be damaged.
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
When tow-starting, observe the important
safety notes (Y page 264).
! Vehicles with an automatic transmission
must not be tow-started. You could
otherwise damage the automatic
transmission.
Before tow-starting:
Rthe
battery must be connected
engine must be cold
Rthe catalytic converter must be cold
X Switch on the hazard warning
lamps(Y page 109).
X Install the towing eye (Y page 264).
Rthe
X
Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Depress and hold the clutch pedal.
X Shift to neutral.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Shift to second gear.
X Tow-start the vehicle.
X Release the clutch pedal slowly and do not
depress the accelerator pedal when doing
so.
The engine is started.
X Depress the clutch pedal and shift to
neutral.
X Engage the parking brake.
X Stop the vehicle in a suitable location to
remove the tow bar or the tow rope.
X Remove the towing eye (Y page 265).
X Switch off the hazard warning lamps.
Fuses
Important safety notes
The fuses in your vehicle serve to close down
faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the
components on the circuit and their functions
will fail.
G Warning
Only use fuses approved by Mercedes-Benz
with the specified amperage for the system in
question and do not attempt to repair or
bridge a blown fuse. Using other than
approved fuses or using repaired or bridged
fuses may cause an overload leading to a fire,
and/or cause damage to electrical
components and/or systems. Have the cause
determined and remedied by an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognize by
the color and value. The fuse ratings are listed
in the fuse allocation chart. An authorized
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 267
Version: 3.0.3.6
Fuses
267
Mercedes-Benz Center will be happy to
advise you.
i If a fuse has blown, visit a breakdown
service or an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Otherwise, components or
systems could be damaged.
X
To open: pull out cover : slightly at the
bottom in the direction of arrow =.
X Pull cover : outwards in the direction of
arrow ; and remove it.
X
Before changing a fuse
X
Park the vehicle and apply the parking
brake.
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
Rfuse
box on the driver's side of the
dashboard
Rfuse box in the engine compartment on the
left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel
Rfuse box in the trunk on the right when
viewed in the direction of travel
The fuse allocation chart is located in the
vehicle tool kit (Y page 253) in the stowage
compartment under the trunk floor.
To close: clip in cover : on the front of
the dashboard.
X Fold cover : inwards until it engages.
Fuse box in the engine compartment
X
Make sure that the windshield wipers are
turned off.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that the windshield wipers are
turned off and the key is pulled out of the
ignition lock before you open the cover of the
fuse box. Otherwise, the windshield wipers
and the wiper rods above the cover could be
set in motion. This could lead to you or others
being injured by the wiper rods.
X
Open the hood (Y page 238).
Fuse box in the dashboard
! Do not use a pointed object such as a
screwdriver to open the cover in the
dashboard. You could damage the
dashboard or the cover.
Z
Breakdown assistance
! Only use fuses that have been approved
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Fuses
268
X
Remove any existing moisture from the
fuse box using a dry cloth.
X Take lines ; from the guides.
X To open: open clamps :.
X Remove the fuse box cover forwards.
X
Breakdown assistance
To close: check whether the rubber seal is
lying correctly in the cover.
X Insert the cover at the rear of the fuse box
into the retainer.
X Fold down the cover and close clamps :.
X Secure lines ; in the guides.
! The cover must be seated properly,
otherwise moisture or dirt could impair the
function of the fuses.
X
Close the hood (Y page 239).
Fuse box in the trunk
X
X
Open the trunk lid.
To open: turn rotary catch : clockwise.
X Open cover ; downwards in the direction
of the arrow.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 268
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 269
Version: 3.0.3.6
269
Vehicle equipment ............................
Important safety notes ....................
Directives to be observed ................
Maintenance and care of wheels
and tires .............................................
Tire pressures ...................................
Loading the vehicle ..........................
Maximum tire load ............................
Direction of rotation .........................
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards ..........................................
Interchanging the wheels ................
Tire labeling .......................................
Definitions for tires and loading ......
Wheel/tire combinations .................
270
270
271
271
272
280
284
284
284
286
286
290
293
Tires and wheels
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
270
Important safety notes
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
Important safety notes
Tires and wheels
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 270
Version: 3.0.3.6
Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
if you require information on tested and
recommended tires and wheels for summer
and winter driving. Advice on purchasing and
caring for tires is also available there.
G Warning
Replace rims or tires with the same
designation, manufacturer and type as shown
on the original part. For further information
contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
If incorrectly sized rims and tires are
mounted, the wheel brakes or suspension
components can be damaged. Also, the
operating clearance of the wheels and the
tires may no longer be correct.
G Warning
Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the tire
tread is worn to minimum tread depth, or if
the tires have sustained damage, replace
them.
When replacing rims, only use genuine
Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts specified for the
particular rim type. Failure to do so can result
in the bolts loosening and possibly an
accident.
Retreaded tires are not tested or
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since
previous damage cannot always be
recognized on retreads. The operating safety
of the vehicle cannot be assured when such
tires are used.
G Warning
If you feel a sudden significant vibration or
ride disturbance, or you suspect that possible
damage to your vehicle has occurred, you
should turn on the hazard warning flashers,
carefully slow down, and drive with caution to
an area which is a safe distance from the road.
Inspect the tires and the vehicle underbody
for possible damage. If the vehicle appears
unsafe, have the vehicle towed to the nearest
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or tire
dealer for repairs.
G Warning
Do not drive with a flat tire. A flat tire affects
the ability to steer or brake the vehicle. You
might lose control of the vehicle. Continued
driving with a flat tire or driving at high speed
with a flat tire will cause excessive heat buildup and possibly a fire.
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you only use tires,
wheels and accessories which have been
approved by Mercedes-Benz specifically
for your vehicle. These tires have been
specially adapted for use with the control
systems, such as ABS or ESP®, and are
marked as follows:
RMO = Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tires with run-flat characteristics)
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (AMG)
Only use Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
tires on wheels that have been specifically
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
If you use other tires, wheels and
accessories, Mercedes-Benz cannot
accept any responsibility for damage that
may result from this. Further information
about tires, wheels and approved
combinations can be obtained from any
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
i Further information about tires and
wheels can be obtained from any
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 271
Version: 3.0.3.6
Maintenance and care of wheels and tires
Directives to be observed
ROnly
mount tires and wheels of the same
type and make.
ROnly mount tires of the correct size onto
the wheels.
RAfter mounting new tires, run them in at
moderate speeds for the first 60 miles
(100 km) as they only reach their full
performance after this distance.
RDo not use tires until they are excessively
worn as the tire traction on wet road
surfaces decreases significantly when the
tread depth is less than 1/8 in (3 mm).
RIf the vehicle is heavily laden, check the tire
pressure and adjust it if necessary.
parking your vehicle, make sure that
the tires do not get deformed by the curb
or other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive
over curbs, speed humps or similar
elevations, try to do so slowly and at an
obtuse angle. Otherwise, the tires,
particularly the sidewalls, can get
damaged.
RWhen
Damaged wheels can cause a loss of tire
pressure.
RRegularly check the tire tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the whole
width of the tire (Y page 271). If necessary,
turn the front wheels to full lock in order to
inspect the inner side of the tire surface.
RAll wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not
install anything on the valve (such as tire
pressure monitoring systems) other than
the standard valve cap or other valve caps
approved by Mercedes-Benz for your
vehicle.
RRegularly check the pressure of all the tires
including the emergency spare wheel or the
spare wheel, particularly prior to long trips,
and correct the pressure as necessary
(Y page 272).
Service life of tires
The service life of tires depends on the
following factors amongst other things:
Rdriving
Maintenance and care of wheels and
tires
Checking wheels and tires
G Warning
Regularly check the tires for damage.
Damaged tires can cause tire inflation
pressure loss. As a result, you could lose
control of your vehicle.
Worn, old tires can cause accidents. If the tire
tread is worn to minimum tread depth, or if
the tires have sustained damage, replace
them.
RRegularly
check the wheels and tires of
your vehicle for damage (e.g. cuts,
punctures, tears, bulges on tires and
deformation or cracks or severe corrosion
on wheels), at least once a month, as well
as after driving off-road or on rough roads.
style
pressure
Rmileage
Replace the tires after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear. This also applies to the
emergency spare wheel/spare wheel.
Rtire
Tire tread
G Warning
Although the applicable federal motor vehicle
safety laws consider a tire to be worn when
the tread wear indicators (TWI) become
visible at approximately 1/16 in (1.6 mm), we
recommend that you do not allow your tires
to wear down to that level. As tread depth
approaches 1/8 in (3 mm), the adhesion
properties on a wet road are sharply reduced.
Z
271
Tires and wheels
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
272
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 272
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire pressures
Depending upon the weather and/or road
surface (conditions), the tire traction varies
widely.
Do not use tires until they are excessively
worn as the tire traction on wet road surfaces
decreases significantly when the tread depth
is less than 1/8 in (3 mm).
Tires and wheels
Tread wear indicators (TWI) are required by
law. Six indicators are positioned over the tire
tread. They are visible as soon as a tread
depth of approximately 1/16 in (1.6 mm) is
reached. If this is the case, the tire is so worn
that it must be replaced.
The recommended tread depth for summer
tires is at least 1/8 in (3 mm). The
recommended tread depth for winter tires is
at least 1/6 in (4 mm).
Bar marking : for tread wear is integrated
into the tire tread.
Storing tires
Store tires that are not being used in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place. Protect the
tires from contact with oil, grease and fuel.
Cleaning tires
G Warning
Do not use power washers with circular jet
nozzles (concentrated-power jets) to clean
your vehicle, especially for cleaning tires. You
could otherwise damage the tires and cause
an accident.
Tire pressures
Recommended tire pressures
G Warning
Follow recommended tire inflation pressures.
Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires
wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely
affect handling and fuel economy, and are
more likely to fail from being overheated.
Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can
adversely affect handling and ride comfort,
wear unevenly, increase stopping distance,
and result in sudden deflation (blowout)
because they are more likely to become
punctured or damaged by road debris,
potholes etc.
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified load limit as indicated on the Tire
and Loading Information placard on the
driver's door B-pillar. Overloading the tires
can overheat them, possibly causing a
blowout. Overloading the tires can also result
in handling or steering problems, or brake
failure.
You will find a table of recommended tire
pressures on the Tire and Loading
Information placard on the B-pillar on the
driver's side (Y page 280). You will find a
table of tire pressures for various operating
conditions on the inside of your vehicle's fuel
filler flap.
Use a suitable pressure gauge. The outer
appearance of a tire does not permit any
reliable conclusion about the tire pressure.
On vehicles equipped with the electronic tire
pressure monitor, the tire pressure can be
checked using the on-board computer.
G Warning
Should the tire pressure drop repeatedly:
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 273
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire pressures
Rcheck
273
the tire for foreign bodies.
Rcheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
sure that only a valve cap approved
by Mercedes-Benz is installed on the tire
valve.
Tire pressures that are too low have a
negative effect on vehicle safety, which could
lead you to cause an accident.
Rmake
i The specifications given on the following
Tire and Loading Information placard are
examples. Tire pressure specifications are
vehicle-specific and may deviate from the
data shown here. The tire pressure
specifications for your vehicle can be found
on the Tire and Loading Information placard
of your vehicle.
You will find recommended tire pressure
specifications : for cold tires and for a fully
loaded vehicle on the Tire and Loading
Information placard. The tire pressure
specifications apply to tires which are
installed at the factory.
Important notes on tire pressures
G Warning
If the tire pressure drops repeatedly, check
the tires for punctures from foreign objects
and/or whether air is leaking from the valves
or from around the rim.
The temperature and pressure of the tires
increase when the vehicle is in motion. This
is dependent on the driving speed and the
load.
If you wish to drive at high speeds of
100 mph (160 km/h) or higher when this is
allowed, use the tire pressure table on the
inside of the fuel filler flap to set the correct
tire pressures when the wheels are cold. If the
tire pressure is not set correctly, this can lead
to an excessive build up of heat and a sudden
loss of pressure.
For more information, contact a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
i Ride comfort may be affected if the tire
pressure is adjusted to the recommended
value for speeds of over
100 mph(160 km/h).
Z
Tires and wheels
Only correct tire pressures when the tires are
cold. The tires are cold when the vehicle has
been parked for at least three hours or driven
for less than 1 mile (1.6 km). The tire
temperature changes depending on the
outside temperature, the vehicle speed and
the tire load. If the tire temperature changes
by 18 ‡ (10 †), the tire pressure changes by
approximately 10 kPa (0.1 bar/1.5 psi). Take
this into account when checking the pressure
of warm tires and only correct the tire
pressure if it is too low for the current
operating conditions. If you check the tire
pressure when the tires are warm, the reading
will be higher than if the tires were cold. This
is normal. Do not reduce the tire pressure to
the value specified for cold tires. The tire
pressure would otherwise be too low.
Observe the recommended tire pressure
specifications for cold tires on the Tire and
Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on
the driver's side.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
274
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 274
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire pressures
Make sure that the tire pressure for normal
speeds is adopted again.
Additional specifications of tire pressure
values for loads can also be found on the tire
pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap.
The tire pressure for emergency spare wheels
can be found:
the yellow label on the wheel rim of the
emergency spare wheel
Rin the "Wheel and tire combinations"
section (Y page 293) of this Operator's
Manual
Ron the Tire and Loading Information placard
on the B-pillar on the driver's side
luggage in the table. The actual number of
seats may differ from this.
Ron
Tires and wheels
i The specifications shown in the examples
in the tire pressure tables are only
examples. Tire pressure specifications are
vehicle-specific and may deviate from the
data shown here. The tire pressure
specifications that are valid for your vehicle
can be found on your vehicle's tire pressure
table.
Tire pressure table with tire sizes (example)
Some tire pressure tables only show the rim
diameter instead of the complete tire size,
e.g. R18. The rim diameter is a component of
the tire size and can be read from the tire
sidewall (Y page 287).
The tire pressures in the tire pressure table
on the inside of the fuel filler flap are valid for
all approved tires installed at the factory,
unless stated otherwise.
Tire pressure too low or too high
Underinflated tires
G Warning
Tire pressure table for all approved tires installed
at the factory (example)
If the tire pressure precedes a tire size, the
tire pressure specification is only valid for this
tire size. The vehicle loading conditions
"partially laden" or "fully laden" are specified
using a differing number of persons and
Follow recommended tire inflation pressures.
Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires
wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely
affect handling and fuel economy, and are
more likely to fail from being overheated.
Underinflated tires can:
Rwear
excessively and/or unevenly
affect fuel economy
Radversely
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 275
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire pressures
from being overheated
affect handling
Radversely
Overinflated tires can:
G Warning
Follow recommended tire inflation pressures.
Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can
adversely affect handling and ride comfort,
wear unevenly, increase stopping distance,
and result in sudden deflation (blowout)
because they are more likely to become
punctured or damaged by road debris,
potholes etc.
Overinflated tires can:
Radversely
affect handling
excessively and/or unevenly
Rbe more likely to become damaged
Radversely affect ride comfort
Rincrease stopping distance
Rwear
Checking tire pressures
Important safety notes
G Warning
Follow recommended tire inflation pressures.
Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires
wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely
affect handling and fuel economy, and are
more likely to fail from being overheated.
Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can
adversely affect handling and ride comfort,
wear unevenly, increase stopping distance,
and result in sudden deflation (blowout)
because they are more likely to become
punctured or damaged by road debris,
potholes etc.
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified load limit as indicated on the Tire
and Loading Information placard on the
driver's door B-pillar. Overloading the tires
can overheat them, possibly causing a
blowout. Overloading the tires can also result
in handling or steering problems, or brake
failure.
Check the tire pressure at least once a month.
Only check and correct tire pressures when
the tires are cold (Y page 272).
Checking the tire pressures manually
In order to determine and adjust the tire
pressures, proceed as follows:
X
Remove the valve cap of the tire you wish
to check.
X Press the tire pressure gauge securely onto
the valve.
X Read the tire pressure and compare it with
the recommended value on the Tire and
Loading Information placard on the
B-pillar on the driver's side of your vehicle.
X If necessary, increase the tire pressure to
the recommended value (Y page 272).
X If the tire pressure is too high, release air
by pressing down the metal pin in the valve
using the tip of a pen, for example. Then,
check the tire pressure again using the tire
pressure gauge.
X Screw the valve cap onto the valve.
X Repeat the steps for the other tires.
Tire pressure loss warning system
(Canada only)
Important safety notes
While the vehicle is in motion, the tire
pressure loss warning system monitors the
set tire pressure using the rotational speed of
the wheels. This enables the system to detect
significant pressure loss in a tire. If the speed
of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of
a loss of pressure, a corresponding warning
message will appear in the multifunction
display.
Z
Tires and wheels
Rfail
275
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
276
Tire pressures
G Warning
If the Check Tire Pressure Soon message
appears in the multifunction display, one or
more tires are significantly underinflated.
Stop the vehicle as soon as possible and
inflate the tires to the pressure specified on
the vehicle's Tire and Loading Information
placard or (where available) in the tire
pressure table.
Driving on a significantly underinflated tire
causes the tire to overheat and can lead to
tire failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel
efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect
the vehicle's handling and stopping ability.
Check all tires when cold, including the spare
tire, at least once a month. The tires should
be inflated to the recommended pressure.
This information can be found:
Tires and wheels
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 276
Version: 3.0.3.6
Ron the Tire and Loading Information placard
on the B-pillar on the driver's side
or
Rin the table for the tire pressure on the
inside of the fuel filler flap
G Warning!
The tire pressure loss warning system does
not provide a warning for wrongly selected tire
inflation pressures. Always adjust tire
inflation pressure according to the Tire and
Loading Information placard on the driver's
door B-pillar or on the tire inflation pressure
label located on the inside of the fuel filler flap.
The tire pressure loss warning system does
not replace regular checks of the tire inflation
pressures since a gradual pressure loss in
more than one tire cannot be detected by the
tire pressure loss warning system.
The tire pressure loss warning system is not
able to issue a warning due to a sudden
dramatic loss of tire inflation pressure (e.g.
tire blowout caused by a foreign object). In
this case bring the vehicle to a halt by carefully
applying the brakes and avoiding abrupt
steering maneuvers.
The function of the tire pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
Rsnow
chains are mounted on your vehicle.
conditions are wintry.
Ryou are driving on sand or gravel.
Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style
(cornering at high speeds or driving with
high rates of acceleration).
Ryou are driving with a heavy cargo (in the
vehicle or on the roof).
Rroad
Restarting the tire pressure loss
warning system
Restart the tire pressure loss warning system
if you have:
Rchanged the tire pressure
Rchanged the wheels or tires
Rmounted new wheels or tires
X Before restarting, refer to the Tire and
Loading Information placard on the
B-pillar on the driver's side or the tire
pressure table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap to ensure the tire pressure in all four
tires is set correctly for the current
operating conditions.
X Observe the notes in the section on tire
pressures (Y page 272).
G Warning
The tire pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set the
correct tire pressure.
If an incorrect tire pressure is set, these
incorrect values will be monitored.
A tire with insufficient pressure results in
vehicle instability when driving, thus
increasing the risk of an accident.
X
Make sure that the SmartKey is in
position 2 (Y page 131) in the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
Service menu.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 277
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire pressures
Press the 9 or : button to select
Tire Pressure.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator Active
Press 'OK' to Restart message
appears in the multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Press the a button.
The Tire Pressure Now OK? message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Press 9 or : to select Yes.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator Restarted
message appears in the multifunction
display.
After a teach-in period, the tire pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tire pressures of all four tires.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
or
X
If the message: Tire Pressure now OK?
appears, use 9 or : to select
Cancel.
X Press the a button.
The tire pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Tire pressure monitoring system
(USA only)
Important safety notes
If a tire pressure monitor is installed, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors installed that
monitor the tire pressures in all four tires. The
tire pressure monitor warns you when the
pressure drops in one or more of the tires. The
tire pressure monitor only functions if the
correct wheel electronics units are installed
in all wheels.
The tire pressure monitor has a yellow
warning lamp in the instrument cluster for
indicating a pressure loss or malfunction.
Depending on how the warning lamp flashes
or lights up, a tire pressure that is too low or
a malfunction in the tire pressure monitor is
displayed:
Rif
the warning lamp is lit continuously, the
tire pressure on one or more tires is
significantly too low. The tire pressure
monitor is not malfunctioning.
Rif the warning lamp flashes for 60 seconds
and then remains lit constantly, the tire
pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
G Warning!
Each tire, including the spare (if provided),
should be checked at least once a month
when cold and inflated to the inflation
pressure recommended by the vehicle
manufacturer on the tire and loading
information table on the driver's door B-pillar
or the tire inflation pressure table on the
inside of the fuel filler flap. If your vehicle has
tires of a different size than the size indicated
on the tire and loading information table or
the tire inflation pressure table, you should
determine the proper tire inflation pressure
for those tires.
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has
been equipped with a tire pressure monitor
(TPMS). An indicator lamp lights up if one or
more of your tires are significantly
underinflated. Accordingly, when the low tire
pressure indicator lamp lights up, you should
stop and check your tires as soon as possible,
and inflate them to the proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly underinflated tire
causes the tire to overheat and can lead to
tire failure.
Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency
and tire tread life and may affect the vehicle's
handling and stopping ability. Please note that
the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire
maintenance and it is the driver's
responsibility to maintain correct tire
pressure, even if underinflation has not
Z
Tires and wheels
X
277
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Tires and wheels
278
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 278
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire pressures
reached the level at which the low tire
pressure indicator lamp of the TPMS lights up.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a
TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when
the system is not operating properly. The
TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with
the low tire pressure indicator lamp. When the
system detects a malfunction, the indicator
lamp will flash for approximately 1 minute and
then remain illuminated. This sequence will
continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups
as long as the malfunction exists. When the
malfunction indicator is lit, the system may
not be able to detect or signal low tire
pressure as intended.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of
reasons, including the installation of
incompatible replacement or alternate tires
or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the
TPMS from functioning properly. Always
check the TPMS malfunction indicator after
replacing one or more tires or wheels on your
vehicle to ensure that the replacement or
alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to
continue to function properly.
i If the tire pressure monitor is
malfunctioning, it may take more than
10 minutes for the tire pressure warning
lamp to inform you of the malfunction by
flashing for 60 seconds and then remaining
lit.
When the malfunction has been rectified,
the tire pressure warning lamp goes out
after driving for a few minutes.
Information on tire pressures is displayed in
the multifunction display. After a few minutes
of driving, the current tire pressure of each
tire is shown in the multifunction display.
i The tire pressure values indicated by the
on-board computer may differ from those
measured at a gas station with a pressure
gauge. The tire pressures shown by the onboard computer refer to those measured at
sea level. At high altitudes, the tire pressure
values indicated by a pressure gauge are
higher than those shown by the on-board
computer. In this case, do not reduce the
tire pressures.
i The operation of the tire pressure monitor
can be affected by interference from radio
transmitting equipment (e.g. radio
headphones, two-way radios) that may be
operated in or near the vehicle.
i This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2. This device must withstand any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Unauthorized modifications to the device
could void the user’s authority to operate
the equipment.
Checking tire pressure electronically
X
Make sure that the SmartKey is in
position 2 (Y page 131) in the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
Service menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tire Pressure.
X Press the a button.
The current tire pressure for each wheel will
be displayed in the multifunction display.
If the vehicle has been parked for longer than
20 minutes, the Tire pressures will be
displayed after driving a few
minutes message appears in the display.
After a teach-in period, the tire pressure
monitor automatically recognizes new wheels
or new sensors. As long as a clear allocation
of the tire pressure values to the individual
wheels is not possible, the Tire Pressure
Monitor Active message is shown instead
of the tire pressure display. The tire pressures
are already being monitored.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 279
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire pressures
i If a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
is mounted, the system may continue to
show the tire pressure of the wheel that has
been removed for a few minutes. If this
occurs, note that the value displayed for
the position where the spare wheel is
mounted is not the same as the spare
wheel/emergency spare wheel's current
tire pressure.
TPMS warning messages
If the tire pressure monitor detects a
significant pressure loss on one or more tires,
a warning message is shown in the
multifunction display. A warning tone also
sounds and the tire pressure warning lamp
lights up in the instrument cluster.
Each tire that is affected by a significant loss
of pressure is highlighted by a red rectangle.
If the Correct Tire Pressure message
appears in the multifunction display:
X Check the tire pressure on all four wheels
and correct it if necessary.
i If the wheel positions on the vehicle are
interchanged, the tire pressures may be
displayed for the wrong positions for a
short time. This is rectified after a few
minutes of driving, and the tire pressures
are displayed for the correct positions.
Restarting the tire pressure monitor
G Warning
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tire
inflation pressure to the recommended cold
tire inflation pressure. Underinflated tires
affect the ability to steer or brake the vehicle.
You might lose control over the vehicle.
When you restart the tire pressure monitor,
all existing warning messages are deleted and
the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses
the currently set tire pressures as the
reference values for monitoring.
The TPMS must be restarted when you set the
tire pressure to a new value (as a result of
changed handling or load characteristics, for
example). The TPMS then monitors the new
tire pressure values.
Restart the tire pressure monitor after you
have set the tire pressure to the value
recommended for the desired driving
situation (Y page 272). Only correct tire
pressures on cold tires. Comply with the
recommended tire pressures on the Tire and
Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on
the driver's side Additional tire pressure
values for driving at high speeds or with heavy
loads can be found in the Tire Pressure table
on the inside of the fuel filler flap.
X Make sure that the tire pressure is correct
on all four wheels.
X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position
2 in the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
Service menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tire Pressure.
X Press the a button.
The current tire pressure of each wheel or
the Tire pressures will be
displayed after driving a few
minutes message is shown in the
multifunction display.
X Press the : button.
The Use Current Pressures as New
Reference Values message appears in
the multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Press the a button.
The Tire Press. Monitor Restarted
message appears in the multifunction
display.
After driving for a few minutes, the system
checks whether the current tire pressures
are within the specified range. The new tire
pressures are then accepted as reference
values and monitored.
Z
279
Tires and wheels
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
Loading the vehicle
280
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tire pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Maximum tire pressures
G Warning
Tires and wheels
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 280
Version: 3.0.3.6
Never exceed the maximum tire inflation
pressure. Follow recommended tire inflation
pressures.
Do not underinflate tires. Underinflated tires
wear excessively and/or unevenly, adversely
affect handling and fuel economy, and are
more likely to fail from being overheated.
Do not overinflate tires. Overinflated tires can
adversely affect handling and ride comfort,
wear unevenly, increase stopping distance,
and result in sudden deflation (blowout)
because they are more likely to become
punctured or damaged by road debris,
potholes etc.
: Maximum permitted tire pressure
(example)
i The actual values for tires are specific to
each vehicle and may deviate from the
values in the illustration.
When adjusting the tire pressures always
observe the recommended tire pressure for
your vehicle (Y page 272).
Loading the vehicle
Instruction labels for tires and loads
G Warning
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified load limit as indicated on the Tire
and Loading Information placard on the
driver's door B-pillar. Overloading the tires
can overheat them, possibly causing a
blowout. Overloading the tires can also result
in handling or steering problems, or brake
failure.
Two instruction labels on your vehicle show
the maximum possible load.
(1) The Tire and Loading Information placard
is on the B-pillar on the driver's side. The
Tire and Loading Information placard
shows the permissible number of
occupants and the maximum permissible
vehicle load. It also contains details of the
tire sizes and corresponding pressures
for tires mounted at the factory.
(2) The vehicle identification plate is on the
B-pillar on the driver's side. The vehicle
identification plate informs you of the
gross vehicle weight rating. It is made up
of the vehicle weight, all vehicle
occupants, the fuel and the cargo. You
can also find information about the
maximum gross axle weight rating on the
front and rear axle.
The maximum gross axle weight rating is
the maximum weight that can be carried
by one axle (front or rear axle). Never
exceed the maximum load or the
maximum gross axle weight rating for the
front or rear axle.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 281
Version: 3.0.3.6
Loading the vehicle
281
Number of seats
i The data in the illustration of the Tire and
Loading Information placard is an example.
The number of seats is vehicle-specific and
can differ from the details shown. The
number of seats in your vehicle can be
found on the Tire and Loading Information
placard.
: B-pillar, driver's side
Maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight rating
Loading Information placard is an example.
The maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight rating is vehicle-specific and may
differ from that which is illustrated. You can
find the valid maximum permissible gross
vehicle weight rating for your vehicle on the
Tire and Loading Information placard.
X
Maximum number of seats : determines the
maximum number of occupants allowed to
travel in the vehicle. This information can be
found on the Tire and Loading Information
placard.
The Tire and Loading Information placard
gives you details on maximum permissible
gross vehicle weight rating :: "The gross
weight of occupants and luggage must
never exceed XXX kilograms or XXX
pounds."
The gross weight of all vehicle occupants,
cargo, luggage and trailer load/noseweight (if
applicable) must not exceed the specified
value.
Z
Tires and wheels
i The data in the illustration of the Tire and
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
282
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 282
Version: 3.0.3.6
Loading the vehicle
Tires and wheels
Determining the maximum load
The following steps have been developed as required of all manufacturers under Title 49, Code
of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the "National Traffic and Motor Vehicle
Safety Act of 1966".
X Step 1: Locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never
exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs." on your vehicle's Tire and Loading Information placard.
X Step 2: Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be traveling
in your vehicle.
X Step 3: Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kilograms or
XXX lbs.
X Step 4: The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity.
For example, if the "XXX" amount equals 1400 lbs and there will be five 150 lbs passengers
in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs (1400 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs).
X Step 5: Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle.
For reasons of safety, that weight must not exceed the available cargo and luggage cargo
capacity calculated in step 4.
X Step 6 (if applicable): If you intend to tow a trailer behind your vehicle, the load on the
trailer is transferred to your vehicle. Consult this Operator's Manual to determine how this
reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle (Y page 284).
The following table shows examples of how to calculate total and cargo load capacities with
varying seating configurations and number and size of occupants. The following examples use
a cargo limit of 1500 lbs (680 kg). This is for illustration purposes only. Make sure you
always use the actual load limit for your vehicle stated on the vehicle's Tire and Loading
Information placard (Y page 281).
Step 1
Step 2
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
1500 lbs
(680 kg)
1500 lbs
(680 kg)
1500 lbs
(680 kg)
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
Number of people in
the vehicle (driver
and occupants)
5
3
1
Distribution of the
occupants
Front: 2
Rear: 3
Front: 1
Rear: 2
Front: 1
Combined maximum
weight of occupants
and cargo (data from
the Tire and Loading
Information placard)
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 283
Version: 3.0.3.6
Loading the vehicle
Step 3
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
Weight of the
occupants
Occupant 1:
150 lbs (68 kg)
Occupant 2:
180 lbs (82 kg)
Occupant 3:
160 lbs (73 kg)
Occupant 4:
140 lbs (63 kg)
Occupant 5:
120 lbs (54 kg)
Occupant 1:
200 lbs (91 kg)
Occupant 2:
190 lbs (86 kg)
Occupant 3:
150 lbs (68 kg)
Occupant 1:
150 lbs (68 kg)
Gross weight of all
occupants
750 lbs (340 kg) 540 lbs (245 kg) 150 lbs (68 kg)
Permissible cargo
and trailer load/
noseweight
(maximum gross
vehicle weight rating
from the Tire and
Loading Information
placard minus the
gross weight of all
occupants)
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
1500 lbs
(680 kg) 750 lbs (340 kg)
= 750 lbs
(340 kg)
1500 lbs
(680 kg) 540 lbs (245 kg)
= 960 lbs
(435 kg)
1500 lbs
(680 kg) 150 lbs (68 kg) =
1350 lbs
(612 kg)
The greater the combined weight of the occupants, the lower the maximum luggage load.
Further information can be found under "Towing a trailer" (Y page 284).
Vehicle identification plate
Even if you have calculated the total cargo
carefully, you should still make sure that the
gross vehicle weight rating and the gross axle
weight rating are not exceeded. Details can
be found on the vehicle identification plate on
the B-pillar on the driver's side (Y page 280).
Gross vehicle weight: the gross weight of
the vehicle, all passengers, cargo and trailer
load/noseweight (if applicable) must not
exceed the permissible gross vehicle weight.
Gross axle weight rating: the maximum
permissible load that can be carried by one
axle (front or rear axle).
To ensure that your vehicle does not exceed
the maximum permissible values (gross
vehicle weight and maximum gross axle
weight rating), have your loaded vehicle
(including driver, occupants, cargo, and full
trailer load if applicable) weighed on a
suitable vehicle weighbridge.
Z
283
Tires and wheels
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
284
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 284
Version: 3.0.3.6
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards
Trailer load/noseweight
The trailer load/noseweight affects the gross
weight of the vehicle. If a trailer is attached,
the trailer load/noseweight is included in the
load along with occupants and luggage. The
trailer load/noseweight is usually
approximately 10% of the gross weight of the
trailer and its cargo.
Your Mercedes-Benz is designed for
transporting persons and their luggage.
Mercedes-Benz does not recommend towing
a trailer with your vehicle.
Direction of rotation
Tires with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of hydroplaning. You will only gain these
benefits if the correct direction of rotation is
observed.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tire indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
You may mount an emergency spare wheel/
spare wheel against the direction of rotation.
Observe the time restriction on use as well as
the speed limitation specified on the
emergency spare wheel/spare wheel.
Maximum tire load
Tires and wheels
G Warning
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified load limit as indicated on the Tire
and Loading Information placard on the
driver's door B-pillar. Overloading the tires
can overheat them, possibly causing a
blowout. Overloading the tires can also result
in handling or steering problems, or brake
failure.
i The actual values for tires are specific to
each vehicle and may deviate from the
values in the illustration.
Maximum tire load : is the maximum
permitted weight for which the tire is
approved.
Further information on tire loads
(Y page 286).
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards
Overview of tire quality standards
The Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards
are U.S. government specifications. Their
purpose is to provide drivers with uniform
reliable information on tire performance data.
Tire manufacturers have to grade tires using
three performance factors: : tread
wear, ; tire traction, and = heat resistance.
All tires sold in North America are provided
with the corresponding quality class mark on
the sidewall of the tire, even though these
regulations do not apply to Canada.
i The actual values for tires are specific to
each vehicle and may deviate from the
values in the illustration.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 285
Version: 3.0.3.6
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards
Where applicable, the tire grading
information can be found on the tire sidewall
between the tread shoulder and maximum
tire width.
For example:
Tread wear Traction
Temperature
200
A
AA
All passenger car tires must conform to the
statutory safety requirements in addition to
these grades.
Tread wear
The tread wear grade is a comparative rating
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested
under controlled conditions on a specified
U.S. government test track. For example, a
tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half
times as well on the government test track as
a tire graded 100.
The relative performance of tires depends
upon the actual conditions of their use,
however, and may depart significantly from
the norm due to variations in driving habits,
service practices and differences in road
characteristics and climate conditions.
Traction
G Warning
The traction grade assigned to this tire is
based on straight-ahead braking traction
tests, and does not include acceleration,
cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction
characteristics.
The traction grades, from highest to lowest,
are AA, A, B, and C. These grades represent
the tire's ability to stop on a wet surface as
measured under controlled conditions on
specified government test surfaces of asphalt
and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor
traction performance.
285
G Warning
If ice has formed on the road, tire traction will
be substantially reduced. Under such weather
conditions, drive, steer and brake with
extreme caution.
The safe speed on a wet, snow covered or icy
road is always lower than on dry road
surfaces.
You should pay special attention to road
conditions when temperatures are around
the freezing point.
Mercedes-Benz recommends a minimum tire
tread depth of 1/6 in (4 mm) for all four winter
tires (Y page 154) to maintain normal driving
characteristics in winter. Winter tires can
reduce the braking distance on snow covered
surfaces in comparison to summer tires. The
braking distance is still much further than on
surfaces that are not icy or covered with
snow. Take appropriate care when driving.
! Avoid wheelspin. This can lead to damage
to the drive train.
Temperature
G Warning
The temperature grade for this tire is
established for a tire that is properly inflated
and not overloaded. Excessive speed,
underinflation, or excessive loading, either
separately or in combination, can cause
excessive heat build-up and possible tire
failure.
The temperature grades are A (the highest),
B, and C. These represent the tire's
resistance to the generation of heat and its
ability to dissipate heat when tested under
controlled conditions on a specified indoor
laboratory test wheel. Sustained high
temperature can cause the material of the tire
to degenerate and reduce tire life.
Furthermore, excessive temperature can lead
to sudden tire failure. Grade C corresponds
to a level of performance that all passenger
Z
Tires and wheels
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
286
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 286
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire labeling
car tires must meet under Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B
and A represent higher levels of performance
on the laboratory test wheel than the
minimum required by law.
Tire labeling
Overview of tire labeling
The following markings are on the tire in
addition to the tire name (sales designation)
and the manufacturer's name:
Interchanging the wheels
G Warning
Rotate front and rear wheels only if the tires
are of the same dimension.
If your vehicle is equipped with mixed-size
tires (different tire dimensions front vs. rear),
tire rotation is not possible.
Tires and wheels
G Warning!
Have the tightening torque checked after
changing a wheel. Wheels could become
loose if not tightened with a torque of
96 lb-ft (130 Nm).
Only use genuine Mercedes-Benz wheel bolts
specified for your vehicle's rims.
The wear patterns on the front and rear tires
differ, depending on the operating conditions.
Rotate the wheels before a clear wear pattern
has formed on the tires. Front tires typically
wear more on the shoulders and the rear tires
in the center.
If your vehicle's tire configuration allows, you
can rotate the wheels according to the
intervals in the tire manufacturer's warranty
book in your vehicle documents. If no
warranty book is available, the tires should be
rotated every 3000 to 6000 miles
(5000 to 10000 km), or earlier if tire wear
requires. Do not change the direction of
wheel rotation.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is rotated. Check the tire pressures.
Information on changing a wheel and
mounting the spare wheel (Y page 255).
: Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standard
(Y page 290)
; DOT, Tire Identification Number
(Y page 289)
= Maximum tire load (Y page 284)
? Maximum tire pressure (Y page 280)
A Manufacturer
B Tire material (Y page 290)
C Tire size designation, load-bearing
capacity and speed index (Y page 287)
D Load index (Y page 289)
E Tire name
i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may
deviate from the data in the example.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 287
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire labeling
Tire size designation, load-bearing
capacity and speed index
: Tire width
; Nominal aspect ration in %
= Tire code
? Rim diameter
A Load bearing index
B Speed index
i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may
deviate from the data in the example.
General: depending on the manufacturer's
standards, the size imprinted in the tire wall
may not contain any letters or may contain
one letter that precedes the size description.
If there is no letter preceding the size
description (as shown above): these are
passenger vehicle tires according to
European manufacturing standards.
If "P" precedes the size description: these are
passenger vehicle tires according to U.S.
manufacturing standards.
If "LT" precedes the size description: these
are light truck tires according to U.S.
manufacturing standards.
If "T" precedes the size description: these are
compact emergency spare wheels at high tire
pressure, to be used only temporarily in an
emergency.
Tire width: tire width : shows the nominal
tire width in millimeters.
Nominal aspect ration: aspect ratio ; is
the size ratio between the tire height and the
tire width and is shown in percent. The aspect
287
ratio is calculated by dividing the tire width by
the tire height.
Tire code: tire code = specifies the tire type.
"R" represents radial tires. "D" represents
diagonal tires, "B" represents diagonal radial
tires.
Optionally, tires with a maximum speed of
over 149 mph (240 km/h) may have "ZR" in
the size description depending on the
manufacturer (e.g. 245/40 ZR 18).
Rim diameter: rim diameter ? is the
diameter of the bead seat, not the diameter
of the rim flange. The rim diameter is
specified in inches (in).
Load bearing index: load bearing index A
is a numerical code which specifies the
maximum load-bearing capacity of a tire.
G Warning
The tire load rating must always be at least
half of the GAWR of your vehicle. Otherwise,
sudden tire failure may be the result which
could cause an accident and/or serious injury
to you or others.
Always replace rims and tires with rims and
tires having the same specifications
(designation, manufacturer and type) as
shown on the original part.
G Warning
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified load limit as indicated on the Tire
and Loading Information placard on the
driver's door B-pillar. Overloading the tires
can overheat them, possibly causing a
blowout. Overloading the tires can also result
in handling or steering problems, or brake
failure.
Example:
The load bearing index 91 is equivalent to a
maximum load of 1356 lbs (615 kg) that the
tire can carry. For further information on the
maximum tire load in kilograms and pounds,
see (Y page 284).
Z
Tires and wheels
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
288
Tire labeling
For further information on the load bearing
index, see load index (Y page 289).
Speed index: speed index B specifies the
approved maximum speed of the tire.
G Warning
Even when permitted by law, never operate a
vehicle at speeds greater than the maximum
speed rating of the tires.
Exceeding the maximum speed for which tires
are rated can lead to sudden tire failure,
causing loss of vehicle control and possibly
resulting in an accident and/or serious
personal injury and possible death, for you
and for others.
Regardless of the speed index always observe
the speed limits. Drive carefully and adapt
your driving style to the traffic conditions.
Tires and wheels
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 288
Version: 3.0.3.6
Summer tires
The service specifications consists of load
bearing index A and speed index B.
RIf the size description of your tire includes
"ZR" and there are no service
specifications, ask the tire manufacturer in
order to find out the maximum speed.
If a service specification is available, the
maximum speed is limited according to the
speed index in the service specification.
Example: 245/40 ZR18 97 Y. In this
example, "97 Y" is the service specification.
The letter "Y" represents the speed index
and the maximum speed of the tire is
limited to 186 mph (300 km/h).
REvery tire that has a maximum speed above
186 mph (300 km/h) must have "ZR" in the
size description and the service
specification must be given in brackets.
Example: 275/40 ZR 18 (99 Y). The speed
index "(Y)" shows that the maximum speed
of the tire is above 186 mph (300 km/h).
Ask the tire manufacturer to find out the
maximum speed.
Index
Speed rating
Q
up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
R
up to 106 mph (170 km/h)
All-weather tires and winter tires
S
up to 112 mph (180 km/h)
Index
T
up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
Q M+S33 up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
H
up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
T M+S33
V
up to 149 mph (240 km/h)
H M+S33 up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
W
up to 168 mph (270 km/h)
V M+S33
Y
up to 186 mph (300 km/h)
ZR...Y
up to 186 mph (300 km/h)
ZR...(..Y)
above 186 mph (300 km/h)
ZR
above 149 mph (240 km/h)
ROptionally,
tires with a maximum speed of
over 149 mph (240 km/h) may have "ZR"
in the size description depending on the
manufacturer (e.g. 245/40 ZR 18).
33 or
M+Si for winter tires.
Speed rating
up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
up to 149 mph (240 km/h)
i Not all tires that have the M+S
identification offer the driving
characteristics of winter tires. Winter tires
have, in addition to the M+S identification,
the i snow flake symbol on the tire
sidewall. Tires with this identification fulfill
the requirements of the Rubber
Manufacturers Association (RMA) and the
Rubber Association of Canada (RAC)
regarding the tire traction on snow and
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 289
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire labeling
An electronic speed limiter prevents your
vehicle from exceeding the following speeds:
RAll
vehicles (except AMG vehicles):
130 mph (210 km/h)
RAMG vehicles: 155 mph (250 km/h)
RAMG vehicles with raised maximum speed:
174 mph (280 km/h)
The speed index of tires installed at the
factory may be higher than the maximum
speed that the electronic speed limiter
permits.
Make sure that your tires have the required
speed index as specified in the "Tires" section
(Y page 293) for your vehicle, e.g. when
buying new tires.
More information on reading the tire data can
be obtained at any qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. at an authorized MercedesBenz Center.
RIf no specification is given: no text (as in the
example above), represents a standard
load (SL) tire
RXL or Extra Load: represents a reinforced
tire
RLight load: represents a light load tire
RC, D, E: represents a load range that
depends on the maximum load that the tire
can carry at a certain pressure
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN)
U.S. tire regulations prescribe that every new
tire manufacturer or retreader has to imprint
a TIN in or on the sidewall of each tire
produced.
Tires and wheels
have been especially developed for driving
on snow.
Load index
The TIN is a unique identification number. The
TIN enables the tire manufacturers to inform
purchasers of recalls and other safetyrelevant matters. It makes it possible for the
purchaser to easily identify the affected tires.
The TIN is made up of manufacturer
identification code ;, tire size =, tire type
code ? and date of manufacture A.
i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may
deviate from the data in the example.
In addition to the load bearing index, load
index : may be imprinted after the letters
that identify speed index B (Y page 287) on
the sidewall of the tire.
289
i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may
deviate from the data in the example.
DOT (Department of Transportation): tire
symbol : marks that the tire complies with
the requirements of the U.S. Department of
Transportation.
Manufacturer identification code:
manufacturer identification code ; provides
details on the tire manufacturer. New tires
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
290
Definitions for tires and loading
have a code with two symbols. Retreaded
tires have a code with four symbols.
Further information about retreaded tires
(Y page 270).
Tire size: identifier = describes the tire size.
Tire type code: tire type code ? can be
used by the manufacturer as a code to
describe specific characteristics of the tire.
Date of manufacture: date of manufacture
A provides information about the age of a
tire. The first and second positions represent
the week of manufacture, starting with "01"
for the first calendar week. Positions three
and four represent the year of manufacture.
For example, a tire that is marked with
"3208", was manufactured in week 32 in
2008.
Tires and wheels
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 290
Version: 3.0.3.6
Tire ply material
Bar
Metric unit for tire pressure. 14.5038 pounds
per square inch (psi) and 100 kilopascals
(kPa) are the equivalent of 1 bar.
DOT (Department of Transportation)
DOT marked tires fulfill the requirements of
the United States Department of
Transportation.
Average weight of the vehicle
occupants
The number of occupants for which the
vehicle is designed multiplied by 68 kilograms
(150 lb).
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards
This is a uniform standard to grade the quality
of tires with regards to tread quality, tire
traction and temperature characteristics. The
quality grading assessment is made by the
manufacturer following specifications from
the U.S. government. The quality grade of a
tire is imprinted on the sidewall of the tire.
i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may
deviate from the data in the example.
This information describes the tire cord and
the number of layers in sidewall : and under
the tread ;.
Definitions for tires and loading
Tire ply composition and material
used
Describes the number of layers or the number
of rubber-coated belts in the tire tread and
the tire wall. These are made of steel, nylon,
polyester and other materials.
Recommended tire pressure
This is the recommended tire pressure for
your vehicle under normal driving conditions.
You will find the recommendation on the Tire
and Loading Information placard on the
B-pillar on the driver's side of your vehicle.
The recommended tire pressure provides the
best balance between handling
characteristics, ride comfort and wear.
Additional information on particular driving
conditions is located on the tire pressure
table on the inside of the fuel filler flap.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 291
Version: 3.0.3.6
Definitions for tires and loading
Increased vehicle weight due to
optional equipment
This is the combined weight of all standard
and optional equipment available for the
vehicle, regardless of whether it is actually
installed on the vehicle or not.
Wheel rim
This is the part of the wheel on which the tire
is mounted.
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
The GAWR is the maximum gross axle weight
rating. The actual load on an axle must never
exceed the gross axle weight rating. The
gross axle weight rating can be found on the
vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on
the driver's side.
noseweight if applicable). The gross vehicle
weight rating is specified on the vehicle
identification plate on the B-pillar on the
driver's side.
Maximum loaded vehicle weight
The maximum weight is the sum of the
unladen weight of the vehicle, the weight of
the accessories, the maximum load and the
weight of the optional equipment installed at
the factory.
Kilopascal (kPa)
Metric unit for tire pressure. 6.9 kPa is the
equivalent of 1 psi. Another unit for tire
pressure is bar. 100 kilopascal (kPa) is the
equivalent of 1 bar.
Load index
Speed index
The speed index is part of the tire
identification. It specifies the speed range for
which the tire is approved. Specifies the
speed range for which the tire is approved.
In addition to the load bearing index, the load
index may also be imprinted on the sidewall
of the tire. This specifies the load bearing
capacity more precisely.
Unladen weight
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
The gross vehicle weight includes the weight
of the vehicle including fuel, tools, the spare
wheel, accessories installed, occupants,
luggage and the drawbar noseweight if
applicable. The gross vehicle weight must not
exceed the gross vehicle weight rating GVWR
as specified on the vehicle identification plate
on the B-pillar on the driver's side.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)
291
The weight of a vehicle with standard
equipment including the maximum capacity
of fuel, oil and coolant. It also includes the airconditioning system and optional equipment
if these are installed on the vehicle, but does
not include passengers or luggage.
Maximum tire load
The maximum tire load in kilograms or
pounds is the maximum weight for which a
tire is approved.
The GVWR is the maximum permissible gross
weight of a fully loaded vehicle (the weight of
the vehicle including all accessories,
occupants, fuel, luggage and the drawbar
Z
Tires and wheels
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
292
Definitions for tires and loading
Maximum permissible tire pressure
Maximum permissible tire pressure for one
tire.
Maximum load on one tire
Maximum load on one tire. This is calculated
by dividing the maximum axle load of one axle
by two.
PSI (pounds per square inch)
Standard unit of measurement for tire
pressure.
Aspect ratio
Tires and wheels
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 292
Version: 3.0.3.6
Relationship between tire height and tire
width in percent.
Tire pressure
Pressure inside the tire applying an outward
force to every square inch of the tire's
surface. The tire pressure is specified in
pounds per square inch (psi), in kilopascal
(kPa) or in bar. The tire pressure should only
be corrected when the tires are cold. For this,
the vehicle must have been stationary for at
least three hours or not have traveled more
than 1.6 km (1 mile) in this time.
Tire tread
The part of the tire that comes into contact
with the road.
Tire bead
The tire bead ensures that the tire sits
securely on the wheel. There are several steel
wires in the bead to prevent the tire from
coming loose from the wheel rim.
Sidewall
The part of the tire between the tread and the
tire bead.
Weight of optional extras
The combined weight of those optional extras
that weigh more than the replaced standard
part and more than 2.3 kilograms (5 lbs).
These optional extras, such as highperformance brakes, level control, a roof rack
or a high-performance battery, are not
included in the unladen weight and the weight
of the accessories.
TIN (Tire Identification Number)
A unique identification number which can be
used by a tire manufacturer to identify tires,
for example for a product recall, and thus
identify the purchasers. The TIN is made up
of the manufacturer's identity code, tire size,
tire type code and the manufacturing date.
Load bearing index
The load bearing index (also load index) is a
code that contains the maximum load bearing
capacity of a tire.
Traction
Traction is the result of friction between the
tires and the road surface.
Wear indicator
This is indicated by narrow bars (tread wear
bars) that are distributed over the tire tread.
If the tire tread is level with the bars, the wear
limit of 1/16 in (1.6 mm) has been reached.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 293
Version: 3.0.3.6
Wheel/tire combinations
Distribution of the vehicle occupants
This is the distribution of vehicle occupants
over designated seat positions in a vehicle.
Maximum permissible payload
weight
Nominal load and luggage load plus
68 kilograms (150 lb) multiplied by the
number of seats in the vehicle.
Wheel/tire combinations
Points to remember
G Warning
Observe the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 270).
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you only use tires,
wheels and accessories which have been
approved by Mercedes-Benz specifically
for your vehicle.
These tires have been specially adapted for
use with the control systems, such as ABS
or ESP®, and are marked as follows:
RMO
= Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tires with run-flat characteristics)
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only
certain AMG tires)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tires
may only be used on wheels that have been
specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tires, wheels or accessories
tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Certain characteristics, e.g. handling,
vehicle noise emissions or fuel
consumption, may otherwise be adversely
affected. In addition, when driving with a
load, tire dimension variations could cause
the tires to come into contact with the
bodywork and axle components. This could
result in damage to the tires or the vehicle.
293
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage resulting from the use of tires,
wheels or accessories other than those
tested and approved.
Further information about tires, wheels and
approved combinations can be obtained
from any authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
i The Tire and Loading Information placard
with the recommended tire pressures is
attached to the B-pillar on the driver's side.
Further information about driving at high
speeds or driving with vehicle loads that are
lighter than the maximum vehicle load can
be found in the tire pressure table on the
inside of the fuel filler flap. Check tire
pressures regularly, and only when the tires
are cold. Follow the tire manufacturer's
maintenance recommendations in the
vehicle document wallet.
Further information on recommended tire
pressures including tire pressures for specific
driving situations, see (Y page 272).
i Notes on the vehicle equipment – always
equip the vehicle:
Rwith tires of the same size on a given axle
(left/right)
Rwith the same type of tires at a given time
(summer tires, winter tires, MOExtended
tires)
i The following pages contain information
on approved wheel rims and tire sizes for
equipping your vehicle with winter tires.
Winter tires are not available at the factory
as standard equipment or optional extras.
If you wish to fit approved winter tires to
your vehicle, rims of appropriate size are
also required, as the sizes of the approved
winter tires can differ from those of the
original tires. This is dependent on the
model and the equipment installed at the
factory.
Tires and wheel rims as well as additional
information are available from a qualified
Z
Tires and wheels
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
294
Wheel/tire combinations
Tires and wheels
specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 294
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 295
Version: 3.0.3.6
Wheel/tire combinations
295
Tires of the same dimensions
i BA: both axles
R16 BA
R17 BA
Alloy wheels
Offset
7 J x 16 H2
1.69 in (43 mm)
All-weather tires
205/55 R16 91 H M+S
Winter tires
205/55 R16 91 H M+Si
C 300
C 300 4MATIC
C 35035
C 350 4MATIC35
Alloy wheels
Offset
7.5 J x 17 H2
1.85 in (47 mm)
7.5 J x 17 H2
1.85 in (47 mm)
Summer tires36
225/45 R17 91 W
MOExtended
—
All-weather tires
225/45 R17 91 H M+S
—
Winter tires
225/45 R17 91 H
M+Si
225/45 R17 91 H
M+Si
Winter tires36
225/45 R17 91 H
M+SiMOExtended
—
Tires and wheels
C 25034, 35
C 250 4MATIC35
C 63 AMG
R18 BA
AMG alloy wheels
Offset
8 J x 18 H2
1.77 in (45 mm)
Winter tires
225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si
Winter tires37
235/40 R18 95 V XL M+Si
Mixed size tires
i FA: front axle, RA: rear axle
34 Not
in combination with the Sports package.
only.
36 Tires with run-flat characteristics and only in combination with an activated tire pressure loss warning system
or tire pressure monitor.
37 Use of snow chains not permitted.
35 Canada
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
296
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 296
Version: 3.0.3.6
Wheel/tire combinations
C 25038
C 250 4MATIC38
C 300
C 300 4MATIC
C 350
C 350 4MATIC38
17"
FA
Tires and wheels
RA
Alloy wheels
Offset
7.5 J x 17 H2
1.85 in (47 mm)
Summer tires39
225/45 R17 91 W MOExtended
All-weather tires
225/45 R17 91 H M+S
Alloy wheels
Offset
8.5 J x 17 H2
2.28 in (58 mm)
Summer tires39
245/40 R17 91 W MOExtended
All-weather tires40
245/40 R17 91 H M+S
C 30038
C 300 4MATIC38
C 350 4MATIC38
17"
FA
RA
38 Canada
AMG alloy wheels
Offset
7.5 J x 17 H2
1.85 in (47 mm)
All-weather tires
225/45 R17 91 H M+S
AMG alloy wheels
Offset
8.5 J x 17 H2
2.28 in (58 mm)
All-weather tires40
245/40 R17 91 H M+S
only.
39 Tires with run-flat characteristics and only in combination with an activated tire pressure loss warning system
or tire pressure monitor.
of snow chains not permitted.
40 Use
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 297
Version: 3.0.3.6
Wheel/tire combinations
297
18"
FA
RA
Alloy wheels
Offset
7.5 J x 18 H2
1.85 in (47 mm)
Summer tires
225/40 R18 92 Y XL
All-weather tires
225/40 R18 92 H XL M+S
Alloy wheels
Offset
8.5 J x 18 H2
2.13 in (54 mm)
Summer tires40
255/35 R18 94 Y XL
All-weather tires40
255/35 R18 94 H XL M+S
Tires and wheels
C 25038
C 250 4MATIC38
C 300
C 300 4MATIC
C 350
C 350 4MATIC38
C 25038
C 250 4MATIC38
C 300
C 300 4MATIC38
C 350
C 350 4MATIC38
18"
FA
RA
AMG alloy wheels
Offset
8 J x 18 H2
1.97 in (50 mm)
Summer tires
225/40 R18 92 Y XL
All-weather tires
225/40 R18 92 H XL M+S
AMG alloy wheels
Offset
8.5 J x 18 H2
2.13 in (54 mm)
Summer tires40
255/35 R18 94 Y XL
All-weather tires40
255/35 R18 94 H XL M+S
38 Canada
40 Use
only.
of snow chains not permitted.
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
298
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 298
Version: 3.0.3.6
Wheel/tire combinations
C 63 AMG
18"
FA
RA
AMG alloy wheels
Offset
8 J x 18 H2
1.77 in (45 mm)
Summer tires
235/40 ZR18 95 Y XL
Winter tires
235/40 ZR18 95 V XL M+Si
AMG alloy wheels
Offset
9 J x 18 H2
2.13 in (54 mm)
Summer tires40
255/35 ZR18 94 Y XL
Winter tires40
255/35 ZR18 94 V XL M+Si
Spare wheel
Tires and wheels
i Please note that the tire pressure of the spare wheel differs from the tire pressure of the
other wheels.
i The specified tire pressure is printed in yellow on the emergency spare wheel.
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel41
C 250 (all models)42, 43
C 300
C 300 4MATIC
R16 Wheels
Offset
40 Use
3.5 B x 16 H2
0.79 in (20 mm)
Tires
T 125/90 R16 98 M
Tire pressure
420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
of snow chains not permitted.
of snow chains not permitted.
42 Canada only.
43 Not in combination with the Sports package.
41 Use
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 299
Version: 3.0.3.6
Wheel/tire combinations
299
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel41
C 25042, 44
C 30044
C 300 4MATIC44
C 350 (all models)
R17 Wheels
Offset
3.5 B x 17 H2
0.79 in (20 mm)
Tires
T 125/80 R17 99 M
Tire pressure
420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel41
C 63 AMG
3.5 B x 18
0.79 in (20 mm)
Tires
T 125/70 R18 99 M
Tire pressure
420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
Tires and wheels
R18 Wheels
Offset
41 Use
of snow chains not permitted.
only.
44 Only in combination with the Sports package.
42 Canada
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
300
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 300
Version: 3.0.3.6
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 301
Version: 3.0.3.6
301
Vehicle equipment ............................
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts .........
Warranty ............................................
Vehicle identification plates ............
Service products and capacities .....
Vehicle data ......................................
302
302
302
303
304
311
Technical data
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
302
Warranty
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
which was available at the time of
purchase. Country-specific differences are
possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle
may not feature all functions described
here. This also refers to safety-related
systems and functions.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
Technical data
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 302
Version: 3.0.3.6
All Mercedes-Benz Centers maintain a supply
of genuine Mercedes-Benz parts for
necessary service and repair work. In
addition, strategically located parts delivery
centers provide for quick and reliable parts
service.
More than 300,000 different genuine
Mercedes-Benz parts are available for
Mercedes-Benz models.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts are subjected
to stringent quality inspections. Every part
has been specifically developed,
manufactured or selected for and adapted to
Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
Only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts should
therefore be used.
! The use of non-approved parts could
impair the vehicle's safety. For this reason,
Mercedes-Benz recommends genuine
Mercedes-Benz parts and approved
conversion parts and accessories for your
vehicle model.
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned major
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. They are covered by the
same Limited Warranty entitlements as new
parts.
Always specify the vehicle identification
number and engine number when ordering
genuine Mercedes-Benz parts. You will find
these numbers on your vehicle's
identification plates, for example
(Y page 303).
Warranty
Your vehicle is covered under the terms of the
warranties printed in the Service and
Warranty Information booklet.
Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will
exchange or repair any defective parts
originally installed in the vehicle in
accordance with the terms of the following
warranties:
RNew
Vehicle Limited Warranty
System Warranty
REmission Performance Warranty
RCalifornia, Connecticut, Maine,
Massachusetts, New York, Pennsylvania,
Rhode Island and Vermont Emission
Control Systems Warranty
RState Warranty Enforcement Laws (Lemon
Laws)
Replacement parts and accessories are
subject to the Mercedes-Benz Replacement
Part and Accessory Warranties. You can
obtain these at any Mercedes-Benz Center.
REmission
i Should you lose your Service and
Warranty Information booklet, have an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center arrange
for a replacement. It will be mailed to you.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 303
Version: 3.0.3.6
Vehicle identification plates
Vehicle identification plates
303
i The data on the type plate is only an
example. This data is vehicle-specific and
can differ from the data given here. The
data that applies to your vehicle can be
found on your vehicle's type plate.
Vehicle identification plate with
vehicle identification number (VIN)
and paint code number
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
The vehicle identification number (VIN) can
be found in the following locations:
X
Open the driver's door.
You see vehicle identification plate :.
the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 303)
Rat the lower edge of the windshield
(Y page 304)
In addition to being stamped on the vehicle
identification plate, the vehicle identification
number (VIN) is also stamped onto the vehicle
body.
It is located on the floor in front of the frontpassenger seat.
Technical data
Ron
Example: vehicle identification plate (USA only)
; VIN
= Paint code number
X
Slide the right-hand front seat to its
rearmost position.
X Fold floor covering : upwards.
You will see vehicle identification number
(VIN) ;.
Example: vehicle identification plate (Canada only)
; VIN
= Paint code number
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
304
Service products and capacities
Engine number
: Emissions control information label,
including the certification of both federal
and Californian emissions reference
values
; Engine number (stamped into the
crankcase)
= VIN (on the lower edge of the windshield)
Service products and capacities
Technical data
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 304
Version: 3.0.3.6
Important safety notes
Service products include the following:
Rfuels
(e.g. gasoline, diesel)
Rlubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
Rcoolant
Rbrake
fluid
Rwindshield
washer fluid
Vehicle components and their respective
lubricants must match. You should therefore
only use products that have been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Information on tested and approved products
can be obtained at an authorized MercedesBenz Center or on the Internet at http://
www.mbusa.com (USA only).
G Warning
Comply with all valid regulations with respect
to handling, storing and disposing of service
fluids. Otherwise, you could endanger
persons or the environment.
Keep service fluids out of the reach of
children.
For health reasons, you should prevent
service fluids from coming into direct contact
with your skin or clothing.
If a service fluid is swallowed, contact a
physician immediately.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 305
Version: 3.0.3.6
Service products and capacities
305
Vehicle model
Capacity
Fuel, coolant,
lubricants etc.
C 25045
C 300
C 350
8.5 US qt (8.0 l)
Approved engine
oils
C 250 4MATIC45
C 300 4MATIC
C 350 4MATIC45
7.4 US qt (7.0 l)
C 63 AMG46
9.0 US qt (8.5 l)
Power steering
All models
Approximately 0.9 US qt
(0.8 l)
MB power steering
fluid or approved
Dexron III ATF
Cooling system
All models except
AMG vehicles
Approximately 8.9 US qt
(8.4 l)
C 63 AMG
Approximately 12.4 US qt
(11.7 l)
MB 325.0 corrosion
inhibitor/antifreeze
agent
Tank capacity
All models
17.4 US gal. (66.0 l)
Reserve
All models except
AMG vehicles
Engine oil and
filter
C 63 AMG
Airconditioning
system
45 Canada
All models
Premium-grade
unleaded gasoline
Approximately 2.1 US gal. (at least 91 octane,
(8.0 l)
average value
Approximately 3.7 US gal. between 96 RON/
86 MON)
(14.0 l)
—
Refrigerant R134a
and special PAG
lubricant (never
R 12)
only.
external oil cooler.
46 Including
Z
Technical data
Capacities
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
306
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 306
Version: 3.0.3.6
Service products and capacities
Windshield/
headlamp
cleaning
system
Vehicle model
Capacity
Fuel, coolant,
lubricants etc.
C 25045
C 250 4MATIC45
C 300 4MATIC
C 350 4MATIC45
C 63 AMG
6.3 US qt (6.0 l)
C 300
C 350
3.7 US qt (3.5 l)
MB windshield
washer
concentrate47
(Y page 310)
Mixing ratio for
washer fluid
(Y page 310)
Ravoid
Fuel
Important safety notes
Technical data
G Warning
Gasoline is highly flammable and poisonous.
It burns violently and can cause serious
personal injury.
Never allow sparks, flames or smoking
materials near gasoline.
Turn off the engine before refueling.
Whenever you are around gasoline, avoid
inhaling fumes and any skin or clothing
contact.
Direct skin contact with fuels and the
inhalation of fuel vapors are damaging to your
health.
Premium-grade unleaded gasoline
! To ensure the longevity and full
performance of the engine, only premiumgrade unleaded gasoline must be used.
If premium-grade unleaded gasoline is
unavailable and regular gasoline is used,
observe the following precautions:
Ronly
fill the fuel tank to half full with
regular unleaded gasoline and add the
rest as soon as possible with premiumgrade unleaded gasoline.
Rdo not drive at the maximum speed.
45 Canada
47 Mixed
sudden acceleration.
Rwhen the vehicle is carrying a light cargo,
e.g. two passengers without luggage, do
not allow the engine to rev above
3000 rpm.
Rwhen the vehicle is fully loaded or being
operated in mountainous terrain, do not
depress the accelerator pedal further
than 2/3 of the pedal travel.
Flexible fuel vehicles
Important safety notes
All C 300 models with automatic
transmission are flexible fuel vehicles.
Flexible fuel vehicles are identified by a label
reading Premium gasoline or E85 only on
the inside of the fuel filler flap.
Flexible fuel vehicles are designed to operate
on premium unleaded gasoline and ethanol
fuel (E85) or a mixture of these two. Ethanol
fuel (E85) is a mixture of approximately 85%
ethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline.
G Warning
Ethanol fuel (E85) and its vapors are highly
flammable, poisonous and highly
combustible. Ethanol fuel causes serious
injury if it ignites, if it comes into contact with
your skin or if you inhale the vapors. Avoid
inhaling ethanol vapors and ethanol coming
only.
with water or premixed washer fluid with antifreeze protection.
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 307
Version: 3.0.3.6
Service products and capacities
into contact with your skin. Before refueling,
extinguish all naked flames. Never allow
sparks or smoking materials near ethanol.
Changing the fuel type
For best performance and driveability, it is
recommended that you use either one or the
other fuel. Avoid alternating regularly
between the two different types of fuel.
When changing the fuel type, make sure:
Rthe
fuel level is below half full.
Rthe fuel level is above the reserve level. This
is identifiable by the fuel tank reserve
warning lamp not being lit.
Ryou add more than 5 gallons (20 liters) of
fuel.
Rbefore refueling, you switch off the engine.
Rthe engine is started and operated for at
least five minutes immediately after
refueling.
These precautions and recommendations
should prevent any difficulties when starting
and operating the engine which otherwise
may be experienced before the engine has
fully adapted to the different fuel.
If, in spite of these recommendations, the
engine does not perform properly, add at
least 3 gallons (12 liters) of gasoline. This may
improve the running of the engine.
Fuel consumption
Ethanol fuel (E85) contains less energy per
gallon than gasoline. To ensure that the
engine performance with ethanol fuel (E85) is
similar to that when using gasoline, the
engine must burn more ethanol fuel. As a
result, it is to be expected that the fuel
consumption will increase when using
ethanol fuel (E85), compared to gasoline.
Maintenance
When you bring your vehicle for maintenance
or repairs, please inform your authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center if you use or have
used ethanol fuel (E85).
307
Low outside temperatures
It is possible that the time required for the
starting procedure will significantly increase
at outside temperatures below 32 ‡ (0 †).
At low outside temperatures, Mercedes-Benz
recommends the use of an auxiliary heater.
For further information, contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Rough idling may also be experienced at low
outside temperatures until the engine is fully
warmed up.
Ethanol fuel (E85) is unsuitable for use when
outside temperatures fall below 14 ‡
(-10 †).
High outside temperatures
At outside temperatures above 95 ‡ (35 †),
the time required for the starting procedure
may increase and be accompanied by rough
idling following the start.
Fuel requirements
Use only premium-grade unleaded gasoline.
The octane number should be at least 91.
Details can be found on the gas pump. The
octane number is the average value of the
Research Octane Number (RON) and Motor
Octane Number (MON): (RON + MON) / 2,
also known as knock resistance.
Reformulated Gasoline (RFG) and/or
unleaded gasoline with additives can be used
if the concentration of the additives in the fuel
does not exceed 10%, e.g.:
REthanol
RTAME
RETBE
RIPA
RTBA
For MTBE, the concentration should not
exceed 15%.
The concentration of methanol in gasoline
including other additives must not exceed 3%.
Using mixtures of methanol and ethanol is not
permitted. Gasohol, a mixture of 10% ethanol
and 90% unleaded gasoline can be used.
Z
Technical data
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
308
Service products and capacities
All of these mix fuels must fulfill the fuel
requirements, e.g.:
Damage or malfunctions can result that are
not covered:
Rknock
Rby
Rboiling
Rby
resistance
point
Rvapor pressure
Additives in gasoline
One of the major problems in engine design
is the creation of carbon deposits during the
process of burning fuel. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you use fuel brands that
have the additives which prevent the build up
of carbon deposits.
If you use fuels without these additives for a
longer period of time, there may be a build up
of carbon deposits, especially on the inlet
valves and in the combustion chamber.
This could lead to engine running problems,
e.g.:
Rwarm-up
Technical data
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 308
Version: 3.0.3.6
hesitation
Runstable idle
Rknocking/pinging
Rmisfire
Rpower loss
In areas where carbon deposits may be
encountered due to lack of availability of
gasoline which contains these additives,
Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of
additives approved for use in Mercedes-Benz
vehicles.
Consult an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
or visit http://www.mbusa.com (USA only)
to view a list of approved products. Observe
the instructions for use on the product label.
Do not mix other fuel additives with fuel. This
causes unnecessary costs and could damage
the engine.
! Do not refuel with low-grade fuel and do
not use fuel additives that are not tested
and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
48 Canada
only.
the Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty
an existing Limited Warranty
Rby an extended Limited Warranty
Engine oil
Points to remember
The engine oils are matched to the
performance of Mercedes-Benz engines and
service intervals. For this reason, only use
engine oils and oil filters that are approved for
vehicles with a service system.
Contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
or visit http://www.mbusa.com (USA only)
for a list of approved engine oils and oil filters.
! Never use engine oil or an oil filter of a
specification other than is necessary to
fulfill the prescribed service intervals. Do
not change the engine oil or oil filter in
order to achieve longer replacement
intervals than those prescribed. Otherwise,
you may cause damage to the engine or
exhaust gas aftertreatment; this is not
covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited
Warranty.
Follow the instructions in the service
interval display regarding the oil change.
Otherwise, you may damage the engine and
the exhaust gas aftertreatment.
Mercedes-Benz recommends MOBIL OIL.
The table shows which engines oil have been
approved for your vehicle.
Model
Engine
model
MB
Approval
C 25048
272
229.5
C 250 4MATIC48
272
229.5
C 300
272
229.5
C 300 4MATIC
272
229.5
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 309
Version: 3.0.3.6
Service products and capacities
Model
C 350
C 350
4MATIC48
C 63 AMG
Engine
model
MB
Approval
272
229.5
272
229.5
156
229.549
309
i MB Approval is stated on the containers.
Lubricant additives
the engine oil. This could damage the
engine. Damage resulting from the use of
such lubricant additives in the engine oil is
not covered by the Mercedes-Benz Limited
Warranty.
Engine oil viscosity
Viscosity describes the flow characteristics
of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity,
this means that it is thick; a low viscosity
means that it is thin.
Using the table below, make sure that the SAE
classification (viscosity) is sufficient for the
temperatures at which the vehicle is
operated. The low temperature
characteristics of engine oils can deteriorate
significantly, e.g. by aging, soot and fuel
deposits. It is therefore recommended that
you carry out oil changes regularly using an
approved engine oil with the appropriate SAE
classification.
Refrigerant of the air-conditioning
system
The air-conditioning system is filled with
R134a refrigerant and a special PAG
lubricant.
! Never use refrigerant R 12 (CFC) or
mineral lubricants. Otherwise, you could
damage the air-conditioning system.
Brake fluid
G Warning!
The brake fluid constantly absorbs moisture
from the air; this lowers its boiling point.
If the boiling point of the brake fluid is too low,
vapor pockets may form in the brake system
when the brakes are applied hard (e.g. when
driving downhill). This would impair braking
efficiency.
You should have the brake fluid renewed at
regular intervals. The brake fluid change
intervals can be found in the Service Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz. Information about approved brake
fluids can be obtained from any authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
48 Canada
only.
only SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 engine oils may be used.
49 Restriction:
Z
Technical data
! Do not mix any lubricant additives with
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
310
Service products and capacities
Coolant
Important safety notes
The coolant is a mixture of water and
antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It performs
the following tasks:
Ranti-corrosion
protection
protection
Rraising the boiling point
The cooling system is filled with coolant at the
factory which contains antifreeze/corrosion
inhibitor that ensures protection down to
approximately -35 ‡ (-37 †).
Rantifreeze
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
Technical data
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 310
Version: 3.0.3.6
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants and on
filling can be found in the Mercedes-Benz
Specifications for Service Products, MB
Approval 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com. You
can also consult an authorized MercedesBenz Center.
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Otherwise, the cooling system will not be
sufficiently protected from corrosion, and
the boiling point will be too low.
If the coolant has antifreeze protection down
to -35 ‡ (-37 †), the boiling point of the
coolant in the pressurized system is
approximately 266 ‡ (130 †).
Your vehicle has a range of aluminum
components. Use of aluminum components
in the engine make it necessary to specifically
match the antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor in
these systems in order to protect the
aluminum parts. Using other antifreeze/
corrosion inhibitors without these
characteristics affects the service life.
The coolant must be used throughout the year
in order to maintain the necessary corrosion
protection and provide protection from
overheating. In the Service Booklet, you can
find information on the intervals for renewal.
The renewal interval is determined by the
coolant type and the cooling system design.
The renewal interval in the Service Booklet is
only valid if the coolant is added or renewed
with Mercedes-Benz approved products.
Therefore, only use MB 326.0 antifreeze/
corrosion inhibitor or another Mercedes-Benz
approved product of the same specification.
Information on other Mercedes-Benz
approved products of the same specification
can be obtained at any authorized MercedesBenz Center or on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
The coolant is checked at every service date
at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor
concentration in the cooling system should:
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the cooling
system against freezing down to around
-35 ‡ (-37 †).
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection
down to -49 ‡ (-45 †); otherwise, heat will
not be dissipated as effectively.
If the coolant level is too low, MB 326.0
antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor should be
added. Have the cooling system checked for
leaks.
Windshield and headlamp cleaning
system
G Warning
Washer solvent/antifreeze is highly
flammable. Do not spill washer solvent/
antifreeze on hot engine parts, because it may
ignite and burn. You could be seriously
burned.
X
Use MB Windshield Washer Concentrate
MB SummerFit.
X At temperatures above freezing: add 1
part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water, e.g.
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 311
Version: 3.0.3.6
Vehicle data
1.34 fl oz (40 ml) MB SummerFit to 1 gal
(4.0 l) of water.
X At temperatures below freezing: add 1
part MB SummerFit to 100 parts washer
fluid, e.g. 1.34 fl oz (40 ml) MB SummerFit
to 1 gal (4.0 l) of water.
i This vehicle is only available in Canada.
Vehicle dimensions, C 250 4MATIC
Vehicle length
182.8 in (4630 mm)
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
79.1 in (2008 mm)
Vehicle data
Vehicle height
56.9 in (1444 mm)
Vehicle data, C 250
Wheel base
108.7 in (2760 mm)
Front track
60.7 in (1541 mm)
Rear track
60.8 in (1544 mm)
Turning circle
35.6 ft (10.9 m)
The data quoted here refers specifically to a
vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the
data for all vehicle variants and trim levels.
311
i This vehicle is only available in Canada.
Vehicle length
182.3 in (4630 mm)
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
79.1 in (2008 mm)
Vehicle height
56.9 in (1444 mm)
Wheel base
108.7 in (2760 mm)
Front track
60.7 in (1541 mm)
Rear track
60.8 in (1544 mm)
Turning circle
35.6 ft (10.9 m)
Vehicle weight, C 250 4MATIC
Maximum roof
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Maximum trunk
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Vehicle data, C 300
The data quoted here refers specifically to a
vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the
data for all vehicle variants and trim levels.
Vehicle dimensions, C 300
Vehicle weight, C 250
Maximum roof
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Maximum trunk
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Vehicle data, C 250 4MATIC
The data quoted here refers specifically to a
vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the
data for all vehicle variants and trim levels.
Vehicle length
182.8 in (4630 mm)
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
79.1 in (2012 mm)
Vehicle height
56.9 in (1444 mm)
Wheel base
108.7 in (2760 mm)
Front track
60.7 in (1541 mm)
Rear track
60.8 in (1544 mm)
Turning circle
35.6 ft (10.9 m)
Z
Technical data
Vehicle dimensions, C 250
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
312
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 312
Version: 3.0.3.6
Vehicle data
Vehicle weight, C 300
Maximum roof
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Maximum trunk
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Vehicle data, C 300 4MATIC
The data quoted here refers specifically to a
vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the
data for all vehicle variants and trim levels.
Vehicle dimensions, C 350
Vehicle length
182.3 in (4630 mm)
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
79.1 in (2008 mm)
Vehicle height
56.9 in (1444 mm)
Wheel base
108.7 in (2760 mm)
Front track
60.4 in (1533 mm)
Rear track
60.5 in (1536 mm)
Turning circle
35.6 ft (10.9 m)
Technical data
Vehicle dimensions, C 300 4MATIC
Vehicle length
182.3 in (4630 mm)
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
79.1 in (2008 mm)
Vehicle height
56.9 in (1444 mm)
Wheelbase
108.7 in (2760 mm)
Front track
60.7 in (1541 mm)
Rear track
60.8 in (1544 mm)
Turning circle
35.6 ft (10.9 m)
Vehicle weight, C 300 4MATIC
Maximum roof
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Maximum trunk
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Vehicle data, C 350
The data quoted here refers specifically to a
vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the
data for all vehicle variants and trim levels.
Vehicle weight, C 350
Maximum roof
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Maximum trunk
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Vehicle data, C 350 4MATIC
The data quoted here refers specifically to a
vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the
data for all vehicle variants and trim levels.
i This vehicle is only available in Canada.
Vehicle dimensions, C 350 4MATIC
Vehicle length
182.3 in (4630 mm)
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
79.1 in (2008 mm)
Vehicle height
56.9 in (1444 mm)
Wheel base
108.7 in (2760 mm)
Front track
60.4 in (1533 mm)
Rear track
60.5 in (1536 mm)
Turning circle
35.6 ft (10.9 m)
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 313
Version: 3.0.3.6
Vehicle data
313
Vehicle weight, C 350 4MATIC
Maximum roof
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Maximum trunk
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Vehicle data, C 63 AMG
The data quoted here refers specifically to a
vehicle with standard equipment. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for the
data for all vehicle variants and trim levels.
Vehicle length
186.1 in (4726 mm)
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
79.2 in (2012 mm)
Vehicle height
56.6 in (1438 mm)
Wheel base
108.9 in (2765 mm)
Front track
61.8 in (1569 mm)
Rear track
60.0 in (1525 mm)
Technical data
Vehicle dimensions, C 63 AMG
Vehicle weight, C 63 AMG
Maximum roof
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Maximum trunk
load
Maximum 220 lb
(100 kg)
Z
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
314
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 314
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 315
Version: 3.0.3.6
315
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
316
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 316
Version: 3.0.3.6
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 317
Version: 3.0.3.6
Publication details
Internet
Further information about Mercedes-Benz
vehicles and about Daimler AG can be found
on the following websites:
http://www.mbusa.com (USA only)
http://www.mercedes-benz.ca (Canada
only)
Editorial office
Not to be reprinted, translated or otherwise
reproduced, in whole or in part, without the
written permission of Daimler AG.
As at 26.02.2010
BA 204 USA, CA Edition A 2011; 1; 5, en-US
hereepe
2010-05-20T09:17:30+02:00 - Seite 318
Version: 3.0.3.6
É2045848981XËÍ
2045848981
Order no. 6515 0722 13 Part no. 204 584 89 81 Edition A 2011